Log local IP on delivery log line, under the incoming_interface log selector. Bug 507
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.85"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2014
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1989 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1990 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1991 support has not been tested for some time.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2036 building process fails if it is set.
2037
2038 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2039 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2040 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2041 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2042 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2043 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2044 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2045 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2046
2047 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2048 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2049 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2050
2051
2052
2053 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2054 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2055 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2056 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2057 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2058 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2059 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2060 .code
2061 FULLECHO='' make -e
2062 .endd
2063 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2064 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2065 given in addition to the short output.
2066
2067
2068
2069 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2070 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2071 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2072 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2073 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2074 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2075 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2076 order:
2077 .display
2078 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2079 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile_&
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2085 .endd
2086 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2089 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2090 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2091 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2092 and are often not needed.
2093
2094 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2095 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2096 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2097 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2098 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2099 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2100 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2101 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2102 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2103
2104
2105 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2106 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2107 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2108 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2109 default values are.
2110
2111
2112 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2113 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2114 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2115 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2116 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2117 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2118 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2119 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2120 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2121 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2122 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2123 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2124 containing the lines
2125 .code
2126 CC=cc
2127 CFLAGS=-std1
2128 .endd
2129 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2130 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2131
2132 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2133 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2134 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2135
2136
2137 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2141 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2142 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2143 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2144 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2145 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2146 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2147 .code
2148 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2149 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2150 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2151 .endd
2152 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2153 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2154 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2155 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2156 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2157 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2158 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2159 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2160 errors.
2161
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2164 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2165 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2166 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2167 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2168 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2169 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2170 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2171 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2172 syntax. For instance:
2173 .code
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2175 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2176 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2177 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2180 .endd
2181
2182 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2183 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2184 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2185 .code
2186 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2187 .endd
2188 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2189 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2190
2191 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2192 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2193 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2194 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2195 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2196 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2197 .code
2198 X11=/usr/X11R6
2199 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2200 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2201 .endd
2202 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2203 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2204 .code
2205 X11=/usr/openwin
2206 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2208 .endd
2209 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2210 definition of all three of these variables into your
2211 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2212
2213 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2214 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2215 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2216 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2217 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2218
2219 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2220 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2221 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2222 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2223 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2224 libraries.
2225
2226 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2227 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2228 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2229 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2230 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2231
2232
2233 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2234 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2235 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2236 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2237 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2238 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2239 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2240 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2241
2242
2243
2244 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2245 .cindex "building Eximon"
2246 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2247 where the files that are involved are
2248 .display
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2255 .endd
2256 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2257 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2260 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2261 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2262 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2263 .ecindex IIDbuex
2264
2265
2266 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2267 .cindex "installing Exim"
2268 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2269 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2270 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2271 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2272 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2273 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2274 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2275 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2276 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2277 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2278 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2279 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2280
2281 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2282 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2283 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2284 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2285 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2286 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2287 alternative files, no default is installed.
2288
2289 .cindex "system aliases file"
2290 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2291 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2292 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2293 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2294 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2295 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2296 and outputs a comment to the user.
2297
2298 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2299 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2300 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2301 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2302 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2303
2304 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2305 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2306 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2307 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2308 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2309 over SMTP.
2310
2311 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2312 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2313 command such as
2314 .code
2315 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2316 .endd
2317 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2318 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2319 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2320 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2321 but this usage is deprecated.
2322
2323 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2324 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2325 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2326 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2327 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2328 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2329
2330 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2331 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2332 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2333 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2334 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2335 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2336 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2337
2338 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2339 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2340 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2341 command:
2342 .code
2343 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2344 .endd
2345 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2346 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2347 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2348 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2349 command:
2350 .code
2351 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2352 .endd
2353 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2354 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2355
2356 .ilist
2357 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2358 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2359 .next
2360 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2361 installed binary.
2362 .endlist
2363
2364 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2365 .code
2366 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2367 .endd
2368 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2369 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2370 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2371 .code
2372 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2373 .endd
2374
2375
2376
2377 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2378 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2379 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2380 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2381 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2382 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2383
2384 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2385 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2386 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2391 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2392 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2393 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2394 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2395 necessary.
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2401 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2402 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2403 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2404 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2405 .code
2406 exim -bV
2407 .endd
2408 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2409 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2410 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2411 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2412 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2413 example,
2414 .display
2415 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2416 .endd
2417 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2418 .display
2419 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2420 .endd
2421 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2422 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2423 user agent. For example:
2424 .code
2425 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2426 From: user@your.domain.example
2427 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2428 Subject: Testing Exim
2429
2430 This is a test message.
2431 ^D
2432 .endd
2433 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2434 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2435 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2436
2437 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2438 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2439 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2440 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2441 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2442 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2443 .display
2444 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2445 .endd
2446 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2447 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2448 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2449 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2450 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2451
2452 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2453 .cindex "lock files"
2454 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2455 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2456 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2457 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2458 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2459 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2460 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2461 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2462 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2463 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2464 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2465 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2466
2467 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2468 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2469 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2470 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2471 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2472 incoming SMTP mail.
2473
2474 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2475 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2476 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2477 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2478 production version.
2479
2480
2481 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2482 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2483 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2484 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2485 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2486 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2487 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2488 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2489 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2490 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2491 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2492 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2493 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2494
2495 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2496 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2497 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2498 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2499 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2500 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2501 as follows:
2502 .code
2503 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2506 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2507 .endd
2508 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2509 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2510 favourite user agent.
2511
2512 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2513 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2514 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2515 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2516 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2517 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2518
2519
2520
2521 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2522 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2523 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2524 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2525 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2526 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2527 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2528 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2529 configuration file.
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2535 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2536 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2537 .code
2538 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2539 .endd
2540 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2541 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2542 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2543 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2544 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2545 .code
2546 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2547 .endd
2548 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2549
2550 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2551 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2552 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559
2560 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2561 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2562 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2563 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2564 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2565 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2566 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2567 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2568 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2569
2570
2571 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2572 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2573 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2574 were present before any other options.
2575 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2576 standard output.
2577 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2578 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2579 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2580
2581 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2582 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2583 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2584 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2585 format.
2586
2587 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2588 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2589 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2590 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2591
2592 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2593 .cindex "queue runner"
2594 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2595 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2596 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2597
2598 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2599 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2600 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2602 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2603 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2604 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2605 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2606
2607
2608 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2609 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2610 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2611 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2612 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2613 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2614
2615 .ilist
2616 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2617 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2618 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2619 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2620 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2621 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2622
2623 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2624 .cindex "envelope sender"
2625 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2626 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2627 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2628 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2629 users to set envelope senders.
2630
2631 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2632 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2633 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2634 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2635 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2636
2637 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2638 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2639 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2640 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2641 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2642 that are available to trusted users.
2643 .next
2644 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2645 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2646 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2647 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2648 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2649
2650 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2651 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2652 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2653 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2654
2655 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2656 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2657 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2658 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2659
2660 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2661 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2662 false.
2663 .endlist
2664
2665
2666 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2667 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2668 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2669 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2675 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2676 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2677 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2678 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2679 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2680 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2681 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2682
2683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2685 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2686 . creates a man page for the options.
2687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2688
2689 .literal xml
2690 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2691 .literal off
2692
2693
2694 .vlist
2695 .vitem &%--%&
2696 .oindex "--"
2697 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2698 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2699 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2700 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2701
2702 .vitem &%--help%&
2703 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2704 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2705 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2706 no arguments.
2707
2708 .vitem &%--version%&
2709 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2710 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2711 displayed.
2712
2713 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2714 &%-Am%&
2715 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2716 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2717 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2718 ignored by Exim.
2719
2720 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2721 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2722 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2723 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2724 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2725 clean; it ignores this option.
2726
2727 .vitem &%-bd%&
2728 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2729 .cindex "daemon"
2730 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2731 .cindex "queue runner"
2732 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2733 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2734 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2735
2736 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2737 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2738 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2739 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2740
2741 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2742 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2743 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2744 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2745
2746 When a listening daemon
2747 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2748 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2749 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2750 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2751 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2752 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2753 running as root.
2754
2755 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2756 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2757 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2758
2759 The SIGHUP signal
2760 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2761 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2762 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2763 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2764 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2765 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2766 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2767 because these are reread each time they are used.
2768
2769 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2770 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2771 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2772 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2773
2774 .vitem &%-be%&
2775 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2776 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2777 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2778 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2779 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2780 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2781 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2782
2783 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2784 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2785 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2786 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2787 test data. A line history is supported.
2788
2789 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2790 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2791 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2792 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2793 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2794 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2795 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2796
2797 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2798 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2799 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2800 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2801
2802 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2803 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2804 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2805 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2806 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2807 of a file. For example:
2808 .code
2809 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2810 .endd
2811 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2812 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2813 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2814 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2815 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2816 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2817 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2818 &%-be%&).
2819
2820 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2821 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2822 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2823 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2824 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2825 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2826 system filters are recognized.
2827
2828 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2830 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2832 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2833 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2834 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2835 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2836 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2837 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2838 supplied.
2839
2840 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2841 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2842 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2843 .code
2844 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2845 .endd
2846 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2847 variables that are used by the user filter.
2848
2849 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2850 .code
2851 # Exim filter
2852 # Sieve filter
2853 .endd
2854 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2855 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2856 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2857 redirection lists.
2858
2859 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2860 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2861 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2862 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2863
2864 When testing a filter file,
2865 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2866 .cindex "envelope sender"
2867 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2868 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2869 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2870 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2871 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2872 options).
2873
2874 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2875 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2876 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2877 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2878 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2879 &$qualify_domain$&.
2880
2881 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2882 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2883 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2885 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2886 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2887 actually being delivered.
2888
2889 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2890 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2891 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2892 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2893 prefix.
2894
2895 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2896 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2897 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2899 suffix.
2900
2901 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2902 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2903 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2904 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2905 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2906 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2907 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2908 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2909 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2910 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2911 after a full stop. For example:
2912 .code
2913 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2914 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2915 .endd
2916 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2917 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2918 conversion to the canonical form is
2919 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2920
2921 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2922 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2923 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2924 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2925 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926
2927 &*Warning 1*&:
2928 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2929 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2930 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2931 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2932 connection.
2933
2934 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2935 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2936 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2937
2938 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2939 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2940 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2941 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2942 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2943 session were authenticated.
2944
2945 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2946 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2947 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2948
2949 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2950 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2951 specialized SMTP test program such as
2952 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2953
2954 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2955 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2956 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2957 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2958 updating the callout cache database.
2959
2960 .vitem &%-bi%&
2961 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2962 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2963 .cindex "building alias file"
2964 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2965 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2966 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2967 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2968 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2969 recognized.
2970
2971 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2972 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2973 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2974 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2975 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2976 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2977 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2978
2979 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2980 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2981 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2982 .cindex "querying exim information"
2983 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2984 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2985 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2986 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2987 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2988
2989 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2990 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2991 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2992 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2993 recognised DSCP names.
2994
2995 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2996 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2998 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2999 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3000 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3001 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3002 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3003 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004
3005 .vitem &%-bm%&
3006 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3007 .cindex "local message reception"
3008 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3009 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3010 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3011 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3012 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3013 if no other conflicting option is present.
3014
3015 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3016 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3017 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3018 suppressing this for special cases.
3019
3020 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3021 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3022
3023 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3024 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3025 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3026
3027 The format
3028 .cindex "message" "format"
3029 .cindex "format" "message"
3030 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3032 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3033 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3034 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3035 .code
3036 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3037 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3038 .endd
3039 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3040 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3041 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3042 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3043 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3044
3045 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3046 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3047 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3048 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3049 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3050
3051 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3052 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3053 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3054 .cindex "malware scan test"
3055 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3056 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3057 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3058 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3059 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3060 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3061
3062 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3063 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3064 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3065 This option requires admin privileges.
3066
3067 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3068 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3069 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3070
3071 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3072 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3073 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3074 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3075 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3076 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3077 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3078 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3079 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3080
3081 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3082 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3083 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3084 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3085 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3086
3087 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3088 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3089 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3090 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3091
3092
3093 .vitem &%-bP%&
3094 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3095 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3096 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3097 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3098 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3099 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3100 arguments, for example:
3101 .code
3102 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3103 .endd
3104 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3105 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3106 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3107 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3108 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3109 users, the output is as in this example:
3110 .code
3111 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3112 .endd
3113 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output.
3115 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3117
3118 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120 name will not be output.
3121
3122 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128 written directly into the spool directory.
3129
3130 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3131 .code
3132 exim -bP +local_domains
3133 .endd
3134 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3136
3137 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142 that driver are output. For example:
3143 .code
3144 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3145 .endd
3146 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3151 &%authenticators%&.
3152
3153 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157 The output format is one item per line.
3158
3159 .vitem &%-bp%&
3160 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3161 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167 to allow any user to see the queue.
3168
3169 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3170 .code
3171 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3173 <other addresses>
3174 .endd
3175 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176 .cindex "size" "of message"
3177 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183 before the sender address.
3184
3185 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3188
3189 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3194 complete.
3195
3196
3197 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3198 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3199 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3202 of just &"D"&.
3203
3204
3205 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3206 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3207 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3211
3212
3213 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3214 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3215 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3222 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3223
3224 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3225 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3226 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3227
3228
3229 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3230 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3231 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3235
3236
3237 .vitem &%-brt%&
3238 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3239 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3244 .code
3245 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3247 .endd
3248 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3257 .code
3258 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3260 .endd
3261
3262 .vitem &%-brw%&
3263 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3264 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3271
3272 .vitem &%-bS%&
3273 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3274 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3283
3284 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3287
3288 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3292
3293 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3296
3297 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3302
3303 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3305
3306 .vitem &%-bs%&
3307 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3308 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3310 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314 messages to the MTA.
3315
3316 In
3317 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3318 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3324
3325 .cindex "inetd"
3326 The
3327 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333 the listening daemon.
3334
3335 .vitem &%-bt%&
3336 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3337 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338 .cindex "address" "testing"
3339 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3344
3345 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3347
3348 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3350 security issues.
3351
3352 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3357 program.
3358
3359 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3363
3364 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3368 always shown.
3369
3370 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3372 message,
3373 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3379 doing such tests.
3380
3381 .vitem &%-bV%&
3382 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3383 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3384 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3389
3390 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396 dynamic testing facilities.
3397
3398 .vitem &%-bv%&
3399 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "address" "verification"
3402 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3408
3409 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3412
3413 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3415
3416 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3418 security issues.
3419
3420 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3425
3426 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3432 to succeed.
3433
3434 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3437
3438 The
3439 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3443
3444 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3448
3449 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3450 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3451 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3453 might happen.
3454
3455 .vitem &%-bw%&
3456 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3457 .cindex "daemon"
3458 .cindex "inetd"
3459 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3463
3464 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467 each port only when the first connection is received.
3468
3469 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3471
3472 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3473 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3474 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3483
3484 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3493
3494 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3501
3502 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3509
3510 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3513 configuration file.
3514
3515 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519 specified by this option.
3520
3521
3522 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3523 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3524 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3530
3531 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3538
3539 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3542 synonymous:
3543 .code
3544 exim -DABC ...
3545 exim -DABC= ...
3546 .endd
3547 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3549 example:
3550 .code
3551 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3552 .endd
3553 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3554
3555
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565 return code.
3566
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574 are:
3575 .display
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603 &`tls `& TLS logic
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608 .endd
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3615
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621 rather than stderr.
3622
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628 run in parallel.
3629
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632 in processing.
3633
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650 .vitem &%-E%&
3651 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688 users to use it.
3689
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694 domain.
3695
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3701 .code
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3704 .endd
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707 &%-bv%& options.
3708
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714 White
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-G%&
3723 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726 .code
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3728 .endd
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731 in future.
3732
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734 this option.
3735
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741 headers.)
3742
3743 .vitem &%-i%&
3744 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773 Retry
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3809 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814 .new
3815 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3816 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3817 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3818 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3819 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3820 .wen
3821
3822 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3823 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3824 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3825 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3826 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3827
3828 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3829 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3830 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3831 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3832 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3833 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3834 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3835 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3836
3837 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3838 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3839 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3840 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3841 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3842 connection.
3843
3844 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3845 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3846 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3848 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3849
3850 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3851 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3852 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3853 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3854 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3855 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3856 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3857 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3858 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3859 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3860 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3861 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3862 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3863 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3864 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3865
3866 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3867 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3868 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3869 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3870 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3871 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3872 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3873 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3874 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3875 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3876
3877 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3878 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3879 .cindex "freezing messages"
3880 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3881 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3882 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3883 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3884 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3885 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3886 user.
3887
3888 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3889 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3890 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3891 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3892 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3893 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3894 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3895 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3896 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3897 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3898 user.
3899
3900 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3901 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3902 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3903 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3904 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3905 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3906 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3907
3908 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3909 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3910 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3911 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3912 .cindex "removing recipients"
3913 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3914 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3915 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3916 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3917 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3918 can be used only by an admin user.
3919
3920 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3921 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3922 .cindex "removing messages"
3923 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3924 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3925 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3926 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3927 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3928 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3929 placed on the queue.
3930
3931 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3932 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3933 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3934 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3935 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3936 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3937 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3938 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3939 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3940 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3941 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3942
3943 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3945 .cindex "thawing messages"
3946 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3947 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3948 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3949 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3950 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3951 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3952 by an admin user.
3953
3954 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3955 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3956 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3957 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3958 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3959 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3960
3961 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3963 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3964 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3965 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3966 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3967 only by an admin user.
3968
3969 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3971 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3972 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3973 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3974 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3975 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3976
3977 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3978 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3979 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3980 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3981 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3982 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3983
3984 .vitem &%-m%&
3985 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3986 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3987 treats it that way too.
3988
3989 .vitem &%-N%&
3990 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3991 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3992 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3993 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3994 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3995 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3996 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3997 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3998 than &"=>"&.
3999
4000 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4001 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4002 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4003 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4004 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4005 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4006 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4007 for that message.
4008
4009 .vitem &%-n%&
4010 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4011 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4012 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4013 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4014
4015 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4016 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4017 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4018 Exim.
4019
4020 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4021 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4022 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4023 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4024 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4025 description above.
4026
4027 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4028 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4029 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4030 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4031 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4032 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4033 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4034 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4035
4036 .vitem &%-odb%&
4037 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4038 .cindex "background delivery"
4039 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4040 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4041 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4042 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4043 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4044 processes to finish.
4045
4046 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4047 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4048 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4049 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4050
4051 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4052 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4053 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4054 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4055
4056 .vitem &%-odf%&
4057 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4058 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4059 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4060 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4061 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4062 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4063 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4064
4065 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4066 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4067 during deliveries.
4068
4069 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4070 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4071
4072 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4073 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4074 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4075 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4076
4077
4078 .vitem &%-odi%&
4079 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4080 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4081 Sendmail.
4082
4083 .vitem &%-odq%&
4084 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4085 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4086 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4087 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4088 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4089 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4090 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4091 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4092 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4093 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4094 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4095 forces queueing.
4096
4097 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4098 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4099 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4100 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4101 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4102 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4103 configuration file is in effect.
4104
4105 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4106 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4107 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4108 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4109 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4110 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4111 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4112 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4113 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4114 &%-qq%& option.
4115
4116 .vitem &%-oee%&
4117 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4118 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4119 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4120 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4121 message.
4122
4123 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4124 Provided
4125 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4126 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4127 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4128 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4129
4130 .vitem &%-oem%&
4131 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4132 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4133 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4134 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4135 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4136 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4137
4138 .vitem &%-oep%&
4139 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4140 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4141 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4142 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4143 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4144 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4145
4146 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4147 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4148 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4149 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4150 effect as &%-oep%&.
4151
4152 .vitem &%-oew%&
4153 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4154 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4155 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4156 effect as &%-oem%&.
4157
4158 .vitem &%-oi%&
4159 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4160 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4161 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4162 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4163 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4164 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4165 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4166
4167 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4168 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4169 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4170
4171 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4172 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4173 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4174 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4175 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4176 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4177 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4178 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4179
4180 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4181 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4182 .code
4183 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4184 .endd
4185 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4186 followed by a colon and the port number:
4187 .code
4188 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4189 .endd
4190 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4191 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4192 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4193 whichever one is last.
4194
4195 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4196 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4197 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4198 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4199 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4200 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4201 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4202 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4203
4204 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4205 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4206 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4207 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4208 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4209 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4210 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4211 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4212
4213 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4214 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4215 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4216 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4217 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4218 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4219 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4220 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4221 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4222 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4225 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4226 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4227 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4228 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4229 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4230 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4231
4232 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4233 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4234 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4235 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4236 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4237 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4238 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4239 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4240 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4241
4242 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4243 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4244 is sending the bounce.
4245
4246 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4247 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4248 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4249 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4250 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4251 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4252 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4253 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4254 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4255 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4256 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4257 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4258
4259 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4260 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4261 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4262 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4263 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4264 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4265 uses the name it is given.
4266
4267 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4268 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4269 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4270 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4271 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4272 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4273 used, when there is no default.
4274
4275 .vitem &%-om%&
4276 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4277 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4278 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4279 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4280 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4281
4282 .vitem &%-oo%&
4283 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4284 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4285 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4286 whatever that means.
4287
4288 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4289 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4290 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4291 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4292 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4293 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4294 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4295 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4296 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4297
4298 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4299 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4300 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4301 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4302 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4303 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4304 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4305
4306 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4307 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4308 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4309 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4310 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4311 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4312 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4313 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4314
4315 .vitem &%-ov%&
4316 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4317 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4318
4319 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4320 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4321 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4322 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4323 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4324 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4325 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4326 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4327 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4328 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4329
4330 .vitem &%-pd%&
4331 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4332 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4333 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4334 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4335 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4336 needed.
4337
4338 .vitem &%-ps%&
4339 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4340 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4341 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4342 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4343 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4344 started.
4345
4346 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4347 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4348 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4349 .display
4350 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4351 .endd
4352 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4353 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4354 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4355 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4356 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4357
4358 .vitem &%-q%&
4359 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4360 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4361 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4362 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4363 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4364 and &%-S%& options).
4365
4366 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4367 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4368 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4369 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4370 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4371 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4372
4373 If
4374 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4375 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4376 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4377 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4378 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4379 proceeding.
4380
4381 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4382 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4383 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4384 this to be repeated periodically.
4385
4386 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4387 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4388 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4389 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4390
4391 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4392 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4393 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4394
4395 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4396 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4397 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4398 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4399
4400 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4401 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4402 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4403 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4404 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4405 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4406 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4407 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4408 transports are run.
4409
4410 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4411 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4412 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4413 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4414 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4415 delivered down a single SMTP
4416 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4417 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4418 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4419 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4420 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4421 intermittently.
4422
4423 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4424 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4425 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4426 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4427 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4428 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4429 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4430
4431 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4432 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4433 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4434 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4435 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4436 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4437 their retry times are tried.
4438
4439 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4440 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4441 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4442 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4443 frozen or not.
4444
4445 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4446 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4447 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4448 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4449 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4450 for later delivery.
4451
4452 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4453 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4454 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4455 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4456 starting message id. For example:
4457 .code
4458 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4459 .endd
4460 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4461 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4462 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4463 .code
4464 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4465 .endd
4466 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4467 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4468 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4469 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4470 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4471 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4472
4473 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4474 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4475 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4476 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4477 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4478 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4479 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4480 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4481 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4482 .code
4483 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4484 .endd
4485 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4486 process every 30 minutes.
4487
4488 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4489 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4490
4491 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4492 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4493 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4494 compatibility.
4495
4496 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4497 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4498 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4499
4500 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4501 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4502 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4503 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4504 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4505 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4506 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4507 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4508 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4509
4510 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4511 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4512 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4513 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4514 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4515 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4516
4517 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4518 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4519 .code
4520 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4521 .endd
4522 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4523 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4524 applied to each queue run.
4525
4526 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4527 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4528 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4529 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4530 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4531 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4532 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4533 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4534 address will be skipped.
4535
4536 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4537 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4538 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4539 &'ff'& is present.
4540
4541 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4542 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4543 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4544 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4545 an arbitrary command instead.
4546
4547 .vitem &%-r%&
4548 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4549 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4550
4551 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4552 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4553 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4554 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4555 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4556 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4557 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4558 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4559
4560 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4561 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4562 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4563 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4564 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4565
4566 .vitem &%-t%&
4567 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4568 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4569 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4570 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4571 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4572 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4573 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4574 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4575 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4576 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4577
4578 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4579 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4580 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4581 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4582 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4583 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4584 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4585 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4586 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4587 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4588 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4589
4590 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4591 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4592 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4593 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4594 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4595 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4596
4597 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4598 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4599 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4600 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4601 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4602 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4603 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4604 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4605 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4606
4607 .vitem &%-ti%&
4608 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4609 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4610 compatibility with Sendmail.
4611
4612 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4613 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4614 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4615 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4616 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4617 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4618 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4619 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4620
4621
4622 .vitem &%-U%&
4623 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4624 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4625 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4626 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4627 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4628 set. Exim ignores this option.
4629
4630 .vitem &%-v%&
4631 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4632 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4633 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4634 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4635 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4636 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4637 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4638 unconditional.
4639
4640 .vitem &%-x%&
4641 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4642 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4643 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4644 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4645 this option.
4646
4647 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4648 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4649 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4650 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4651
4652 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4653 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4654 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4655 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4656 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4657 under most shells.
4658 .endlist
4659
4660 .ecindex IIDclo1
4661 .ecindex IIDclo2
4662
4663
4664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4665 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4666 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4667 . creates a man page for the options.
4668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4669
4670 .literal xml
4671 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4672 .literal off
4673
4674
4675
4676
4677
4678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4680
4681
4682 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4683 "The runtime configuration file"
4684
4685 .cindex "run time configuration"
4686 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4687 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4688 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4689 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4690 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4691 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4692 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4693 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4694 control.
4695
4696 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4697 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4698 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4699 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4700 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4701 actually alter the string.
4702
4703 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4704 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4705 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4706 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4707 existing file in the list.
4708
4709 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4710 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4711 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4712 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4713 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4714 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4715 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4716 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4717 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4718 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4719 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4720
4721 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4722 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4723 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4724 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4725 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4726
4727 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4728 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4729 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4730 compromise the Exim user account.
4731
4732 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4733 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4734 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4735 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4736 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4737 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4738 configuration.
4739
4740
4741
4742 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4743 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4744 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4745 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4746 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4747 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4748 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4749 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4750 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4751 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4752 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4753
4754 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4755 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4756 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4757 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4758 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4759 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4760 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4761 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4762 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4763 &%-M%&).
4764
4765 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4766 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4767 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4768 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4769 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4770
4771 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4772 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4773 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4774 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4775 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4776 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4777
4778 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4779 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4780 necessarily be discarded.
4781 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4782 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4783 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4784 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4785 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4786 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4787
4788 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4789 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4790 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4791 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4792 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4793 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4794 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4795
4796 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4797 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4798 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4799
4800
4801
4802 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4803 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4804 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4805 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4806 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4807 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4808 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4809 optional parts are:
4810
4811 .ilist
4812 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4813 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4814 .next
4815 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4816 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4817 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4818 .next
4819 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4820 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4821 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4822 .next
4823 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4824 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4825 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4826 .next
4827 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4828 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4829 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4830 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4831 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4832 .next
4833 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4834 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4835 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4836 .next
4837 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4838 want to use this feature, you must set
4839 .code
4840 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4841 .endd
4842 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4843 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4844 .endlist
4845
4846 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4847 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4848 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4849 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4850
4851 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4852 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4853 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4854 and does not introduce a comment.
4855
4856 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4857 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4858 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4859 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4860 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4861
4862 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4863 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4864 change settings as required.
4865
4866 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4867 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4868 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4869 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4870 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4871 described.
4872
4873
4874
4875 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4876 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4877 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4878 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4879 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4880 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4881 using this syntax:
4882 .display
4883 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4884 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4885 .endd
4886 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4887 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4888 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4889 name is required.
4890
4891 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4892 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4893 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4894 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4895
4896 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4897 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4898 for example:
4899 .code
4900 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4901 .include /some/file
4902 .endd
4903 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4904 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4905 inclusion appears.
4906
4907
4908
4909 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4910 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4911 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4912 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4913 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4914 definition, and must be of the form
4915 .display
4916 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4917 .endd
4918 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4919 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4920 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4921 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4922 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4923
4924 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4925 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4926 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4927
4928 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4929 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4930 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4931 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4932 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4933 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4934 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4935 define
4936 .display
4937 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4938 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4939 .endd
4940 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4941 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4942 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4943 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4944 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4945 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4946
4947
4948 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4949 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4950 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4951 &'='&. For example:
4952 .code
4953 MAC = initial value
4954 ...
4955 MAC == updated value
4956 .endd
4957 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4958 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4959 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4960 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4961 .code
4962 MAC = initial value
4963 ...
4964 MAC == MAC and something added
4965 .endd
4966 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4967 from a number of other files.
4968
4969 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4970 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4971 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4972 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4973 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4974 file to be ignored.
4975
4976
4977
4978 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4979 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4980 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4981 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4982 .code
4983 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4984 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4985 .endd
4986 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4987 .code
4988 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4989 .endd
4990 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4991 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4992 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4993
4994
4995 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4996 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4997 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4998 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4999 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5000 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5001 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5002
5003 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5004 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5005 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5006 line. Thus:
5007 .code
5008 .ifdef AAA
5009 message_size_limit = 50M
5010 .else
5011 message_size_limit = 100M
5012 .endif
5013 .endd
5014 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
5015 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5016 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5017 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5018
5019 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5020 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5021 in this line"& will always be true.
5022
5023 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5024 to clarify complicated nestings.
5025
5026
5027
5028 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5029 .cindex "common option syntax"
5030 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5031 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5032 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5033 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5034 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5035 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5036 space) and then the value. For example:
5037 .code
5038 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5039 .endd
5040 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5041 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5042 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5043 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5044 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5045 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5046 word &"hide"&. For example:
5047 .code
5048 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5049 .endd
5050 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5051 .code
5052 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5053 .endd
5054 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5055 all instances of the same driver.
5056
5057 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5058 that are found in option settings.
5059
5060
5061 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5062 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5063 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5064 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5065 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5066 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5067 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5068 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5069 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5070 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5071 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5072 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5073 .code
5074 queue_only
5075 queue_only = true
5076 .endd
5077 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5078 .code
5079 no_queue_only
5080 queue_only = false
5081 .endd
5082 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5083
5084
5085
5086
5087 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5088 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5089 .cindex "format" "integer"
5090 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5091 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5092 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5093 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5094 hexadecimal number.
5095
5096 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5097 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5098 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5099 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5100 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5101 used.
5102
5103
5104 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5105 .cindex "integer format"
5106 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5107 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5108 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5109 Such options are always output in octal.
5110
5111
5112 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5113 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5114 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5115 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5116 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5117
5118
5119
5120 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5121 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5122 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5123 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5124 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5125
5126 .table2 30pt
5127 .irow &%s%& seconds
5128 .irow &%m%& minutes
5129 .irow &%h%& hours
5130 .irow &%d%& days
5131 .irow &%w%& weeks
5132 .endtable
5133
5134 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5135 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5136 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5137
5138
5139
5140 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5141 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5142 .cindex "format" "string"
5143 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5144 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5145 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5146 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5147 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5148 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5149 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5150 therefore equivalent:
5151 .code
5152 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5153 trusted_users = uucp:\
5154 # This comment line is ignored
5155 mail
5156 .endd
5157 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5158 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5159 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5160 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5161 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5162
5163 .table2 100pt
5164 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5165 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5166 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5167 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5168 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5169 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5170 character"
5171 .endtable
5172
5173 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5174 character, that character replaces the pair.
5175
5176 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5177 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5178 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5179 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5180 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5181 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5182
5183
5184 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5185 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5186 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5187 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5188 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5189 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5190 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5191 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5192 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5193 within a quoted configuration string.
5194
5195
5196 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5197 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5198 .cindex "format" "user name"
5199 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5200 .cindex "format" "group name"
5201 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5202 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5203 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5204 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5205
5206
5207 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5208 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5209 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5210 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5211 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5212 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5213 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5214 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5215 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5216 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5217 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5218
5219 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5220 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5221 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5222 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5223 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5224 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5225 example, the list
5226 .code
5227 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5228 .endd
5229 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5230
5231 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5232 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5233 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5234 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5235
5236 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5237 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5238 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5239 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5240 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5241 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5242 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5243 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5244 .code
5245 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5246 .endd
5247 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5248 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5249 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5250
5251 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5252 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5253 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5254 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5255 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5256 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5257 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5258 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5259 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5260 .code
5261 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5262 .endd
5263 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5264 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5265 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5266 the value in quotes. For example:
5267 .code
5268 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5269 .endd
5270 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5271 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5272 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5273 enclosing an empty list item.
5274
5275
5276
5277 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5278 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5279 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5280 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5281 .code
5282 senders = user@domain :
5283 .endd
5284 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5285 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5286 items, the second of which is empty:
5287 .code
5288 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5289 .endd
5290 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5291 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5292 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5293 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5294 .code
5295 senders = :
5296 .endd
5297 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5298 is at the end of the list.
5299
5300
5301
5302
5303 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5304 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5305 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5306 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5307 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5308 a sequence of lines like this:
5309 .display
5310 <&'instance name'&>:
5311 <&'option'&>
5312 ...
5313 <&'option'&>
5314 .endd
5315 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5316 followed by three options settings:
5317 .code
5318 localuser:
5319 driver = accept
5320 check_local_user
5321 transport = local_delivery
5322 .endd
5323 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5324 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5325 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5326 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5327 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5328 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5329
5330 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5331 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5332
5333 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5334 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5335 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5336 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5337 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5338 server.
5339
5340 .cindex "generic options"
5341 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5342 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5343 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5344 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5345 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5346 .cindex "private options"
5347 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5348 they all have default values.
5349
5350 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5351 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5352 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5353
5354 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5355 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5356 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5357 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5358 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5359 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5360 configuration lines:
5361 .code
5362 remote_smtp:
5363 driver = smtp
5364 .endd
5365 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5366 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5367 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5368 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5369 thus:
5370 .code
5371 special_smtp:
5372 driver = smtp
5373 port = 1234
5374 command_timeout = 10s
5375 .endd
5376 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5377 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5378 lines.
5379
5380 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5381 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5382 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5383 option.
5384
5385
5386
5387
5388
5389
5390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5391 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5392
5393 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5394 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5395 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5396 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5397 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5398 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5399 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5400 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5401 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5402 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5403 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5404
5405
5406
5407 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5408 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5409 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5410 the line
5411 .code
5412 # primary_hostname =
5413 .endd
5414 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5415 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5416 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5417 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5418
5419 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5420 .code
5421 domainlist local_domains = @
5422 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5423 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5424 .endd
5425 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5426 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5427 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5428 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5429
5430 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5431 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5432 on the local host.
5433
5434 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5435 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5436 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5437 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5438 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5439 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5440
5441 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5442 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5443 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5444 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5445 domain is permitted.
5446
5447 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5448 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5449 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5450 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5451 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5452 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5453
5454 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5455 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5456 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5457
5458 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5459 .code
5460 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5461 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5462 .endd
5463 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5464 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5465 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5466 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5467 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5468 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5469 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5470 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5471 contents of a message to be checked.
5472
5473 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5474 .code
5475 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5476 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5477 .endd
5478 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5479 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5480 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5481 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5482
5483 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5484 .code
5485 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5486 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5487 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5488 .endd
5489 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5490 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5491 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5492 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5493 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5494 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5495 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5496
5497 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5498 .code
5499 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5500 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5501 .endd
5502 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5503 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5504 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5505 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5506 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5507 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5508 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5509 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5510 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5511 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5512 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5513 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5514 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5515 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5516 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5517 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5518
5519 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5520 .code
5521 # qualify_domain =
5522 # qualify_recipient =
5523 .endd
5524 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5525 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5526 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5527 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5528 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5529 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5530
5531 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5532 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5533 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5534 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5535 .code
5536 # allow_domain_literals
5537 .endd
5538 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5539 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5540 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5541 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5542 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5543 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5544
5545 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5546 .code
5547 never_users = root
5548 .endd
5549 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5550 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5551 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5552 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5553 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5554 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5555 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5556 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5557
5558 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5559 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5560 line,
5561 .code
5562 host_lookup = *
5563 .endd
5564 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5565 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5566 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5567 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5568 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5569 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5570 unreachable.
5571
5572 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5573 1413 (hence their names):
5574 .code
5575 rfc1413_hosts = *
5576 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5577 .endd
5578 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5579 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5580 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5581 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5582 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5583 information, you can change this.
5584
5585 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5586 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5587 .code
5588 prdr_enable = true
5589 .endd
5590
5591 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5592 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5593 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5594 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5595 .code
5596 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5597 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5598 .endd
5599 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5600 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5601
5602 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5603 .code
5604 # percent_hack_domains =
5605 .endd
5606 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5607 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5608 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5609
5610 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5611 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5612 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5613 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5614 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5615 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5616 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5617 always bounce messages.
5618 .code
5619 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5620 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5621 .endd
5622 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5623 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5624 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5625 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5626 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5627
5628
5629
5630 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5631 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5632 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5633 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5634 It starts with the line
5635 .code
5636 begin acl
5637 .endd
5638 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5639 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5640 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5641
5642 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5643 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5644 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5645 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5646 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5647 result of the ACL processing.
5648 .code
5649 acl_check_rcpt:
5650 .endd
5651 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5652 ACL, and names it.
5653 .code
5654 accept hosts = :
5655 .endd
5656 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5657 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5658 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5659 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5660 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5661 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5662
5663 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5664 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5665 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5666 manner.
5667 .code
5668 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5669 domains = +local_domains
5670 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5671
5672 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5673 domains = !+local_domains
5674 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5675 .endd
5676 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5677 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5678 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5679 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5680 in Internet mail addresses.
5681
5682 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5683 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5684 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5685 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5686 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5687 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5688 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5689 policy of being as safe as possible.
5690
5691 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5692 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5693 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5694 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5695 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5696 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5697
5698 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5699 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5700 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5701 have to modify this rule.
5702
5703 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5704 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5705 common convention of local parts constructed as
5706 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5707 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5708 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5709 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5710 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5711 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5712
5713 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5714 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5715 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5716 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5717 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5718 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5719 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5720 .code
5721 accept local_parts = postmaster
5722 domains = +local_domains
5723 .endd
5724 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5725 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5726 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5727 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5728 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5729
5730 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5731 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5732 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5733 .code
5734 require verify = sender
5735 .endd
5736 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5737 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5738 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5739 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5740 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5741 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5742 discusses the details of address verification.
5743 .code
5744 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5745 control = submission
5746 .endd
5747 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5748 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5749 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5750 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5751 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5752 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5753 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5754 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5755 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5756 .code
5757 accept authenticated = *
5758 control = submission
5759 .endd
5760 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5761 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5762 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5763 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5764 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5765 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5766 .code
5767 require message = relay not permitted
5768 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5769 .endd
5770 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5771 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5772 .code
5773 require verify = recipient
5774 .endd
5775 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5776 fails, the address is rejected.
5777 .code
5778 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5779 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5780 # $dnslist_text
5781 # dnslists = black.list.example
5782 #
5783 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5784 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5785 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5786 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5787 .endd
5788 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5789 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5790 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5791 line.
5792 .code
5793 # require verify = csa
5794 .endd
5795 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5796 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5797 records.
5798 .code
5799 accept
5800 .endd
5801 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5802 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5803 .code
5804 acl_check_data:
5805 .endd
5806 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5807 of this ACL are commented out:
5808 .code
5809 # deny malware = *
5810 # message = This message contains a virus \
5811 # ($malware_name).
5812 .endd
5813 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5814 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5815 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5816 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5817 .code
5818 # warn spam = nobody
5819 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5820 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5821 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5822 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5823 .endd
5824 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5825 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5826 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5827 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5828 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5829 whatever the spam score.
5830 .code
5831 accept
5832 .endd
5833 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5834
5835
5836 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5837 .cindex "default" "routers"
5838 .cindex "routers" "default"
5839 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5840 by the line
5841 .code
5842 begin routers
5843 .endd
5844 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5845 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5846 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5847 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5848 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5849 .code
5850 # domain_literal:
5851 # driver = ipliteral
5852 # domains = !+local_domains
5853 # transport = remote_smtp
5854 .endd
5855 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5856 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5857 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5858 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5859 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5860 .code
5861 dnslookup:
5862 driver = dnslookup
5863 domains = ! +local_domains
5864 transport = remote_smtp
5865 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5866 no_more
5867 .endd
5868 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5869 domains. This is specified by the line
5870 .code
5871 domains = ! +local_domains
5872 .endd
5873 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5874 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5875 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5876 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5877 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5878 passed on to the following routers.
5879
5880 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5881 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5882 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5883 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5884 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5885
5886 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5887 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5888 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5889 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5890 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5891 the address fails and is bounced.
5892
5893 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5894 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5895 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5896 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5897 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5898 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5899 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5900 out.
5901 .code
5902 system_aliases:
5903 driver = redirect
5904 allow_fail
5905 allow_defer
5906 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5907 # user = exim
5908 file_transport = address_file
5909 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5910 .endd
5911 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5912 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5913 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5914 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5915 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5916 the next router.
5917
5918 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5919 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5920 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5921 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5922 .code
5923 userforward:
5924 driver = redirect
5925 check_local_user
5926 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5927 # local_part_suffix_optional
5928 file = $home/.forward
5929 # allow_filter
5930 no_verify
5931 no_expn
5932 check_ancestor
5933 file_transport = address_file
5934 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5935 reply_transport = address_reply
5936 .endd
5937 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5938 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5939 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5940 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5941 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5942 namely:
5943 .code
5944 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5945 # local_part_suffix_optional
5946 .endd
5947 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5948 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5949 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5950 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5951 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5952 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5953 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5954
5955 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5956 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5957 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5958 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5959
5960 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5961 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5962 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5963 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5964 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5965 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5966 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5967
5968 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5969 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5970 There are two reasons for doing this:
5971
5972 .olist
5973 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5974 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5975 unnecessary work.
5976 .next
5977 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5978 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5979 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5980 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5981 this time.
5982 .endlist
5983
5984 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5985 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5986 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5987 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5988
5989 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5990 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5991 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5992 .code
5993 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5994 .endd
5995 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5996 transport.
5997 .code
5998 localuser:
5999 driver = accept
6000 check_local_user
6001 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6002 # local_part_suffix_optional
6003 transport = local_delivery
6004 .endd
6005 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6006 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6007 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6008 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6009 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6010
6011
6012 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6013 .cindex "default" "transports"
6014 .cindex "transports" "default"
6015 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6016 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6017 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6018 .code
6019 begin transports
6020 .endd
6021 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6022 .code
6023 remote_smtp:
6024 driver = smtp
6025 hosts_try_prdr = *
6026 .endd
6027 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6028 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6029 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6030 It is negotiated between client and server
6031 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6032 All other options are defaulted.
6033 .code
6034 local_delivery:
6035 driver = appendfile
6036 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6037 delivery_date_add
6038 envelope_to_add
6039 return_path_add
6040 # group = mail
6041 # mode = 0660
6042 .endd
6043 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6044 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6045 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6046 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6047 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6048 show how this can be done.
6049
6050 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6051 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6052 similarly-named options above.
6053 .code
6054 address_pipe:
6055 driver = pipe
6056 return_output
6057 .endd
6058 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6059 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6060 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6061 sender.
6062 .code
6063 address_file:
6064 driver = appendfile
6065 delivery_date_add
6066 envelope_to_add
6067 return_path_add
6068 .endd
6069 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6070 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6071 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6072 .code
6073 address_reply:
6074 driver = autoreply
6075 .endd
6076 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6077 filter files.
6078
6079
6080
6081 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6082 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6083 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6084 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6085 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6086 introduced by the line
6087 .code
6088 begin retry
6089 .endd
6090 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6091 errors:
6092 .code
6093 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6094 .endd
6095 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6096 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6097 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6098 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6099
6100 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6101 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6102 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6103
6104
6105 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6106 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6107 .code
6108 begin rewrite
6109 .endd
6110 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6111 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6112
6113
6114
6115 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6116 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6117 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6118 .code
6119 begin authenticators
6120 .endd
6121 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6122 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6123 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6124 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6125 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6126 to support most MUA software.
6127
6128 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6129 .code
6130 #PLAIN:
6131 # driver = plaintext
6132 # server_set_id = $auth2
6133 # server_prompts = :
6134 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6135 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6136 .endd
6137 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6138 .code
6139 #LOGIN:
6140 # driver = plaintext
6141 # server_set_id = $auth1
6142 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6143 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6144 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6145 .endd
6146
6147 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6148 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6149 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6150 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6151 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6152 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6153 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6154 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6155
6156 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6157 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6158 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6159 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6160
6161 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6162 usercode and password are in different positions.
6163 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6164
6165 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6166
6167
6168
6169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6171
6172 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6173
6174 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6175 .cindex "PCRE"
6176 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6177 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6178 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6179 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6180 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6181 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6182
6183 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6184 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6185 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6186 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6187 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6188 case-insensitive.
6189
6190 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6191 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6192 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6193 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6194 .code
6195 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6196 .endd
6197 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6198 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6199 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6200 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6201 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6202 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6203 matched.
6204
6205 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6206 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6207 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6208 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6209 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6210 match anywhere in the subject string.
6211
6212 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6213 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6214 .code
6215 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6216 .endd
6217 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6218 You need to use:
6219 .code
6220 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6221 .endd
6222 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6223 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6224
6225
6226
6227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6229
6230 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6231 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6232 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6233 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6234 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6235 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6236
6237 .olist
6238 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6239 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6240 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6241 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6242 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6243 .next
6244 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6245 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6246 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6247 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6248 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6249 .endlist
6250
6251 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6252 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6253 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6254 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6255 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6256 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6257
6258 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6259 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6260 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6261 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6262 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6263 .code
6264 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6265 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6266 .endd
6267 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6268 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6269 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6270 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6271 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6272 .code
6273 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6274 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6275 .endd
6276 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6277 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6278
6279 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6280 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6281 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6282 .code
6283 domain1:
6284 domain2:
6285 .endd
6286 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6287 matches the list item.
6288
6289 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6290 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6291 .code
6292 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6293 .endd
6294 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6295 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6296 causes a second lookup to occur.
6297
6298 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6299 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6300 lookup is permitted.
6301
6302
6303 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6304 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6305 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6306 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6307
6308 .ilist
6309 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6310 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6311 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6312 .next
6313 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6314 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6315 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6316 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6317 .endlist
6318
6319 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6320 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6321 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6322 .code
6323 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6324 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6325 .endd
6326 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6327 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6328 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6329
6330
6331
6332
6333 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6334 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6335 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6336 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6337
6338 .ilist
6339 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6340 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6341 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6342 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6343 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6344 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6345 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6346 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6347 be found in several places:
6348 .display
6349 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6350 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6351 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6352 .endd
6353 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6354 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6355 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6356 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6357 .next
6358 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6359 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6360 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6361 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6362 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6363 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6364 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6365
6366 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6367 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6368 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6369 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6370 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6371 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6372 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6373 .next
6374 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6375 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6376 .cindex "sasldb2"
6377 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6378 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6379 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6380 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6381 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6382 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6383 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6384 .next
6385 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6386 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6387 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6388 .cindex "Courier"
6389 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6390 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6391 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6392 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6393 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6394 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6395 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6396 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6397 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6398 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6399 .next
6400 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6401 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6402 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6403 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6404 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6405 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6406 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6407 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6408 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6409 .next
6410 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6411 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6412 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6413 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6414 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6415 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6416 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6417 .code
6418 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6419 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6420 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6421 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6422 .endd
6423 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6424 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6425 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6426 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6427 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6428
6429 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6430 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6431 lookup types support only literal keys.
6432
6433 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6434 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6435 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6436 .next
6437 .cindex "linear search"
6438 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6439 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6440 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6441 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6442 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6443 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6444 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6445 in the file is used.
6446
6447 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6448 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6449 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6450 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6451 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6452 colon, for example:
6453 .code
6454 baduser: :fail:
6455 .endd
6456 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6457 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6458 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6459 wildcarding of any kind.
6460
6461 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6462 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6463 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6464 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6465 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6466 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6467 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6468 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6469 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6470
6471 .next
6472 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6473 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6474 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6475 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6476 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6477 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6478 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6479 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6480
6481 .next
6482 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6483 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6484 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6485 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6486 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6487 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6488 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6489 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6490 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6491
6492 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6493 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6494 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6495 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6496
6497 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6498 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6499
6500 .olist
6501 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6502 .code
6503 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6504 *fish data for anythingfish
6505 .endd
6506 .next
6507 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6508 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6509 .code
6510 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6511 .endd
6512 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6513 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6514 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6515 .code
6516 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6517 .endd
6518 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6519 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6520 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6521 .code
6522 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6523 .endd
6524
6525 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6526 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6527 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6528 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6529 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6530
6531 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6532 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6533 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6534 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6535 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6536
6537 .next
6538 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6539 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6540 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6541 example:
6542 .code
6543 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6544 .endd
6545 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6546 .endlist olist
6547
6548 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6549 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6550 be followed by optional colons.
6551
6552 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6553 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6554 lookup types support only literal keys.
6555 .endlist ilist
6556
6557
6558 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6559 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6560 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6561 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6562 many of them are given in later sections.
6563
6564 .ilist
6565 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6566 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6567 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6568 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6569 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6570 .next
6571 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6572 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6573 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6574 .next
6575 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6576 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6577 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6578 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6579 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6580 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6581 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6582 .next
6583 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6584 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6585 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6586 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6587 .next
6588 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6589 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6590 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6591 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6592 .next
6593 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6594 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6595 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6596 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6597 .next
6598 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6599 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6600 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6601 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6602 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6603 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6604 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6605 password value. For example:
6606 .code
6607 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6608 .endd
6609 .next
6610 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6611 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6612 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6613 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6614
6615 .next
6616 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6617 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6618 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6619 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6620
6621 .next
6622 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6623 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6624 .next
6625 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6626 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6627 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6628 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6629 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6630 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6631 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6632 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6633 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6634 .code
6635 require condition = \
6636 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6637 .endd
6638 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6639 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6640 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6641 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6642 .endlist
6643
6644
6645
6646 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6647 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6648 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6649 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6650 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6651 options such as a list of local domains.
6652
6653 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6654 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6655 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6656 or may give up altogether.
6657
6658
6659
6660 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6661 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6662 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6663 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6664 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6665 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6666 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6667 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6668
6669 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6670 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6671 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6672
6673 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6674 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6675 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6676
6677 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6678 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6679 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6680 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6681 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6682 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6683 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6684 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6685 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6686 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6687 .code
6688 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6689 .endd
6690 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6691 looks up these keys, in this order:
6692 .code
6693 jane@eyre.example
6694 *@eyre.example
6695 *
6696 .endd
6697 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6698 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6699 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6700 Exim move on to try the next key.
6701
6702
6703
6704 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6705 .cindex "partial matching"
6706 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6707 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6708 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6709 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6710 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6711 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6712 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6713 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6714 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6715 a key in a DBM file is
6716 .code
6717 *.dates.fict.example
6718 .endd
6719 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6720 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6721 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6722 file.
6723
6724 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6725 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6726 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6727
6728 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6729 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6730 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6731 partial matching keys
6732 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6733 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6734 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6735
6736 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6737 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6738 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6739 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6740 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6741 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6742 remains.
6743
6744 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6745 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6746 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6747 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6748 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6749 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6750 .code
6751 2250.dates.fict.example
6752 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6753 *.dates.fict.example
6754 *.fict.example
6755 .endd
6756 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6757 finishes.
6758
6759 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6760 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6761 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6762 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6763 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6764 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6765 .code
6766 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6767 .endd
6768 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6769 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6770 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6771 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6772 .code
6773 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6774 .endd
6775 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6776 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6777
6778 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6779 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6780 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6781
6782 .ilist
6783 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6784 .next
6785 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6786 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6787 .next
6788 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6789 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6790 for &"*"& on its own.
6791 .next
6792 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6793 .endlist
6794
6795
6796 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6797 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6798 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6799 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6800 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6801 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6802 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6803
6804 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6805 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6806 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6807 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6808 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6809
6810
6811
6812
6813 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6814 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6815 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6816 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6817 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6818 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6819 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6820
6821 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6822 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6823 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6824 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6825 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6826 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6827
6828 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6829 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6830 complete.
6831
6832
6833
6834
6835 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6836 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6837 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6838 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6839 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6840 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6841 .code
6842 [name=$local_part]
6843 .endd
6844 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6845 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6846 .code
6847 [name="$local_part"]
6848 .endd
6849 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6850 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6851 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6852 of the following form is provided:
6853 .code
6854 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6855 .endd
6856 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6857 .code
6858 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6859 .endd
6860 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6861 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6862 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6863
6864
6865
6866
6867 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6868 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6869 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6870 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6871 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6872 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6873 an expansion string could contain:
6874 .code
6875 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6876 .endd
6877 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6878 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6879 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6880 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6881
6882 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, TLSA and TXT,
6883 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6884 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6885 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6886 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6887 .code
6888 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6889 .endd
6890 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6891 altered and nothing is added.
6892
6893 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6894 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6895 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6896 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6897 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6898 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6899 .code
6900 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6901 .endd
6902 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6903 white space is ignored.
6904
6905 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6906 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6907 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6908 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6909 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6910 An alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6911 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6912
6913 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6914 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6915 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6916 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6917 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6918 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6919 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6920 .code
6921 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6922 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6923 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6924 .endd
6925 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6926 white space is ignored.
6927
6928 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6929 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6930 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6931 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6932 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6933 each followed by a comma,
6934 that may appear before the record type.
6935
6936 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6937 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6938 a defer-option modifier.
6939 The possible keywords are
6940 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6941 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6942 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6943 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6944 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6945 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6946 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6947 .code
6948 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6949 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6950 .endd
6951 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6952 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6953
6954 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6955 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6956 The possible keywords are
6957 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6958 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6959 with the lookup.
6960 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6961 is not labelled as authenticated data
6962 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6963 The default is &"never"&.
6964
6965 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6966
6967
6968 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6969 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6970 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6971 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6972 the pseudo-type MXH:
6973 .code
6974 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6975 .endd
6976 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6977 returned.
6978
6979 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6980 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6981 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6982 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6983 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6984 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6985 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6986 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6987 .code
6988 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6989 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6990 .endd
6991 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6992 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6993 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6994
6995 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6996 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6997 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6998 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6999 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7000 such a list.
7001
7002 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7003 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7004 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7005 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7006 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7007 result of a successful lookup such as:
7008 .code
7009 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7010 .endd
7011 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7012 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7013 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7014
7015 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7016 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
7017 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7018 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7019 .code
7020 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7021 .endd
7022
7023
7024 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7025 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7026 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7027 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7028 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7029 .code
7030 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7031 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7032 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7033 .endd
7034 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7035 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7036 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7037 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7038
7039 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7040 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7041 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7042
7043
7044
7045
7046 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7047 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7048 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7049 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7050 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7051 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7052 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7053 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7054 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7055 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7056 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7057 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7058 .code
7059 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7060 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7061 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7062 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7063 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7064 .endd
7065 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7066 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7067
7068 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7069 the way they handle the results of a query:
7070
7071 .ilist
7072 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7073 gives an error.
7074 .next
7075 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7076 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7077 .next
7078 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7079 from all of them are returned.
7080 .endlist
7081
7082
7083 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7084 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7085 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7086 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7087
7088
7089 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7090 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7091 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7092 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7093 .code
7094 data = ${lookup ldap \
7095 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7096 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7097 .endd
7098 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7099 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7100 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7101 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7102
7103 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7104 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7105 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7106
7107 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7108 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7109 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7110 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7111 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7112 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7113 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7114 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7115 &_exim.conf_&.
7116
7117
7118 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7119 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7120 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7121 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7122 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7123 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7124
7125 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7126 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7127 the string:
7128 .code
7129 * => \2A
7130 ( => \28
7131 ) => \29
7132 \ => \5C
7133 .endd
7134 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7135 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7136 .code
7137 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7138 .endd
7139 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7140 .code
7141 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7142 .endd
7143 yields
7144 .code
7145 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7146 .endd
7147 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7148 .code
7149 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7150 .endd
7151 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7152 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7153 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7154 .code
7155 , + " \ < > ;
7156 .endd
7157 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7158 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7159 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7160 .code
7161 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7162 .endd
7163 yields
7164 .code
7165 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7166 .endd
7167 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7168 .code
7169 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7170 .endd
7171 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7172 authentication below.
7173
7174
7175 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7176 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7177 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7178 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7179 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7180 by starting it with
7181 .code
7182 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7183 .endd
7184 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7185 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7186 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7187 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7188 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7189 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7190 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7191 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7192 failures, and timeouts.
7193
7194 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7195 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7196 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7197 doubled. For example
7198 .code
7199 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7200 .endd
7201 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7202 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7203 the local host) is used.
7204
7205 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7206 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7207 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7208 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7209 not available.
7210
7211 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7212 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7213 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7214 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7215 .code
7216 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7217 .endd
7218 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7219 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7220 .code
7221 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7222 .endd
7223 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7224 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7225 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7226 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7227 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7228 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7229 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7230 backup host.
7231
7232 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7233 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7234 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7235
7236 .ilist
7237 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7238 interface.
7239 .next
7240 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7241 .endlist
7242
7243
7244 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7245 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7246
7247
7248
7249 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7250 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7251 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7252 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7253 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7254 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7255 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7256 them. The following names are recognized:
7257 .display
7258 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7259 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7260 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7261 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7262 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7263 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7264 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7265 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7266 .endd
7267 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7268 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7269 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7270 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7271
7272 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7273 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7274 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7275 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7276 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7277 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7278 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7279 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7280 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7281
7282 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7283 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7284
7285 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7286 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7287 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7288 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7289 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7290 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7291 alternate list (colon-separated).
7292
7293 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7294 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7295 .code
7296 ${lookup ldap
7297 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7298 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7299 {$value}fail}
7300 .endd
7301 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7302 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7303 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7304 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7305
7306 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7307 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7308 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7309
7310 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7311 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7312 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7313 quoting has two advantages:
7314
7315 .ilist
7316 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7317 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7318 .next
7319 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7320 .endlist
7321
7322 For example, a setting such as
7323 .code
7324 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7325 .endd
7326 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7327
7328 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7329 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7330 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7331 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7332 .code
7333 PASS=${quote:$3}
7334 .endd
7335 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7336 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7337 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7338
7339
7340
7341 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7342 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7343 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7344 as a sequence of values, for example
7345 .code
7346 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7347 .endd
7348 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7349 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7350 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7351 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7352 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7353 directory.
7354
7355 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7356 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7357 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7358
7359 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7360 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7361 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7362 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7363 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7364 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7365 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7366 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7367 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7368
7369 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7370 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7371 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7372 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7373 .code
7374 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7375 value1.1,value1,,2
7376
7377 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7378 value two
7379
7380 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7381 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7382
7383 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7384 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7385 .endd
7386 You can
7387 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7388 results of LDAP lookups.
7389 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7390 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7391 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7392 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7393 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7394 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7395
7396
7397
7398
7399 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7400 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7401 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7402 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7403 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7404 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7405 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7406 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7407 .code
7408 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7409 .endd
7410 might return the string
7411 .code
7412 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7413 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7414 .endd
7415 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7416 .code
7417 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7418 .endd
7419 would just return
7420 .code
7421 Martin Guerre
7422 .endd
7423 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7424 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7425 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7426
7427
7428
7429 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7430 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7431 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7432 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7433 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7434 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7435 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7436 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7437 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7438 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7439 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7440 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7441 might be
7442 .code
7443 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7444 {$value}fail}
7445 .endd
7446 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7447 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7448 .code
7449 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7450 {$value}}
7451 .endd
7452 might be
7453 .code
7454 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7455 .endd
7456 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7457 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7458 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7459 .code
7460 Mister X
7461 .endd
7462 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7463 with a newline between the data for each row.
7464
7465
7466 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7467 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7468 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7469 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7470 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7471 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7472 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7473 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7475 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7476 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7477 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7478 information.
7479 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7480 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7481 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7482 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7483 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7484 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7485 .code
7486 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7487 .endd
7488 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7489 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7490 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7491 .code
7492 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7493 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7494 .endd
7495 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7496 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7497 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7498 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7499 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7500 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7501
7502 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7503 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7504 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7505 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7506 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7507 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7508 characters are not special.
7509
7510 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7511 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7512 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7513 done by starting the query with
7514 .display
7515 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7516 .endd
7517 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7518 .olist
7519 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7520 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7521 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7522 taken from there.
7523 .next
7524 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7525 .endlist
7526 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7527 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7528 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7529
7530 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7531 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7532 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7533 like this:
7534 .code
7535 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7536 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7537 master/db/name/pw
7538 .endd
7539 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7540 .code
7541 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7542 .endd
7543 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7544 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7545 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7546 .code
7547 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7548 .endd
7549
7550
7551 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7552 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7553 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7554 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7555 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7556 .display
7557 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7558 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7559 .endd
7560 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7561 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7562
7563 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7564 the queries.
7565
7566 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7567 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7568
7569 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7570 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7571 is zero because no rows are affected.
7572
7573
7574 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7575 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7576 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7577 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7578 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7579 looks like this:
7580 .code
7581 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7582 .endd
7583 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7584 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7585 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7586
7587 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7588 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7589 affected.
7590
7591 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7592 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7593 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7594 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7595 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7596 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7597 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7598 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7599 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7600 .code
7601 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7602 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7603 .endd
7604 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7605 .code
7606 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7607 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7608 .endd
7609 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7610 quote, which it doubles.
7611
7612 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7613 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7614 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7615 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7616 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7617 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7618 option.
7619 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7620 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7621
7622
7623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7625
7626 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7627 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7628 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7629 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7630 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7631 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7632 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7633 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7634 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7635
7636 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7637 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7638 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7639 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7640
7641
7642
7643 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7644 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7645 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7646 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7647 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7648 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7649 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7650 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7651
7652
7653 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7654 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7655 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7656
7657 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7658 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7659 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7660 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7661 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7662 .code
7663 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7664 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7665 .endd
7666 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7667 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7668 senders based on the receiving domain.
7669
7670
7671
7672
7673 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7674 .cindex "list" "negation"
7675 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7676 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7677 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7678 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7679 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7680 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7681
7682 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7683 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7684 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7685 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7686 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7687 .code
7688 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7689 .endd
7690 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7691 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7692 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7693 .code
7694 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7695 .endd
7696 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7697 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7698 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7699
7700 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7701 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7702 item.
7703
7704
7705
7706 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7707 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7708 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7709 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7710 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7711 file names are not allowed,
7712 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7713 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7714 lines:
7715
7716 .ilist
7717 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7718 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7719 .next
7720 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7721 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7722 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7723 .code
7724 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7725 .endd
7726 .endlist
7727
7728 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7729 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7730 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7731 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7732
7733 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7734 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7735 .code
7736 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7737 .endd
7738 and the file contains the lines
7739 .code
7740 !a.b.c
7741 *.b.c
7742 .endd
7743 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7744 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7745
7746
7747
7748 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7749 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7750 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7751 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7752 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7753 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7754 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7755 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7756
7757 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7758 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7759 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7760 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7761
7762
7763
7764
7765 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7766 .cindex "named lists"
7767 .cindex "list" "named"
7768 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7769 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7770 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7771 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7772 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7773 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7774 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7775 .code
7776 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7777 .endd
7778 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7779 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7780 configured with the line
7781 .code
7782 domains = +local_domains
7783 .endd
7784 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7785 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7786 .code
7787 dnslookup:
7788 driver = dnslookup
7789 domains = ! +local_domains
7790 transport = remote_smtp
7791 no_more
7792 .endd
7793 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7794 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7795 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7796 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7797 .code
7798 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7799 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7800 .endd
7801 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7802 .code
7803 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7804 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7805 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7806 .endd
7807 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7808 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7809 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7810 .code
7811 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7812 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7813 .endd
7814 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7815 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7816 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7817 .code
7818 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7819 .endd
7820 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7821 referenced lists if you can.
7822
7823 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7824 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7825 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7826 .code
7827 domains = +local_domains
7828 .endd
7829 on several of your routers
7830 or in several ACL statements,
7831 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7832 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7833 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7834 the same each time they are referenced.
7835
7836 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7837 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7838 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7839 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7840
7841
7842
7843 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7844 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7845 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7846 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7847 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7848 write
7849 .code
7850 ALIST = host1 : host2
7851 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7852 .endd
7853 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7854 .code
7855 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7856 .endd
7857 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7858 list, and write
7859 .code
7860 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7861 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7862 .endd
7863 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7864 .code
7865 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7866 .endd
7867
7868
7869 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7870 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7871 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7872 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7873 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7874 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7875 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7876 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7877 message. For example:
7878 .code
7879 domainlist special_domains = \
7880 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7881 .endd
7882 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7883 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7884 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7885 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7886 same list each time.
7887
7888 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7889 cache the result anyway. For example:
7890 .code
7891 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7892 .endd
7893 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7894 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7895
7896
7897
7898 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7899 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7900 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7901 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7902 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7903
7904 .ilist
7905 .cindex "primary host name"
7906 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7907 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7908 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7909 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7910 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7911 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7912 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7913 differ only in their names.
7914 .next
7915 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7916 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7917 .cindex "domain literal"
7918 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7919 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7920 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7921 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7922 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7923 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7924 .next
7925 .cindex "@mx_any"
7926 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7927 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7928 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7929 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7930 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7931 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7932 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7933 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7934 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7935 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7936 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7937
7938 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7939 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7940 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7941 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7942 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7943
7944 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7945 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7946 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7947 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7948 on a router). For example:
7949 .code
7950 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7951 .endd
7952 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7953 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7954
7955 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7956 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7957 contain negative items.
7958
7959 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7960 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7961 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7962 .code
7963 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7964 an.other.domain : ...
7965 .endd
7966 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7967 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7968 .code
7969 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7970 an.other.domain ? ...
7971 .endd
7972 .next
7973 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7974 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7975 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7976 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7977 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7978 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7979 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7980 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7981 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7982 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7983
7984 .next
7985 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7986 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7987 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7988 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7989 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7990 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7991 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7992 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7993 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7994
7995 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7996 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7997 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7998 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7999 expression by expansion, of course).
8000 .next
8001 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8002 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8003 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8004 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8005 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8006 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8007 .code
8008 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8009 .endd
8010 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8011 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8012 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8013 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8014 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8015 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8016 other statements in the same ACL.
8017
8018 .next
8019 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8020 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8021 .code
8022 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8023 .endd
8024 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8025 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8026
8027 .next
8028 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8029 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8030 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8031 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8032 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8033 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8034 expansion variable.
8035 .next
8036 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8037 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8038 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8039 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8040 .code
8041 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8042 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8043 .endd
8044 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8045 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8046 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8047 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8048 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8049 .next
8050 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8051 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8052 between the pattern and the domain.
8053 .endlist
8054
8055 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8056 .code
8057 domainlist funny_domains = \
8058 @ : \
8059 lib.unseen.edu : \
8060 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8061 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8062 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8063 nis;domains.byname : \
8064 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8065 .endd
8066 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8067 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8068 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8069 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8070 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8071 patterns earlier.
8072
8073
8074
8075 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8076 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8077 .cindex "list" "host list"
8078 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8079 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8080 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8081 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8082 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8083 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8084 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8085
8086
8087 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8088 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8089 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8090 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8091 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8092 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8093 not used.
8094
8095 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8096 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8097 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8098
8099
8100
8101 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8102 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8103 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8104 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8105 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8106 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8107 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8108 concerns.)
8109
8110 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8111 inspecting its IP address:
8112
8113 .ilist
8114 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8115 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8116 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8117 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8118 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8119 with the IP address of the subject host.
8120
8121 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8122 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8123 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8124 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8125 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8126
8127 .next
8128 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8129 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8130 domain name, as just described.
8131
8132 .next
8133 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8134 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8135 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8136 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8137 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8138 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8139 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8140 that can never match a client host.
8141
8142 .next
8143 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8144 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8145 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8146 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8147 .code
8148 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8149 accept hosts = @[]
8150 .endd
8151 .next
8152 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8153 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8154 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8155 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8156 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8157 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8158 significant end of the address.
8159
8160 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8161 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8162 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8163 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8164 .code
8165 192.168.23.236/31
8166 .endd
8167 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8168 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8169 matches.
8170
8171 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8172 .code
8173 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8174 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8175 .endd
8176 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8177 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8178 For example:
8179 .code
8180 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8181 .endd
8182 could make use of a file containing
8183 .code
8184 172.16.0.0/12
8185 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8186 .endd
8187 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8188 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8189 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8190 .code
8191 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8192 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8193 .endd
8194 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8195 list.
8196 .endlist
8197
8198
8199
8200 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8201 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8202 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8203 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8204 address, the pattern takes this form:
8205 .display
8206 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8207 .endd
8208 For example:
8209 .code
8210 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8211 .endd
8212 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8213 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8214 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8215 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8216 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8217 returned by the lookup is not used.
8218
8219 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8220 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8221 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8222 patterns of this form:
8223 .display
8224 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8225 .endd
8226 For example:
8227 .code
8228 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8229 .endd
8230 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8231 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8232 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8233 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8234 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8235
8236 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8237 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8238 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8239 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8240 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8241 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8242 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8243 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8244 addresses are always used.
8245
8246 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8247 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8248 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8249 configurations.
8250
8251 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8252 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8253 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8254 case the IP address is used on its own.
8255
8256
8257
8258 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8259 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8260 .cindex "unknown host name"
8261 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8262 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8263 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8264 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8265 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8266 above.)
8267
8268 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8269 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8270 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8271 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8272 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8273 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8274 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8275
8276 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8277 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8278
8279 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8280 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8281 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8282 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8283 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8284 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8285 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8286 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8287 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8288
8289 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8290 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8291
8292 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8293 .cindex "alias for host"
8294 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8295 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8296
8297 .ilist
8298 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8299 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8300 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8301 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8302 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8303 expression.
8304 .next
8305 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8306 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8307 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8308 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8309 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8310 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8311 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8312 example,
8313 .code
8314 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8315 .endd
8316 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8317 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8318 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8319 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8320 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8321 .code
8322 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8323 .endd
8324 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8325 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8326 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8327 required.
8328 .endlist
8329
8330
8331
8332
8333 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8334 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8335 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8336 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8337 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8338 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8339
8340 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8341 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8342
8343 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8344 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8345 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8346 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8347 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8348 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8349 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8350 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8351 not recognized in an indirected file).
8352
8353 .ilist
8354 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8355 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8356 .code
8357 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8358 .endd
8359 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8360 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8361
8362 .next
8363 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8364 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8365 example:
8366 .code
8367 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8368 192.168.4.5
8369 .endd
8370 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8371 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8372 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8373 .endlist
8374
8375 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8376 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8377 list.
8378
8379 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8380 "SECTmixwilhos"
8381 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8382
8383 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8384 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8385 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8386
8387 .ilist
8388 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8389 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8390 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8391 .code
8392 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8393 .endd
8394 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8395 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8396 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8397 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8398 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8399 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8400 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8401
8402 .next
8403 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8404 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8405 .code
8406 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8407 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8408 .endd
8409 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8410 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8411 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8412 this section.
8413 .endlist
8414
8415
8416 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8417 "SECTtemdnserr"
8418 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8419 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8420 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8421 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8422 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8423 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8424 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8425 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8426 host lists such as whitelists.
8427
8428
8429
8430 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8431 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8432 .cindex "unknown host name"
8433 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8434 If a pattern is of the form
8435 .display
8436 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8437 .endd
8438 for example
8439 .code
8440 dbm;/host/accept/list
8441 .endd
8442 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8443 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8444 is not used.
8445
8446 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8447 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8448 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8449 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8450 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8451 lookup, both using the same file.
8452
8453
8454
8455 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8456 If a pattern is of the form
8457 .display
8458 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8459 .endd
8460 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8461 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8462 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8463 .code
8464 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8465 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8466 .endd
8467 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8468 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8469 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8470 operator.
8471
8472 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8473 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8474 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8475
8476 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8477 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8478 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8479 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8480 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8481 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8482
8483
8484
8485
8486
8487 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8488 .cindex "list" "address list"
8489 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8490 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8491 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8492 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8493 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8494 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8495 using this option setting:
8496 .code
8497 senders = :
8498 .endd
8499 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8500 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8501 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8502 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8503
8504 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8505 example:
8506 .code
8507 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8508 .endd
8509 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8510 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8511 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8512 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8513 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8514 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8515 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8516 .code
8517 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8518 *@+hostile_domains:\
8519 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8520 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8521 .endd
8522 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8523 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8524 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8525 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8526 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8527
8528 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8529 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8530 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8531 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8532 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8533 .code
8534 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8535 .endd
8536
8537 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8538 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8539 senders:
8540
8541 .ilist
8542 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8543 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8544 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8545 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8546 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8547 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8548 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8549 .code
8550 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8551 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8552 .endd
8553 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8554 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8555
8556 .next
8557 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8558 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8559 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8560 example:
8561 .code
8562 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8563 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8564 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8565 .endd
8566 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8567 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8568 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8569 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8570
8571 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8572 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8573 panic log.
8574 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8575 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8576 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8577 default. For example, with this lookup:
8578 .code
8579 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8580 .endd
8581 the file could contains lines like this:
8582 .code
8583 user1@domain1.example
8584 *@domain2.example
8585 .endd
8586 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8587 that are tried is:
8588 .code
8589 nimrod@jaeger.example
8590 *@jaeger.example
8591 *
8592 .endd
8593 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8594 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8595
8596 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8597 .code
8598 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8599 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8600 .endd
8601 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8602 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8603 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8604 .endlist
8605
8606
8607 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8608 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8609 always fails.
8610
8611
8612 .ilist
8613 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8614 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8615 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8616 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8617 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8618 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8619 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8620 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8621 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8622
8623 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8624 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8625 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8626 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8627 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8628 with
8629 .code
8630 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8631 .endd
8632 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8633 .code
8634 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8635 .endd
8636 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8637
8638 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8639 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8640 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8641 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8642 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8643 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8644 .code
8645 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8646 spammer3 : spammer4
8647 .endd
8648 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8649 doubling.
8650
8651 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8652 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8653 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8654 might have entries like
8655 .code
8656 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8657 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8658 *: ^\d{8}$
8659 .endd
8660 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8661 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8662 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8663 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8664
8665 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8666 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8667 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8668
8669 .next
8670 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8671 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8672 can only return a single list of local parts.
8673 .endlist
8674
8675 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8676 in these two examples:
8677 .code
8678 senders = +my_list
8679 senders = *@+my_list
8680 .endd
8681 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8682 example it is a named domain list.
8683
8684
8685
8686
8687 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8688 .cindex "case of local parts"
8689 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8690 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8691 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8692 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8693 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8694 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8695 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8696 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8697 default.
8698
8699 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8700 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8701 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8702 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8703 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8704 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8705 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8706 case-independent.
8707
8708 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8709 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8710 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8711 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8712 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8713 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8714 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8715 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8716
8717
8718
8719 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8720 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8721 .cindex "local part" "list"
8722 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8723 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8724 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8725 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8726 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8727 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8728 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8729 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8730
8731 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8732 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8733 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8734 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8735 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8736 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8737 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8738 types.
8739 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8740
8741
8742
8743
8744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8746
8747 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8748 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8749 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8750 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8751
8752 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8753 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8754 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8755 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8756 escape character, as described in the following section.
8757
8758 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8759 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8760 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8761 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8762 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8763 reasons.
8764
8765
8766
8767 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8768 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8769 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8770 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8771 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8772 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8773 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8774 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8775
8776 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8777 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8778 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8779 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8780 .code
8781 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8782 .endd
8783 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8784 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8785 string.
8786
8787
8788
8789 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8790 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8791 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8792 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8793 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8794 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8795 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8796 encoding.
8797
8798 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8799 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8800 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8801
8802
8803 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8804 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8805 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8806 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8807 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8808 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8809 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8810 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8811 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8812 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8813 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8814 and &%nhash%&.
8815
8816 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8817 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8818 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8819
8820 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8821 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8822 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8823 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8824 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8825 .code
8826 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8827 .endd
8828 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8829 Exim message identifier. For example:
8830 .code
8831 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8832 .endd
8833 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8834 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8835
8836
8837 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8838 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8839 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8840 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8841 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8842 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8843 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8844 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8845 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8846 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8847 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8848 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8849 being expanded.
8850
8851
8852
8853
8854 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8855 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8856 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8857 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8858 white space is significant.
8859
8860 .vlist
8861 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8862 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8863 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8864 .code
8865 $local_part
8866 ${domain}
8867 .endd
8868 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8869 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8870 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8871 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8872 given, the expansion fails.
8873
8874 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8875 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8876 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8877 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8878 .code
8879 ${lc:$local_part}
8880 .endd
8881 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8882 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8883 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8884 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8885 string easier to understand.
8886
8887 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8888 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8889 expansion item below.
8890
8891
8892 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8893 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8894 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8895 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8896 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8897 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8898 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8899 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8900 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8901 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8902 the result of the expansion.
8903 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8904 the expansion result is an empty string.
8905 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8906
8907
8908 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8909 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8910 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8911 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8912 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8913 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8914 The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8915 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8916 .display
8917 &`version `&
8918 &`serial_number `&
8919 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8920 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8921 &`notbefore `& time
8922 &`notafter `& time
8923 &`sig_algorithm `&
8924 &`signature `&
8925 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8926 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8927 &`crl_uri `& list
8928 .endd
8929 If the field is found,
8930 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8931 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8932 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8933 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8934
8935 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8936 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8937 extracted is used.
8938
8939 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8940
8941 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8942 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8943 not quite
8944 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8945 (the exceptions being elements containin commas).
8946 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8947 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8948 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8949 The separator may be changed by another modifer of
8950 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8951 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8952
8953 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8954 take an optional modifier of "int"
8955 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
8956 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
8957 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
8958
8959 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
8960 newline-separated by default,
8961 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
8962 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
8963 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8964
8965 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
8966 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
8967 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
8968 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
8969 if so the elenment tags are omitted.
8970
8971 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
8972
8973 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8974 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8975 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8976 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8977 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8978 .code
8979 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8980 .endd
8981 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8982 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8983 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8984
8985 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8986 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8987 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8988 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8989 must have the following type:
8990 .code
8991 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8992 .endd
8993 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8994 function should return one of the following values:
8995
8996 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8997 into the expanded string that is being built.
8998
8999 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9000 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9001
9002 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9003 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9004
9005 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9006
9007 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9008 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9009 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9010
9011 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9012 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9013 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9014 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9015 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9016 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9017 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9018 form:
9019 .display
9020 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9021 .endd
9022 .vindex "&$value$&"
9023 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9024 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9025 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9026 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9027 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9028 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9029 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9030 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9031 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9032
9033 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9034 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9035 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9036 yield &"2001"&:
9037 .code
9038 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9039 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9040 .endd
9041 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9042 appear, for example:
9043 .code
9044 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9045 .endd
9046 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9047 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9048
9049
9050 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9051 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9052 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9053 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9054 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9055 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9056 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9057 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9058 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9059 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9060 <&'string3'&> as before.
9061
9062 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9063 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9064 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9065 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9066 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9067 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9068 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9069 provided. For example:
9070 .code
9071 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9072 .endd
9073 yields &"42"&, and
9074 .code
9075 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9076 .endd
9077 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9078 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9079
9080
9081 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9082 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9083 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9084 .vindex "&$item$&"
9085 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9086 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9087 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9088 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9089 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9090 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9091 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9092 .code
9093 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9094 .endd
9095 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9096 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9097
9098
9099 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9100 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9101 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9102 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9103 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9104 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9105
9106 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9107 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9108 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9109 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9110 .code
9111 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9112 .endd
9113 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9114 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9115 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9116 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9117 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9118 .code
9119 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9120 .endd
9121 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9122 letters appear. For example:
9123 .display
9124 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9125 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9126 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9127 .endd
9128
9129 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9130 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9131 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9132 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9133 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9134 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9135 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9136 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9137 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9138 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9139 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9140 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9141 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9142 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9143 .code
9144 $header_reply-to:
9145 .endd
9146 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9147 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9148 lines) may be present.
9149
9150 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9151 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9152
9153 .ilist
9154 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9155 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9156 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9157
9158 .next
9159 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9160 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9161 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9162 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9163 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9164 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9165 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9166 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9167
9168 .next
9169 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9170 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9171 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9172 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9173 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9174 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9175 .endlist ilist
9176
9177 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9178 command of the following form:
9179 .code
9180 headers charset "UTF-8"
9181 .endd
9182 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9183 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9184 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9185 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9186 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9187 ISO-8859-1.
9188
9189 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9190 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9191 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9192 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9193
9194 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9195 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9196 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9197 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9198 router or transport are not accessible.
9199
9200 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9201 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9202 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9203 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9204 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9205 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9206
9207 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9208 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9209 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9210 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9211 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9212 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9213 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9214
9215 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9216 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9217 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9218 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9219 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9220 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9221 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9222 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9223
9224
9225 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9226 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9227 .cindex &%hmac%&
9228 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9229 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9230 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9231 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9232 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9233 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9234 present. For example:
9235 .code
9236 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9237 .endd
9238 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9239 produces:
9240 .code
9241 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9242 .endd
9243 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9244 an Exim configuration:
9245 .code
9246 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9247 .endd
9248 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9249 .code
9250 headers_add = \
9251 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9252 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9253 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9254 .endd
9255 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9256 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9257 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9258 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9259 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9260 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9261
9262
9263 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9264 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9265 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9266 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9267 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9268 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9269 .code
9270 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9271 .endd
9272 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9273 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9274 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9275 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9276 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9277
9278 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9279 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9280 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9281 .code
9282 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9283 .endd
9284 you can use
9285 .code
9286 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9287 .endd
9288
9289 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9290 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9291 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9292 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9293 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9294 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9295 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9296 some of the braces:
9297 .code
9298 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9299 .endd
9300 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9301 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9302 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9303
9304
9305 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9306 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9307 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9308 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9309 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9310 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9311 apart from an optional leading minus,
9312 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9313
9314 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9315 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9316
9317 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9318 If the number is negative, the fields are
9319 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9320 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9321 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9322
9323 If the modulus of the
9324 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9325 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9326
9327 For example:
9328 .code
9329 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9330 .endd
9331 yields &"42"&, and
9332 .code
9333 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9334 .endd
9335 yields &"result: 99"&.
9336
9337 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9338 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9339 extracted is used.
9340 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9341
9342
9343 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9344 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9345 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9346 described in the next item.
9347
9348 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9349 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9350 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9351 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9352 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9353 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9354 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9355 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9356 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9357
9358 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9359 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9360 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9361 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9362 out by the system administrator.
9363
9364 .vindex "&$value$&"
9365 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9366 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9367 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9368 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9369 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9370 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9371 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9372 original lookup fails.
9373
9374 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9375 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9376 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9377 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9378 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9379 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9380 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9381 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9382
9383 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9384 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9385 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9386 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9387
9388 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9389 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9390 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9391 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9392
9393 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9394 .code
9395 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9396 .endd
9397 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9398 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9399 .code
9400 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9401 {$value}fail}
9402 .endd
9403
9404
9405 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9406 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9407 .vindex "&$item$&"
9408 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9409 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9410 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9411 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9412 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9413 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9414 .code
9415 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9416 .endd
9417 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9418 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9419 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9420
9421 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9422 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9423 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9424 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9425 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9426 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9427 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9428 .code
9429 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9430 .endd
9431 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9432 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9433 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9434 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9435 example,
9436 .code
9437 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9438 .endd
9439 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9440
9441
9442
9443 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9444 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9445 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9446 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9447 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9448 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9449 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9450 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9451
9452 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9453 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9454 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9455 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9456 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9457 not its contents.
9458
9459 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9460 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9461 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9462
9463 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9464 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9465
9466
9467 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9468 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9469 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9470 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9471 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9472 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9473 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9474 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9475
9476 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9477 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9478 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9479 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9480 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9481 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9482 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9483 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9484 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9485 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9486
9487 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9488 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9489 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9490 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9491
9492 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9493 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9494 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9495 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9496 is the expansion of the third argument.
9497
9498 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9499 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9500 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9501
9502 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9503 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9504 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9505 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9506 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9507 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9508 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9509 newlines are left in the string.
9510 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9511 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9512 the string expansion fails.
9513
9514 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9515 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9516
9517
9518
9519 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9520 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9521 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9522 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9523 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9524 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9525 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9526 examples:
9527 .code
9528 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9529 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9530 .endd
9531 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9532 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9533 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9534 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9535 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9536 example:
9537 .code
9538 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9539 .endd
9540 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9541 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9542 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9543 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9544 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9545 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9546 .code
9547 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9548 .endd
9549 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9550 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9551 turns them into spaces:
9552 .code
9553 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9554 .endd
9555 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9556 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9557 addition, the following errors can occur:
9558
9559 .ilist
9560 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9561 .next
9562 Failure to connect the socket;
9563 .next
9564 Failure to write the request string;
9565 .next
9566 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9567 .endlist
9568
9569 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9570 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9571 errors occurs. For example:
9572 .code
9573 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9574 {socket failure}}
9575 .endd
9576 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9577 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9578 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9579 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9580 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9581
9582 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9583 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9584
9585
9586 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9587 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9588 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9589 .vindex "&$value$&"
9590 .vindex "&$item$&"
9591 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9592 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9593 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9594 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9595 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9596 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9597 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9598 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9599 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9600 .code
9601 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9602 .endd
9603 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9604 can be found:
9605 .code
9606 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9607 .endd
9608 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9609 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9610 expansion items.
9611
9612 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9613 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9614 expansion item above.
9615
9616 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9617 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9618 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9619 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9620 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9621 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9622 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9623 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9624 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9625
9626 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9627 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9628 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9629 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9630 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9631 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9632 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9633 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9634 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9635 character.
9636
9637 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9638 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9639 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9640 .vindex "&$value$&"
9641 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9642 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9643 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9644 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9645 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9646 &$value$&.
9647
9648 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9649 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9650 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9651 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9652
9653 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9654 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9655 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9656 troubleshoot:
9657 .code
9658 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9659 log_message = Output of id: $value
9660 .endd
9661 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9662 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9663 .code
9664 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9665 .endd
9666
9667 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9668 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9669 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9670 .code
9671 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9672 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9673 ...
9674 endif
9675 .endd
9676 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9677 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9678 commands.
9679
9680 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9681 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9682 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9683 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9684
9685 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9686 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9687
9688
9689 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9690 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9691 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9692 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9693 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9694 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9695 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9696 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9697 .code
9698 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9699 .endd
9700 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9701 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9702 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9703 .code
9704 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9705 .endd
9706 yields &"defabc"&, and
9707 .code
9708 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9709 .endd
9710 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9711 the regular expression from string expansion.
9712
9713
9714
9715 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9716 .cindex sorting a list
9717 .cindex list sorting
9718 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9719 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9720 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9721 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9722 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9723 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9724 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9725 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9726 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9727 to give values for comparison.
9728
9729 The item result is a sorted list,
9730 with the original list separator,
9731 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9732
9733 Examples:
9734 .code
9735 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9736 .endd
9737 sorts a list of numbers, and
9738 .code
9739 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9740 .endd
9741 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9742
9743
9744 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9745 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9746 .cindex "substring extraction"
9747 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9748 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9749 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9750 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9751 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9752 .code
9753 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9754 .endd
9755 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9756 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9757 omitted.
9758
9759 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9760 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9761 length required. For example
9762 .code
9763 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9764 .endd
9765 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9766 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9767 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9768 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9769
9770 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9771 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9772 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9773 .code
9774 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9775 .endd
9776 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9777 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9778 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9779 .code
9780 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9781 .endd
9782 yields an empty string, but
9783 .code
9784 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9785 .endd
9786 yields &"1"&.
9787
9788 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9789 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9790 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9791 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9792 .code
9793 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9794 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9795 .endd
9796 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9797
9798
9799
9800 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9801 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9802 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9803 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9804 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9805 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9806 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9807 replacement list. For example
9808 .code
9809 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9810 .endd
9811 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9812 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9813 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9814 place.
9815 .endlist
9816
9817
9818
9819 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9820 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9821 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9822 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9823 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9824 following operations can be performed:
9825
9826 .vlist
9827 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9828 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9829 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9830 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9831 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9832 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9833
9834
9835 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9836 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9837 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9838 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9839 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9840 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9841 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9842 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9843 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9844
9845 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9846 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9847 character. For example:
9848 .code
9849 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9850 .endd
9851 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9852 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9853 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9854 processing lists.
9855
9856 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9857 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9858 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9859 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9860 .code
9861 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9862 .endd
9863 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9864 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9865 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9866 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9867 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9868 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9869 quoted.
9870 .code
9871 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9872 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9873 user@example.com
9874 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9875 Last:user@example.com
9876 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9877 user@example.com
9878 .endd
9879
9880 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9881 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9882 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9883 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9884 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9885 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9886 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9887 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9888 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9889
9890 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9891 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9892 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9893 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9894 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9895 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9896 string.
9897
9898
9899 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9900 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9901 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9902 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9903 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9904
9905
9906 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9907 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9908 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9909 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9910 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9911 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9912 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9913
9914
9915 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9916 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9917 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9918 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9919 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9920 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9921 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9922 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9923 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9924 C programming language):
9925 .table2 70pt 300pt
9926 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9927 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9928 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9929 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9930 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9931 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9932 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9933 .endtable
9934 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9935 space is permitted before or after operators.
9936
9937 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9938 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9939 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9940 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9941 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9942
9943 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9944 or 1024*1024*1024,
9945 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9946 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9947
9948 .display
9949 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9950 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9951 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9952 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9953 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9954 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9955 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9956 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9957 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9958 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9959 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9960 .endd
9961
9962 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9963 .code
9964 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9965 condition = \
9966 ${if and { \
9967 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9968 { \
9969 < \
9970 {$recipients_count} \
9971 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9972 } \
9973 }{yes}{no}}
9974 .endd
9975 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9976 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9977
9978
9979 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9980 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9981 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9982 example,
9983 .code
9984 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9985 .endd
9986 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9987 and then re-expands what it has found.
9988
9989
9990 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9991 .cindex "Unicode"
9992 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9993 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9994 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9995 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9996 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9997 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9998 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9999 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10000 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10001
10002 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10003 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10004 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10005 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10006 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10007 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10008 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10009
10010
10011 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10012 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10013 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10014 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10015 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10016 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10017 .code
10018 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10019 .endd
10020 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10021 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10022
10023
10024
10025 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10026 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10027 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10028 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10029 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10030 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10031
10032
10033
10034 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10035 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10036 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10037 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10038 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10039 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10040 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10041
10042
10043 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10044 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10045 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10046 .cindex "lower casing"
10047 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10048 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10049 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10050 .code
10051 ${lc:$local_part}
10052 .endd
10053
10054 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10055 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10056 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10057 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10058 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10059 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10060 .code
10061 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10062 .endd
10063 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10064 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10065 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10066
10067
10068 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10069 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10070 .cindex "list" "item count"
10071 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10072 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10073 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10074
10075
10076 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10077 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10078 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10079 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10080 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10081 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10082 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10083 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10084 matching list is returned.
10085
10086
10087 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10088 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10089 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10090 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10091 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10092 empty.
10093
10094
10095 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10096 .cindex "masked IP address"
10097 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10098 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10099 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10100 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10101 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10102 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10103 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10104 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10105 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10106 .code
10107 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10108 .endd
10109 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10110 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10111 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10112 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10113 .code
10114 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10115 .endd
10116 returns the string
10117 .code
10118 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10119 .endd
10120 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10121
10122
10123 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10124 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10125 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10126 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10127 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10128 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10129 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10130
10131
10132 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10133 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10134 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10135 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10136 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10137 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10138 .code
10139 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10140 .endd
10141 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10142
10143
10144 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10145 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10146 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10147 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10148 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10149 is an empty string or
10150 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10151 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10152 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10153 respectively For example,
10154 .code
10155 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10156 .endd
10157 becomes
10158 .code
10159 "ab\"*\"cd"
10160 .endd
10161 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10162 variable or a message header.
10163
10164 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10165 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10166 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10167 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10168 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10169 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10170 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10171
10172
10173 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10174 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10175 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10176 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10177 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10178 .code
10179 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10180 .endd
10181 returns
10182 .code
10183 two%20%5C2A%20two
10184 .endd
10185 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10186 yields an unchanged string.
10187
10188
10189 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10190 .cindex "random number"
10191 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10192 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10193 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10194 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10195 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10196 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10197 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10198 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10199 random().
10200
10201
10202 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10203 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10204 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10205 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10206 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10207 for DNS. For example,
10208 .code
10209 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10210 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10211 .endd
10212 returns
10213 .code
10214 4.2.0.192
10215 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10216 .endd
10217
10218
10219 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10220 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10221 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10222 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10223 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10224 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10225 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10226 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10227 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10228 characters
10229 .code
10230 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10231 .endd
10232 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10233 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10234 characters.
10235
10236
10237 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10238 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10239 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10240 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10241 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10242 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10243 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10244 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10245
10246 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10247 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10248 to use this operator as well.
10249
10250
10251
10252 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10253 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10254 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10255 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10256 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10257 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10258 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10259
10260
10261 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10262 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10263 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10264 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10265 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10266 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10267 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10268
10269
10270 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10271 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10272 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10273 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10274 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10275 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10276 certificate,
10277 and returns
10278 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10279 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10280
10281
10282 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10283 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10284 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10285 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10286 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10287 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10288 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10289 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10290 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10291 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10292 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10293 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10294 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10295
10296 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10297 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10298 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10299
10300 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10301 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10302 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10303 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10304 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10305
10306
10307
10308 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10309 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10310 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10311 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10312 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10313 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10314
10315
10316 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10317 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10318 .cindex "substring extraction"
10319 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10320 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10321 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10322 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10323 .code
10324 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10325 .endd
10326 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10327 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10328
10329 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10330 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10331 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10332 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10333 seconds.
10334
10335 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10336 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10337 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10338 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10339 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10340 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10341 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10342
10343 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10344 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10345 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10346 .cindex "upper casing"
10347 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10348 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10349 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10350
10351 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10352 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10353 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10354 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10355 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10356 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10357 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10358 .endlist
10359
10360
10361
10362
10363
10364
10365 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10366 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10367 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10368 while expanding strings:
10369
10370 .vlist
10371 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10372 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10373 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10374 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10375 condition.
10376
10377 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10378 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10379 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10380 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10381 are:
10382 .display
10383 &`= `& equal
10384 &`== `& equal
10385 &`> `& greater
10386 &`>= `& greater or equal
10387 &`< `& less
10388 &`<= `& less or equal
10389 .endd
10390 For example:
10391 .code
10392 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10393 .endd
10394 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10395 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10396 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10397 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10398 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10399 zero.
10400
10401 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10402 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10403 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10404
10405
10406 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10407 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10408 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10409 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10410 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10411 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10412 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10413 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10414 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10415 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10416 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10417 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10418 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10419 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10420
10421 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10422 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10423 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10424 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10425 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10426 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10427 false if zero.
10428 An empty string is treated as false.
10429 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10430 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10431 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10432
10433 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10434 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10435 For example:
10436 .code
10437 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10438 .endd
10439
10440
10441 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10442 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10443 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10444 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10445 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10446 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10447 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10448 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10449
10450 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10451
10452 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10453 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10454 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10455 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10456 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10457 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10458 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10459 included in the binary.
10460
10461 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10462 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10463 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10464 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10465 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10466 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10467 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10468 string in LDAP form is:
10469 .code
10470 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10471 .endd
10472 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10473 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10474 .code
10475 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10476 .endd
10477 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10478 supported:
10479
10480 .ilist
10481 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10482 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10483 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10484 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10485 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10486 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10487 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10488 comparison fails.
10489
10490 .next
10491 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10492 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10493 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10494 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10495 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10496 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10497
10498 .next
10499 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10500 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10501 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10502 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10503 whatever its length.
10504
10505 .next
10506 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10507 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10508 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10509 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10510 .endlist
10511 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10512 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10513 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10514 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10515 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10516 support &[crypt16()]&.
10517
10518 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10519 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10520 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10521 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10522 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10523
10524 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10525 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10526 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10527
10528 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10529 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10530 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10531 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10532 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10533
10534 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10535 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10536 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10537 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10538 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10539 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10540 .code
10541 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10542 .endd
10543 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10544 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10545
10546 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10547 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10548 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10549 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10550 exists in the message. For example,
10551 .code
10552 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10553 .endd
10554 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10555 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10556
10557 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10558 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10559 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10560 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10561 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10562 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10563 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10564 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10565 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10566
10567 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10568 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10569 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10570 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10571 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10572 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10573 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10574 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10575
10576 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10577 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10578 .cindex "first delivery"
10579 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10580 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10581 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10582 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10583
10584
10585 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10586 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10587 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10588 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10589 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10590 .vindex "&$item$&"
10591 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10592 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10593 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10594 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10595 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10596 .ilist
10597 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10598 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10599 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10600 .next
10601 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10602 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10603 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10604 .endlist
10605 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10606 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10607 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10608 list separator is changed to a comma:
10609 .code
10610 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10611 .endd
10612 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10613 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10614
10615 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10616
10617
10618 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10619 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10620 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10621 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10622 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10623 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10624 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10625 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10626 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10627 case-independent.
10628
10629 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10630 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10631 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10632 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10633 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10634 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10635 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10636 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10637 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10638 case-independent.
10639
10640 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10641 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10642 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10643 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10644 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10645 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10646 is true.
10647
10648 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10649 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10650 .code
10651 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10652 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10653 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10654 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10655 .endd
10656
10657 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10658 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10659 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10660 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10661 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10662 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10663 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10664 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10665 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10666 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10667 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10668
10669 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10670 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10671 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10672 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10673 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10674
10675 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10676 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10677 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10678 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10679 .code
10680 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10681 .endd
10682 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10683
10684 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10685 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10686 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10687 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10688 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10689 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10690 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10691 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10692 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10693 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10694 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10695 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10696 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10697 this can be used.
10698
10699
10700 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10701 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10702 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10703 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10704 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10705 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10706 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10707 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10708 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10709 case-independent.
10710
10711 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10712 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10713 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10714 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10715 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10716 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10717 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10718 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10719 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10720 case-independent.
10721
10722
10723 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10724 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10725 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10726 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10727 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10728 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10729 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10730 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10731 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10732 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10733 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10734 For example,
10735 .code
10736 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10737 .endd
10738 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10739 backslashes is also required.
10740
10741 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10742 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10743 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10744 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10745 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10746 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10747
10748 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10749 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10750 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10751 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10752 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10753 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10754 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10755 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10756
10757 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10758 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10759 See &*match_local_part*&.
10760
10761 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10762 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10763 See &*match_local_part*&.
10764
10765 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10766 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10767 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10768 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10769 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10770 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10771 .code
10772 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10773 .endd
10774 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10775
10776 .ilist
10777 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10778 .next
10779 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10780 .next
10781 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10782 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10783 in a single test such as
10784 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10785 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10786 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10787 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10788 .code
10789 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10790 .endd
10791 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10792 .next
10793 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10794 .next
10795 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10796 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10797 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10798 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10799 masks. For example:
10800 .code
10801 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10802 .endd
10803 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10804 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10805 address mask, for example:
10806 .code
10807 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10808 .endd
10809 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10810 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10811 .code
10812 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10813 .endd
10814 .endlist ilist
10815
10816 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10817 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10818
10819 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10820
10821 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10822 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10823 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10824 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10825 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10826 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10827 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10828 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10829 example is:
10830 .code
10831 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10832 .endd
10833 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10834 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10835 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10836 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10837 .code
10838 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10839 .endd
10840 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10841 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10842 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10843 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10844 caselessly.
10845
10846 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10847 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10848
10849 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10850 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10851 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10852 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10853
10854 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10855 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10856 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10857 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10858 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10859 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10860 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10861 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10862 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10863 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10864 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10865 .code
10866 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10867 .endd
10868 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10869 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10870
10871 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10872 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10873 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10874 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10875 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10876 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10877 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10878
10879 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10880 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10881 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10882 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10883 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10884 .code
10885 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10886 .endd
10887 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10888 .code
10889 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10890 .endd
10891 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10892 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10893 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10894 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10895 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10896 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10897 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10898 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10899
10900
10901 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10902 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10903 .cindex "Cyrus"
10904 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10905 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10906 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10907 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10908 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10909 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10910
10911 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10912 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10913 building Exim. For example:
10914 .code
10915 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10916 .endd
10917 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10918 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10919 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10920 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10921
10922 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10923 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10924 configuration, you might have this:
10925 .code
10926 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10927 .endd
10928 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10929 .code
10930 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10931 .endd
10932 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10933 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10934 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10935 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10936 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10937 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10938
10939
10940 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10941 .cindex "Radius"
10942 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10943 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10944 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10945 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10946 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10947 support.
10948
10949 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10950 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10951 this library, you need to set
10952 .code
10953 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10954 .endd
10955 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10956 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10957 .code
10958 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10959 .endd
10960 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10961 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10962 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10963
10964 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10965 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10966 the authentication is successful. For example:
10967 .code
10968 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10969 .endd
10970
10971
10972 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10973 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10974 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10975 .cindex "Cyrus"
10976 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10977 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10978 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10979 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10980 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10981 by a process that is not running as root.
10982
10983 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10984 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10985 building Exim. For example:
10986 .code
10987 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10988 .endd
10989 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10990 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10991 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10992
10993 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10994 two are mandatory. For example:
10995 .code
10996 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10997 .endd
10998 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10999 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11000 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11001 .endlist vlist
11002
11003
11004
11005 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11006 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11007 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11008 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11009 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11010 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11011 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11012
11013
11014 .vlist
11015 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11016 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11017 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11018 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11019 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11020 For example,
11021 .code
11022 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11023 .endd
11024 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11025 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11026 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11027
11028 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11029 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11030 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11031 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11032 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11033 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11034 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11035 parsed but not evaluated.
11036 .endlist
11037 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11038
11039
11040
11041
11042 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11043 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11044 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11045 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11046 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11047
11048 .vlist
11049 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11050 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11051 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11052 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11053 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11054 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11055 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11056 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11057 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11058 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11059 matching condition.
11060
11061 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11062 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11063 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11064 any unused variables being made empty.
11065
11066 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11067 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11068 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11069 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11070 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11071 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11072 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11073 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11074 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11075 during subsequent delivery.
11076
11077 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11078 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11079 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11080 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11081 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11082 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11083 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11084 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11085 delivery.
11086
11087 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11088 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11089 this variable has the number of arguments.
11090
11091 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11092 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11093 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11094 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11095 be preserved by coding like this:
11096 .code
11097 warn !verify = sender
11098 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11099 .endd
11100 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11101 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11102 failure.
11103
11104 .vitem &$address_data$&
11105 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11106 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11107 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11108 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11109 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11110 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11111 user filter files.
11112
11113 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11114 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11115 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11116 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11117 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11118 from the child's routing.
11119
11120 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11121 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11122 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11123 address.
11124
11125 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11126 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11127 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11128
11129 .vitem &$address_file$&
11130 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11131 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11132 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11133 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11134 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11135 .code
11136 /home/r2d2/savemail
11137 .endd
11138 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11139 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11140 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11141 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11142 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11143 to the relevant file.
11144
11145 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11146 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11147 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11148 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11149
11150 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11151 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11152 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11153 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11154
11155 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11156 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11157 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11158 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11159 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11160 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11161 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11162 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11163 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11164 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11165 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11166 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11167 command line option.
11168
11169 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11170 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11171 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11172 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11173 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11174 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11175 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11176 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11177 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11178 the ACL's as well.
11179
11180
11181 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11182 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11183 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11184 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11185 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11186 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11187 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11188 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11189 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11190 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11191 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11192
11193 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11194 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11195 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11196 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11197 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11198
11199
11200 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11201 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11202 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11203 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11204 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11205 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11206 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11207 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11208 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11209 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11210 an undefined mechanism.
11211
11212 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11213 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11214 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11215 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11216 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11217 the ACL malware condition.
11218
11219 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11220 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11221 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11222 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11223 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11224 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11225
11226 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11227 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11228 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11229 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11230 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11231 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11232 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11233
11234 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11235 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11236 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11237 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11238 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11239
11240 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11241 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11242 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11243 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11244 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11245
11246 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11247 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11248 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11249 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11250 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11251 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11252 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11253
11254 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11255 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11256 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11257 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11258 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11259 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11260 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11261
11262 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11263 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11264 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11265
11266 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11267 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11268 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11269 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11270 compilations of the same version of the program.
11271
11272 .new
11273 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11274 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11275 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11276 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11277 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11278 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11279
11280 .vitem &$config_file$&
11281 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11282 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11283 .wen
11284
11285 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11286 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11287 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11288 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11289 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11290
11291 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11292 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11293 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11294 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11295 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11296
11297 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11298 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11299 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11300 &$dnslist_value$&
11301 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11302 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11303 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11304 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11305 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11306 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11307 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11308 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11309 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11310
11311 .vitem &$domain$&
11312 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11313 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11314 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11315 case for &$domain$&.
11316
11317 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11318 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11319 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11320 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11321
11322 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11323 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11324 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11325 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11326 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11327 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11328
11329 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11330 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11331 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11332
11333 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11334
11335 .ilist
11336 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11337 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11338 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11339 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11340 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11341 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11342 the &(smtp)& transport.
11343
11344 .next
11345 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11346 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11347 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11348 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11349
11350 .next
11351 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11352 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11353 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11354 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11355 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11356 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11357
11358 .next
11359 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11360 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11361 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11362 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11363 .endlist
11364
11365
11366 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11367 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11368 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11369 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11370 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11371 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11372 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11373 used.
11374
11375 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11376 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11377 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11378 to nothing.
11379
11380 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11381 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11382 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11383
11384 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11385 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11386 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11387
11388 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11389 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11390 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11391
11392 .new
11393 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11394 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11395 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11396 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11397 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11398 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11399 .wen
11400
11401 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11402 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11403 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11404 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11405 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11406
11407 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11408 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11409 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11410 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11411 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11412
11413 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11414 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11415 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11416 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11417 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11418
11419 .vitem &$home$&
11420 .vindex "&$home$&"
11421 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11422 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11423 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11424 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11425 by a setting on the transport itself.
11426
11427 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11428 of the environment variable HOME.
11429
11430 .vitem &$host$&
11431 .vindex "&$host$&"
11432 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11433 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11434 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11435 to local and remote transports.
11436
11437 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11438 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11439 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11440 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11441 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11442 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11443 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11444 is connected.
11445
11446 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11447 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11448 client is connected.
11449
11450
11451 .vitem &$host_address$&
11452 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11453 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11454 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11455 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11456
11457 .vitem &$host_data$&
11458 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11459 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11460 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11461 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11462 .code
11463 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11464 message = $host_data
11465 .endd
11466 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11467 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11468 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11469 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11470 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11471 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11472 variables is set to &"1"&.
11473
11474 .ilist
11475 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11476 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11477
11478 .next
11479 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11480 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11481 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11482 .endlist ilist
11483
11484 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11485 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11486 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11487 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11488 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11489 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11490 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11491 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11492 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11493 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11494
11495 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11496 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11497 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11498
11499 .vitem &$host_port$&
11500 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11501 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11502 for an outbound connection.
11503
11504
11505 .vitem &$inode$&
11506 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11507 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11508 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11509 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11510 a unique name for the file.
11511
11512 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11513 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11514 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11515
11516 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11517 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11518 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11519
11520 .vitem &$item$&
11521 .vindex "&$item$&"
11522 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11523 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11524 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11525 empty.
11526
11527 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11528 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11529 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11530 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11531 lookup.
11532
11533 .vitem &$load_average$&
11534 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11535 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11536 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11537 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11538
11539 .vitem &$local_part$&
11540 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11541 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11542 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11543 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11544 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11545
11546 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11547 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11548 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11549 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11550 once.
11551
11552 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11553 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11554 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11555 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11556 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11557 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11558
11559 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11560 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11561 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11562 &$address_pipe$&).
11563
11564 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11565 local part of the recipient address.
11566
11567 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11568 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11569 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11570
11571 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11572 the addresses
11573 .code
11574 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11575 abc\:xyz@test.example
11576 .endd
11577 the value of &$local_part$& is
11578 .code
11579 abc:xyz
11580 .endd
11581 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11582 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11583 have:
11584 .code
11585 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11586 .endd
11587 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11588 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11589 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11590
11591 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11592 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11593 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11594 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11595 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11596 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11597 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11598
11599 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11600 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11601 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11602 variable expands to nothing.
11603
11604 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11605 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11606 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11607 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11608 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11609
11610 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11611 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11612 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11613 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11614 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11615
11616 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11617 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11618 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11619 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11620
11621 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11622 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11623 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11624
11625 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11626 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11627 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11628 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11629 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11630 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11631 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11632 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11633
11634 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11635 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11636 This contains the expanded value of the
11637 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11638 been read.
11639
11640 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11641 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11642 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11643 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11644 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11645 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11646
11647 .vitem &$log_space$&
11648 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11649 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11650 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11651 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11652 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11653 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11654
11655
11656 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11657 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11658 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11659 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11660 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11661 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11662 and &"yes"& if it was.
11663
11664 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11665 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11666 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11667 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11668 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11669 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11670 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11671 variable is empty.
11672
11673 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11674 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11675 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11676 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11677 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11678
11679 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11680 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11681 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11682 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11683 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11684 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11685 character(s).
11686
11687 .vitem &$message_age$&
11688 .cindex "message" "age of"
11689 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11690 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11691 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11692 delivery attempt.
11693
11694 .vitem &$message_body$&
11695 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11696 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11697 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11698 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11699 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11700 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11701 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11702 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11703 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11704
11705 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11706 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11707 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11708 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11709 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11710
11711 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11712 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11713 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11714 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11715 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11716 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11717 &$message_body$&.
11718
11719 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11720 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11721 .cindex "message body" "size"
11722 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11723 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11724 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11725 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11726 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11727
11728 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11729 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11730 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11731 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11732 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11733 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11734 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11735 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11736
11737 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11738 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11739 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11740 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11741 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11742 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11743
11744 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11745 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11746 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11747 contents of header lines is done.
11748
11749 .vitem &$message_id$&
11750 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11751
11752 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11753 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11754 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11755 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11756 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11757 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11758 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11759 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11760 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11761 from the body is not counted.
11762
11763 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11764 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11765 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11766 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11767 header and the body).
11768
11769 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11770 .code
11771 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11772 condition = \
11773 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11774 .endd
11775 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11776 message has not yet been received.
11777
11778 .vitem &$message_size$&
11779 .cindex "size" "of message"
11780 .cindex "message" "size"
11781 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11782 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11783 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11784 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11785 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11786 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11787 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11788 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11789 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11790
11791 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11792 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11793 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11794 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11795
11796 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11797 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11798 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11799 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11800
11801 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11802 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11803 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11804
11805 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11806 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11807 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11808 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11809 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11810 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11811 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11812 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11813 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11814 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11815
11816 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11817 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11818 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11819
11820 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11821 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11822 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11823 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11824 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11825 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11826 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11827 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11828 the original address.
11829
11830 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11831 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11832 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11833 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11834 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11835
11836 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11837 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11838 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11839
11840 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11841 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11842 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11843 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11844 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11845 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11846 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11847 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11848 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11849
11850 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11851 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11852 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11853 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11854 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11855 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11856 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11857 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11858 user.
11859
11860 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11861 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11862 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11863 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11864
11865 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11866 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11867 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11868 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11869
11870 .vitem &$pid$&
11871 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11872 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11873 This variable contains the current process id.
11874
11875 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11876 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11877 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11878 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11879 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11880 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11881 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11882 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11883 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11884 variable"& error if encountered.
11885
11886 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11887 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11888 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11889 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11890 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11891 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11892 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11893
11894
11895 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11896 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11897 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11898 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11899
11900 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11901 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11902 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11903 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11904
11905 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11906 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11907 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11908 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11909
11910 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11911 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11912 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11913
11914 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11915 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11916 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11917 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11918
11919 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11920 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11921 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11922 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11923 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11924
11925 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11926 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11927 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11928 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11929 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11930 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11931
11932 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11933 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11934 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11935 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11936 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11937
11938 .vitem &$received_count$&
11939 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11940 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11941 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11942 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11943 delivering.
11944
11945 .vitem &$received_for$&
11946 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11947 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11948 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11949 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11950 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11951
11952 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11953 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11954 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11955 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11956 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11957 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11958 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11959 option.
11960
11961 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11962 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11963 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11964 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11965 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11966 time.
11967 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
11968
11969 .vitem &$received_port$&
11970 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11971 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11972
11973 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11974 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11975 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11976 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11977 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11978 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11979 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11980 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11981 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11982
11983 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11984 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11985 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11986 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11987 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11988 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11989
11990 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11991 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11992 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11993
11994 .vitem &$received_time$&
11995 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11996 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11997 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11998
11999 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12000 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12001 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12002 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12003 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12004 .display
12005 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12006 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12007 .endd
12008 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12009 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12010 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12011 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12012
12013 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12014 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12015 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12016 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12017
12018 .ilist
12019 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12020 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12021
12022 .next
12023 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12024
12025 .next
12026 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12027 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12028 MAIL).
12029
12030 .next
12031 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12032 .next
12033
12034 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12035 .endlist
12036
12037 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12038 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12039
12040 .vitem &$recipients$&
12041 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12042 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12043 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12044 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12045 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12046 cases:
12047
12048 .olist
12049 In a system filter file.
12050 .next
12051 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12052 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12053 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12054 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12055 .next
12056 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12057 .endlist
12058
12059
12060 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12061 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12062 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12063 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12064 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12065 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12066
12067
12068 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12069 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12070 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12071 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12072
12073
12074 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12075 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12076 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12077 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12078 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12079 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12080 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12081
12082 .vitem &$return_path$&
12083 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12084 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12085 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12086 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12087 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12088 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12089 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12090 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12091 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12092 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12093 envelope sender.
12094
12095 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12096 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12097 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12098
12099 .vitem &$router_name$&
12100 .cindex "router" "name"
12101 .cindex "name" "of router"
12102 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12103 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12104
12105 .vitem &$runrc$&
12106 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12107 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12108 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12109 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12110 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12111 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12112 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12113 another.
12114
12115 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12116 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12117 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12118 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12119 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12120 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12121 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12122 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12123
12124 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12125 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12126 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12127 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12128 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12129 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12130
12131 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12132 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12133 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12134 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12135 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12136 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12137 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12138 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12139
12140 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12141 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12142 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12143
12144 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12145 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12146 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12147
12148 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12149 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12150 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12151 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12152 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12153 this:
12154 .display
12155 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12156 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12157 .endd
12158 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12159 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12160 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12161 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12162
12163 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12164 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12165 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12166 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12167 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12168 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12169 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12170 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12171 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12172 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12173 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12174 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12175 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12176
12177 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12178 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12179 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12180 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12181 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12182 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12183
12184 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12185 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12186 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12187 this variable contains that
12188 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12189
12190 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12191 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12192 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12193 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12194 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12195 &$authenticated_id$&.
12196
12197 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12198 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12199 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12200 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12201 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12202 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
12203 other times, this variable is false.
12204
12205 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12206 library, by setting:
12207 .code
12208 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12209 .endd
12210
12211 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12212 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12213
12214 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
12215 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
12216
12217 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12218 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12219
12220
12221 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12222 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12223 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12224 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12225 other means, this variable is empty.
12226
12227 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12228 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12229 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12230 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12231 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12232 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12233 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12234
12235 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12236 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12237 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12238 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12239
12240 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12241 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12242 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12243 is set to &"1"&.
12244
12245 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12246 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12247 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12248 following are true:
12249
12250 .ilist
12251 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12252 .next
12253 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12254 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12255 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12256 .next
12257 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12258 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12259 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12260 .next
12261 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12262 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12263 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12264 .next
12265 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12266 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12267 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12268 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12269 .code
12270 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12271 .endd
12272 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12273 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12274 .endlist
12275
12276
12277 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12278 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12279 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12280 number that was used on the remote host.
12281
12282 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12283 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12284 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12285 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12286 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12287 called Exim.
12288
12289 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12290 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12291 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12292 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12293
12294 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12295 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12296 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12297 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12298 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12299 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12300 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12301 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12302 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12303 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12304 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12305 the parentheses.
12306
12307 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12308 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12309 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12310 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12311 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12312
12313 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12314 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12315 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12316 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12317 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12318
12319 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12320 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12321 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12322 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12323 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12324 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12325 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12326
12327 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12328 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12329 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12330 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12331 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12332
12333 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12334 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12335 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12336 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12337 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12338 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12339
12340 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12341 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12342 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12343 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12344 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12345 .code
12346 MAIL FROM:<>
12347 MAIL FROM: <>
12348 .endd
12349 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12350 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12351 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12352 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12353
12354 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12355 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12356 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12357 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12358 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12359 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12360 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12361
12362 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12363 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12364 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12365 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12366 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12367 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12368 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12369 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12370 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12371 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12372 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12373
12374 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12375 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12376 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12377 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12378 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12379 message is junk mail.
12380
12381 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12382 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12383 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12384 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12385
12386
12387 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12388 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12389 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12390
12391 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12392 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12393 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12394 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12395 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12396 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12397
12398 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12399 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12400 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12401 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12402 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12403 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12404 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12405 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12406 .code
12407 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12408 .endd
12409 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12410
12411
12412 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12413 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12414 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12415 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12416 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12417 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12418
12419 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12420 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12421 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12422 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12423 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12424 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12425 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12426 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12427
12428 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12429 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12430 the outbound.
12431
12432 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12433 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12434 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12435 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12436 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12437 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12438
12439 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12440 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12441 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12442 inbound connection when the message was received.
12443 It is only useful as the argument of a
12444 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12445 or a &%def%& condition.
12446
12447 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12448 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12449 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12450 inbound connection when the message was received.
12451 It is only useful as the argument of a
12452 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12453 or a &%def%& condition.
12454
12455 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12456 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12457 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12458 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12459 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12460 or a &%def%& condition.
12461
12462 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12463 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12464 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12465 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12466 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12467 or a &%def%& condition.
12468
12469 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12470 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12471 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12472 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12473
12474 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12475 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12476 the outbound.
12477
12478 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12479 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12480 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12481 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12482 and &"0"& otherwise.
12483
12484 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12485 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12486 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12487 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12488 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12489 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12490 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12491 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12492 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12493
12494 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12495 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12496 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12497
12498 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12499 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12500 This variable is
12501 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12502 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12503 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12504 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12505
12506 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12507 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12508 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12509 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12510 .code
12511 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12512 1 No response to request
12513 2 Response not verified
12514 3 Verification failed
12515 4 Verification succeeded
12516 .endd
12517
12518 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12519 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12520 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12521 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12522 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12523
12524 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12525 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12526 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12527 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12528 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12529 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12530 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12531
12532 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12533 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12534 the outbound.
12535
12536 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12537 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12538 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12539 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12540 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12541 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12542
12543 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12544 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12545 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12546 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12547 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12548 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12549 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12550 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12551 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12552 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12553 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12554
12555 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12556 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12557 the outbound.
12558
12559 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12560 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12561 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12562 During outbound
12563 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12564 the transport.
12565
12566 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12567 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12568 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12569 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12570
12571 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12572 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12573 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12574
12575 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12576 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12577 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12578
12579 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12580 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12581 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12582 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12583 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12584 values for those that are behind (west).
12585
12586 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12587 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12588 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12589 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12590
12591 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12592 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12593 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12594 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12595 flag.
12596
12597 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12598 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12599 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12600 -0500.
12601
12602 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12603 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12604 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12605 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12606
12607 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12608 .cindex "transport" "name"
12609 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12610 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12611 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12612
12613 .vitem &$value$&
12614 .vindex "&$value$&"
12615 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12616 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12617 &*reduce*& expansion.
12618
12619 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12620 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12621 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12622 or for cutthrough delivery,
12623 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12624 Otherwise, empty.
12625
12626 .vitem &$version_number$&
12627 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12628 The version number of Exim.
12629
12630 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12631 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12632 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12633 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12634
12635 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12636 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12637 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12638 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12639 .endlist
12640 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12641
12642
12643
12644 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12646
12647 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12648 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12649 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12650 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12651 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12652 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12653 the line
12654 .code
12655 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12656 .endd
12657 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12658
12659
12660 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12661 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12662 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12663 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12664 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12665 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12666 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12667 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12668 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12669
12670 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12671 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12672 should usually be something like
12673 .code
12674 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12675 .endd
12676 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12677 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12678 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12679 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12680 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12681 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12682 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12683 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12684 two ways:
12685
12686 .ilist
12687 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12688 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12689 a startup when Exim is entered.
12690 .next
12691 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12692 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12693 .endlist
12694
12695 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12696 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12697
12698
12699 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12700 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12701 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12702 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12703 forms:
12704 .code
12705 ${perl{foo}}
12706 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12707 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12708 .endd
12709 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12710 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12711 with an error message of the form
12712 .code
12713 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12714 .endd
12715 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12716 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12717 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12718 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12719 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12720 that was passed to &%die%&.
12721
12722
12723 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12724 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12725 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12726 the Perl code
12727 .code
12728 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12729 .endd
12730 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12731 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12732 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12733
12734 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12735 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12736 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12737 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12738
12739 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12740 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12741 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12742 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12743 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12744 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12745 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12746
12747
12748 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12749 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12750 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12751 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12752 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12753 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12754 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12755 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12756 avoided, but the output is lost.
12757
12758 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12759 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12760 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12761 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12762 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12763 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12764 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12765 .code
12766 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12767 .endd
12768 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12769 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12770 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12771 as the first subroutine argument.
12772 .ecindex IIDperl
12773
12774
12775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12777
12778 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12779 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12780 "Starting the daemon"
12781 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12782 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12783 .cindex "network interface"
12784 .cindex "interface" "network"
12785 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12786 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12787 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12788 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12789 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12790 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12791 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12792 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12793 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12794 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12795 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12796
12797 .olist
12798 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12799 and ports to listen on.
12800 .next
12801 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12802 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12803 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12804 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12805 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12806 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12807 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12808 as an error situation.
12809 .next
12810 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12811 for the outgoing connection.
12812 .endlist
12813
12814
12815 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12816 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12817 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12818 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12819 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12820
12821 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12822 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12823 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12824 chapter describes how they operate.
12825
12826 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12827 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12828
12829
12830
12831 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12832 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12833 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12834 following options:
12835
12836 .ilist
12837 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12838 or service names.
12839 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12840 .next
12841 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12842 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12843 .endlist
12844
12845 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12846 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12847 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12848 colons. For example:
12849 .code
12850 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12851 192.168.23.65 ; \
12852 ::1 ; \
12853 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12854 .endd
12855 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12856 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12857
12858 .olist
12859 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12860 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12861 .code
12862 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12863 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12864 .endd
12865 .next
12866 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12867 with a colon separator, for example:
12868 .code
12869 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12870 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12871 .endd
12872 .endlist
12873
12874 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12875 default setting contains just one port:
12876 .code
12877 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12878 .endd
12879 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12880 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12881 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12882 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12883 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12884
12885
12886
12887 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12888 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12889 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12890 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12891 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12892 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12893 .code
12894 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12895 .endd
12896 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12897 .code
12898 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12899 .endd
12900 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12901
12902
12903
12904 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12905 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12906 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12907 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12908 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12909 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12910 exim.
12911
12912 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12913 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12914 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12915 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12916 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12917 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12918 .code
12919 -oX 1225
12920 .endd
12921 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12922 whereas
12923 .code
12924 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12925 .endd
12926 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12927 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12928 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12929
12930
12931
12932 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12933 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12934 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12935 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12936 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12937 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12938 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12939 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12940 list of port numbers or service names,
12941 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12942 common use of this option is expected to be
12943 .code
12944 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12945 .endd
12946 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12947 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12948 this way when a daemon is started.
12949
12950 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12951 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12952 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12953 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12954 connections via the daemon.)
12955
12956
12957
12958
12959 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12960 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12961 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12962 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12963 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12964 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12965 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12966 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12967 .code
12968 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12969 .endd
12970 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12971 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12972 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12973 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12974 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12975 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12976 .code
12977 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12978 .endd
12979 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12980 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12981 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12982 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12983 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12984
12985 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12986 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12987 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12988 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12989 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12990 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12991 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12992 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12993 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12994 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12995 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12996 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12997
12998 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12999 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13000 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13001 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13002 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13003
13004
13005
13006 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13007 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13008 .code
13009 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13010 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13011 .endd
13012 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13013 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13014 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13015 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13016
13017 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13018 .code
13019 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13020 .endd
13021 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13022 .code
13023 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13024 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13025 .endd
13026 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13027 IPv4 loopback address only:
13028 .code
13029 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13030 .endd
13031 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13032 .code
13033 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13034 .endd
13035 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13036
13037
13038
13039 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13040 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13041 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13042 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13043 treated as local.
13044
13045 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13046 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13047 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13048 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13049
13050 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13051 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13052 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13053 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13054 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13055 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13056 used for listening. Consider this example:
13057 .code
13058 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13059 192.168.53.235 ; \
13060 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13061
13062 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13063 .endd
13064 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13065 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13066 Exim is routing.
13067
13068 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13069 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13070 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13071 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13072 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13073 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13074 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13075 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13076
13077
13078
13079 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13080 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13081 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13082 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13083 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13084 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13085 details.
13086
13087
13088
13089
13090 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13091 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13092
13093 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13094 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13095 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13096 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13097
13098 .ilist
13099 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13100 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13101 .next
13102 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13103 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13104 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13105 .next
13106 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13107 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13108 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13109 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13110 settings.
13111 .endlist
13112
13113 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13114 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13115 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13116 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13117 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13118 listed in more than one group.
13119
13120 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13121 .table2
13122 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13123 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13124 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13125 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13126 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13127 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13128 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13129 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13130 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13131 .endtable
13132
13133
13134 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13135 .table2
13136 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13137 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13138 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13139 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13140 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13141 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13142 .endtable
13143
13144
13145
13146 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13147 .table2
13148 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13149 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13150 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13151 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13152 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13153 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13154 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13155 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13156 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13157 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13158 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13159 .endtable
13160
13161
13162
13163 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13164 .table2
13165 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13166 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13167 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13168 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13169 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13170 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13171 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13172 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13173 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13174 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13175 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13176 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13177 .endtable
13178
13179
13180
13181 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13182 .table2
13183 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13184 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13185 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13186 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13187 .endtable
13188
13189
13190
13191 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13192 .table2
13193 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13194 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13195 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13196 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13197 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13198 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13199 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13200 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13201 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13202 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13203 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13204 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13205 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13206 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13207 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13208 .endtable
13209
13210
13211
13212 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13213 .table2
13214 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13215 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13216 .endtable
13217
13218
13219
13220 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13221 .table2
13222 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13223 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13224 .endtable
13225
13226
13227
13228 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13229 .table2
13230 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13231 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13232 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13233 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13234 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13235 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13236 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13237 .endtable
13238
13239
13240
13241 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13242 .table2
13243 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13244 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13245 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13246 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13247 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13248 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13249 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13250 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13251 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13252 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13253 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13254 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13255 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13256 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13257 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13258 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13259 connection"
13260 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13261 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13262 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13263 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13264 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13265 .endtable
13266
13267
13268
13269 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13270 .table2
13271 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13272 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13273 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13274 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13275 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13276 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13277 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13278 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13279 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13280 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13281 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13282 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13283 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13284 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13285 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13286 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13287 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13288 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13289 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13290 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13291 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13292 words""&"
13293 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13294 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13295 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13296 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13297 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13298 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13299 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13300 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13301 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13302 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13303 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13304 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13305 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13306 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13307 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13308 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13309 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13310 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13311 .endtable
13312
13313
13314
13315 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13316 .table2
13317 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13318 item"
13319 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13320 item"
13321 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13322 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13323 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13324 .endtable
13325
13326
13327
13328 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13329 .table2
13330 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13331 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13332 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13333 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13334 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13335 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13336 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13337 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13338 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13339 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13340 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13341 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13342 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13343 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13344 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13345 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13346 .endtable
13347
13348
13349
13350 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13351 .table2
13352 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13353 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13354 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13355 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13356 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13357 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13358 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13359 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13360 .endtable
13361
13362
13363
13364 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13365 .table2
13366 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13367 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13368 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13369 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13370 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13371 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13372 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13373 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13374 .endtable
13375
13376
13377
13378
13379 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13380 .table2
13381 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13382 .endtable
13383
13384
13385
13386
13387
13388 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13389 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13390
13391 .table2
13392 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13393 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13394 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13395 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13396 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13397 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13398 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13399 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13400 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13401 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13402 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13403 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13404 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13405 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13406 connection"
13407 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13408 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13409 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13410 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13411 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13412 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13413 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13414 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13415 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13416 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13417 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13418 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13419 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13420 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13421 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13422 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13423 .endtable
13424
13425
13426
13427 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13428 .table2
13429 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13430 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13431 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13432 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13433 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13434 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13435 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13436 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13437 .endtable
13438
13439
13440
13441 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13442 .table2
13443 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13444 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13445 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13446 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13447 words""&"
13448 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13449 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13450 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13451 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13452 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13453 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13454 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13455 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13456 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13457 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13458 .endtable
13459
13460
13461
13462 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13463 .table2
13464 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13465 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13466 directory"
13467 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13468 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13469 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13470 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13471 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13472 .endtable
13473
13474
13475
13476 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13477 .table2
13478 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13479 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13480 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13481 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13482 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13483 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13484 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13485 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13486 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13487 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13488 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13489 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13490 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13491 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13492 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13493 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13494 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13495 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13496 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13497 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13498 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13499 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13500 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13501 .endtable
13502
13503
13504
13505 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13506 .table2
13507 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13508 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13509 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13510 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13511 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13512 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13513 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13514 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13515 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13516 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13517 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13518 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13519 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13520 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13521 .endtable
13522
13523
13524
13525 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13526 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13527 &dagger;.
13528
13529 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13530 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13531 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13532 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13533 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13534 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13535 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13536 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13537 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13538
13539 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13540 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13541 It now defaults to true.
13542 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13543 .display
13544 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13545 .endd
13546
13547 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13548 .code
13549 log_selector = +8bitmime
13550 .endd
13551
13552 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13553 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13554 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13555 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13556 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13557 further details.
13558
13559 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13560 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13561 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13562 SMTP messages.
13563
13564 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13565 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13566 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13567 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13568 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13569
13570 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13571 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13572 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13573 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13574 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13575
13576 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13577 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13578 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13579 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13580
13581 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13582 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13583 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13584 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13585 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13586
13587 .new
13588 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13589 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13590 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13591 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13592 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13593 .wen
13594 This option defines the ACL that,
13595 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13596 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13597 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13598 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13599
13600 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13601 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13602 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13603 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13604
13605 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13606 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13607 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13608 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13609
13610 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13611 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13612 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13613 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13614 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13615
13616
13617 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13618 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13619 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13620 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13621
13622 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13623 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13624 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13625 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13626 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13627
13628 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13629 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13630 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13631 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13632 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13633
13634 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13635 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13636 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13637 further details.
13638
13639 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13640 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13641 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13642 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13643
13644 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13645 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13646 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13647 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13648
13649 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13650 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13651 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13652 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13653
13654 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13655 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13656 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13657 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13658
13659 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13660 .cindex "admin user"
13661 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13662 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13663 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13664 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13665 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13666 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13667 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13668
13669 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13670 .cindex "domain literal"
13671 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13672 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13673 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13674 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13675
13676 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13677 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13678 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13679 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13680 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13681 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13682 the local host's IP addresses.
13683
13684
13685 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13686 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13687 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13688 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13689 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13690 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13691 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13692 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13693 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13694
13695 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13696 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13697 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13698 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13699 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13700 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13701 experiment if they wish.
13702
13703 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13704 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13705 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13706 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13707 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13708 suitable setting is:
13709 .code
13710 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13711 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13712 .endd
13713 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13714 .code
13715 dns_check_names_pattern =
13716 .endd
13717 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13718
13719
13720 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13721 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13722 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13723 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13724 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13725 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13726 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13727 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13728 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13729 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13730 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13731
13732 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13733 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13734 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13735 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13736 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13737 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13738
13739 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13740 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13741 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13742 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13743 .code
13744 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13745 .endd
13746 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13747 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13748 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13749 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13750
13751
13752 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13753 .cindex "thawing messages"
13754 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13755 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13756 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13757 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13758 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13759 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13760
13761 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13762 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13763 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13764
13765
13766 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13767 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13768 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13769 .code
13770 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13771 .endd
13772 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13773 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13774
13775
13776 .option bi_command main string unset
13777 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13778 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13779 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13780 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13781 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13782
13783
13784 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13785 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13786 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13787 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13788 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13789 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13790
13791
13792 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13793 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13794 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13795 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13796
13797 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13798 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13799 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13800 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13801 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13802 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13803 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13804 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13805 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13806 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13807
13808 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13809 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13810 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13811 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13812
13813
13814 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13815 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13816 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13817 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13818 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13819 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13820 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13821 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13822 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13823
13824 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13825 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13826 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13827 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13828 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13829 messages.
13830
13831 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13832 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13833 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13834 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13835 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13836 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13837 connection. A typical setting might be:
13838 .code
13839 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13840 .endd
13841 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13842 .code
13843 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13844 .endd
13845 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13846 address.
13847
13848 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13849 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13850 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13851 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13852 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13853 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13854
13855
13856 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13857 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13858 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13859 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13860
13861
13862 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13863 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13864 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13865 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13866
13867
13868 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13869 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13870 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13871 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13872
13873
13874 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13875 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13876 callout verification. The default value is
13877 .code
13878 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13879 .endd
13880 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13881
13882
13883 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13884 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13885
13886
13887 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13888 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13889
13890 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13891 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13892 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13893 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13894 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13895 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13896 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13897 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13898 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13899 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13900
13901
13902 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13903 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13904
13905
13906 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13907 .cindex "checking disk space"
13908 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13909 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13910 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13911 message is accepted.
13912
13913 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13914 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13915 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13916 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13917 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13918 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13919 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13920 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13921
13922
13923 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13924 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13925 .code
13926 check_spool_space = 10M
13927 check_spool_inodes = 100
13928 .endd
13929 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13930 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13931 transit.
13932
13933 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13934 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13935 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13936
13937 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13938 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13939 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13940 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13941 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13942 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13943
13944 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13945 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13946
13947 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13948 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13949 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13950
13951 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13952 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13953 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13954 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13955 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13956 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13957
13958 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13959 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13960 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13961 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13962 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13963 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13964 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13965
13966 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13967 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13968
13969 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13970 .cindex "warning of delay"
13971 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13972 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13973 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13974 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13975 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13976 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13977 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13978 with
13979 .code
13980 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13981 .endd
13982 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13983 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13984 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13985 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13986 .code
13987 delay_warning = 6h
13988 .endd
13989 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13990 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13991 .code
13992 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13993 .endd
13994 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
13995 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
13996 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
13997
13998 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13999 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14000 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14001 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14002 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14003 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14004 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14005 not sent. The default is:
14006 .code
14007 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14008 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14009 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14010 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14011 } {no}{yes}}
14012 .endd
14013 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14014 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14015 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14016 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14017
14018 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14019 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14020 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14021 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14022 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14023 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14024 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14025 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14026
14027 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14028 .cindex "load average"
14029 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14030 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14031 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14032 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14033 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14034
14035
14036 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14037 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14038 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14039 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14040 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14041 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14042 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14043 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14044
14045 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14046 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14047 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14048 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14049 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14050 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14051 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14052 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14053
14054 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14055 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14056 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14057 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14058
14059
14060 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14061 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14062 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14063 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14064 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14065 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14066 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14067
14068
14069 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14070 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14071 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14072 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14073 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14074 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14075 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14076 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14077 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14078 by a setting such as this:
14079 .code
14080 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14081 .endd
14082 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14083 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14084 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14085 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14086 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14087 options are applied after this global option.
14088
14089 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14090 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14091 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14092 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14093 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14094 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14095 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14096 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14097 value of this option. The default pattern is
14098 .code
14099 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14100 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14101 .endd
14102 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14103 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14104 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14105 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14106 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14107 empty string.
14108
14109 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14110 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14111 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14112
14113 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14114 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14115 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14116 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14117
14118
14119 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14120 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14121 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14122 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14123 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14124 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14125
14126 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14127
14128
14129 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14130 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14131 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14132 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14133 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14134 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14135 domain matches this list.
14136
14137 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14138 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14139 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14140
14141
14142 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14143 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14144 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14145 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14146 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14147 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14148 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14149 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14150 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14151 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14152 to set in them.
14153
14154
14155 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14156 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14157
14158
14159 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14160 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14161 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14162 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14163 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14164 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14165 on.
14166
14167 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14168
14169
14170 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14171 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14172 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14173 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14174
14175 .new
14176 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14177 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14178 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14179 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14180 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14181 and accepted from, these hosts.
14182 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14183 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14184 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14185 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14186 are sent.
14187 .wen
14188
14189 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14190 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14191 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14192 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14193 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14194 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14195 .code
14196 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14197 .endd
14198 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14199 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14200
14201 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14202 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14203 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14204 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14205 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14206 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14207 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14208 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14209 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14210
14211
14212 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14213 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14214 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14215 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14216 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14217 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14218 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14219 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14220 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14221
14222 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14223 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14224 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14225 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14226 are examined. For example:
14227 .code
14228 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14229 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14230 postmaster@mydomain.example
14231 .endd
14232 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14233 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14234 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14235 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14236 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14237 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14238 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14239
14240
14241 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14242 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14243 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14244 .display
14245 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14246 .endd
14247 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14248 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14249 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14250 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14251 overrides the default.
14252
14253 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14254 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14255 and warning messages. For example:
14256 .code
14257 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14258 .endd
14259 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14260 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14261 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14262 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14263 not used.
14264
14265
14266 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14267 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14268 .cindex "Exim group"
14269 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14270 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14271 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14272 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14273 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14274 security issues.
14275
14276
14277 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14278 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14279 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14280 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14281 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14282 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14283 other place.
14284 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14285 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14286 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14287 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14288
14289
14290 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14291 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14292 .cindex "Exim user"
14293 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14294 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14295 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14296 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14297
14298 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14299 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14300 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14301 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14302
14303
14304 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14305 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14306 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14307 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14308
14309
14310 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14311 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14312
14313 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14314 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14315 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14316 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14317 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14318 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14319 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14320 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14321 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14322 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14323 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14324 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14325 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14326 addresses.
14327
14328
14329 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14330 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14331 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14332 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14333 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14334 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14335 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14336 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14337 retries.
14338
14339 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14340 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14341 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14342 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14343
14344
14345
14346 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14347 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14348 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14349 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14350 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14351 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14352 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14353 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14354 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14355 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14356 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14357 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14358 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14359 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14360 logging that you require.
14361
14362
14363 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14364 .cindex "HP-UX"
14365 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14366 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14367 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14368 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14369 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14370 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14371 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14372 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14373
14374 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14375 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14376 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14377 user's name.
14378
14379 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14380 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14381 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14382 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14383 .code
14384 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14385 gecos_name = $1
14386 .endd
14387
14388 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14389 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14390
14391
14392 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14393 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14394 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14395 implementations of TLS.
14396
14397
14398 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14399 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14400 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14401
14402 See
14403 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14404 for documentation.
14405
14406
14407
14408 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14409 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14410 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14411 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14412 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14413 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14414
14415
14416
14417 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14418 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14419 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14420 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14421 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14422 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14423 sections are rejected.
14424
14425
14426 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14427 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14428 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14429 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14430 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14431 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14432 zero means &"no limit"&.
14433
14434
14435
14436
14437 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14438 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14439 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14440 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14441 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14442 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14443 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14444 if you want to do semantic checking.
14445 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14446 set.
14447
14448
14449 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14450 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14451 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14452 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14453 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14454 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14455 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14456 .code
14457 helo_allow_chars = _
14458 .endd
14459 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14460
14461
14462 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14463 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14464 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14465 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14466 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14467 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14468 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14469 do.
14470
14471
14472 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14473 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14474 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14475 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14476 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14477 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14478 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14479 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14480 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14481 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14482 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14483 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14484
14485 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14486 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14487 EHLO command either:
14488
14489 .ilist
14490 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14491 .next
14492 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14493 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14494 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14495 calling host address, or
14496 .next
14497 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14498 available) yields the calling host address.
14499 .endlist
14500
14501 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14502 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14503 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14504
14505 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14506 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14507 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14508 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14509 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14510 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14511 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14512 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14513 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14514 error.
14515
14516 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14517 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14518 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14519 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14520 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14521 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14522 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14523 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14524 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14525
14526 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14527 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14528 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14529 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14530 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14531
14532 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14533 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14534 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14535 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14536
14537
14538 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14539 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14540 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14541 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14542 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14543 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14544 default configuration file contains
14545 .code
14546 host_lookup = *
14547 .endd
14548 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14549 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14550
14551 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14552 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14553 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14554
14555 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14556 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14557 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14558 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14559 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14560 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14561
14562
14563 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14564 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14565 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14566 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14567 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14568 if you want.
14569
14570 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14571 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14572 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14573 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14574
14575
14576
14577 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14578 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14579 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14580 as soon as the connection is made.
14581 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14582 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14583 connections immediately.
14584
14585 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14586 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14587 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14588 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14589 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14590
14591
14592 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14593 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14594 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14595 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14596 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14597 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14598 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14599 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14600 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14601 .code
14602 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14603 .endd
14604 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14605
14606
14607
14608 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14609 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14610 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14611 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14612 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14613 records
14614 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14615 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14616
14617 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14618 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14619 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14620 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14621 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14622 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14623 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14624
14625
14626 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14627 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14628 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14629 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14630 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14631
14632
14633
14634 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14635 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14636 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14637 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14638 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14639 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14640
14641 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14642 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14643 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14644 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14645 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14646 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14647 for frozen messages. For example,
14648 .code
14649 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14650 .endd
14651 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14652 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14653 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14654 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14655 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14656 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14657
14658
14659 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14660 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14661 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14662 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14663 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14664 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14665 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14666 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14667 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14668 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14669
14670
14671 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14672 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14673
14674
14675 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14676 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14677 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14678 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14679 logged.
14680
14681
14682 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14683 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14684 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14685 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14686 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14687 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14688 and constrained to be a directory.
14689
14690
14691 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14692 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14693 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14694 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14695 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14696 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14697 and constrained to be a file.
14698
14699
14700 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14701 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14702 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14703 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14704 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14705
14706
14707 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14708 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14709 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14710 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14711 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14712 identity to be proven.
14713
14714
14715 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14716 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14717 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14718 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14719 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14720
14721
14722 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14723 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14724 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14725 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14726 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14727 with LDAP support.
14728
14729
14730 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14731 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14732 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14733 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14734 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14735 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14736 to hard/demand.
14737
14738
14739 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14740 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14741 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14742 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14743 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14744 of SSL-on-connect.
14745 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14746 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14747
14748
14749 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14750 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14751 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14752 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14753 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14754 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14755 has been built with LDAP support.
14756
14757
14758
14759 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14760 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14761 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14762 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14763 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14764 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14765 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14766
14767 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14768 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14769 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14770
14771 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14772 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14773 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14774 and the default qualify domain.
14775
14776 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14777 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14778 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14779 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14780
14781 .cindex "envelope sender"
14782 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14783 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14784 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14785
14786 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14787 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14788 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14789
14790
14791
14792
14793 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14794 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14795 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14796 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14797 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14798 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14799 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14800 example, if
14801 .code
14802 local_from_prefix = *-
14803 .endd
14804 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14805 .code
14806 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14807 .endd
14808 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14809 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14810 qualify domain.
14811
14812
14813 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14814 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14815
14816
14817 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14818 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14819 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14820 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14821 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14822 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14823 &%local_interfaces%& is
14824 .code
14825 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14826 .endd
14827 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14828 .code
14829 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14830 .endd
14831
14832 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14833 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14834 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14835 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14836 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14837 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14838 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14839 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14840
14841
14842
14843 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14844 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14845 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14846 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14847 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14848 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14849 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14850 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14851
14852
14853
14854
14855 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14856 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14857 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14858 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14859 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14860 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14861 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14862 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14863 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14864 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14865 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14866 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14867 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14868 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14869 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14870
14871
14872
14873 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14874 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14875 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14876 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14877 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14878 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14879 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14880 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14881 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14882 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14883 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14884 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14885 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14886 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14887
14888
14889 .option log_selector main string unset
14890 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14891 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14892 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14893 minus characters. For example:
14894 .code
14895 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14896 .endd
14897 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14898 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14899
14900
14901 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14902 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14903 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14904 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14905 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14906 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14907 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14908 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14909 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14910 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14911 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14912 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14913 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14914
14915
14916 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14917 .cindex "too many open files"
14918 .cindex "open files, too many"
14919 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14920 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14921 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14922 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14923 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14924 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14925 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14926 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14927 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14928 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14929 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14930 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14931
14932
14933 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14934 .cindex "length of login name"
14935 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14936 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14937 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14938 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14939 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14940 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14941
14942
14943 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14944 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14945 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14946 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14947 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14948 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14949 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14950 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14951
14952
14953 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14954 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14955 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14956 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14957 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14958 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14959 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14960
14961
14962 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14963 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14964 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14965 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14966 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14967 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14968 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14969 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14970 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14971 empty string, the option is ignored.
14972
14973
14974 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14975 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14976 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14977 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14978 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14979 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14980 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14981 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14982 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14983 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14984 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14985 colons will become hyphens.
14986
14987
14988 .option message_logs main boolean true
14989 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14990 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14991 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14992 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14993 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14994 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14995 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14996 which is not affected by this option.
14997
14998
14999 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15000 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15001 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15002 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15003 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15004 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15005 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15006 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15007 optionally followed by K or M.
15008
15009 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15010 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15011 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15012 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15013 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15014
15015 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15016 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15017 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15018 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15019 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15020 message that an individual transport can process.
15021
15022 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15023 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15024 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15025 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15026 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
15027 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15028 some problems may result.
15029
15030 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15031 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15032 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15033
15034
15035 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15036 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15037 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15038 .code
15039 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15040 .endd
15041 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15042 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15043 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15044 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15045 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15046
15047
15048 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15049 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15050 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15051 contains a full description of this facility.
15052
15053
15054
15055 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15056 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15057 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15058 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15059 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15060
15061
15062 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15063 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15064 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15065 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15066 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15067 safety precaution.
15068
15069 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15070 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15071 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15072 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15073 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15074
15075 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15076 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15077 example is
15078 .code
15079 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15080 .endd
15081 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15082 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15083 transport driver.
15084
15085
15086 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15087 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15088 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15089 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15090 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15091
15092 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15093 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15094 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15095 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15096 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15097 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15098 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15099
15100 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15101 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15102 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15103 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15104 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15105
15106 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15107
15108 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15109 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15110 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15111 some now infamous attacks.
15112
15113 Examples:
15114 .code
15115 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15116 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15117 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15118
15119 # Disable older protocol versions:
15120 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15121 .endd
15122
15123 Possible options may include:
15124 .ilist
15125 &`all`&
15126 .next
15127 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15128 .next
15129 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15130 .next
15131 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15132 .next
15133 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15134 .next
15135 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15136 .next
15137 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15138 .next
15139 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15140 .next
15141 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15142 .next
15143 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15144 .next
15145 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15146 .next
15147 &`no_compression`&
15148 .next
15149 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15150 .next
15151 &`no_sslv2`&
15152 .next
15153 &`no_sslv3`&
15154 .next
15155 &`no_ticket`&
15156 .next
15157 &`no_tlsv1`&
15158 .next
15159 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15160 .next
15161 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15162 .next
15163 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15164 .next
15165 &`single_dh_use`&
15166 .next
15167 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15168 .next
15169 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15170 .next
15171 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15172 .next
15173 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15174 .next
15175 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15176 .next
15177 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15178 .endlist
15179
15180 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15181 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15182 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15183 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15184 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15185 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15186
15187
15188 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15189 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15190 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15191 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15192 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15193
15194
15195 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15196 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15197 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15198 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15199 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15200 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15201 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15202 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15203 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15204 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15205 an ACL.
15206
15207 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15208 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15209 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15210 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15211 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15212 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15213 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15214
15215
15216 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15217 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15218 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15219
15220
15221 .option perl_startup main string unset
15222 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15223 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15224
15225
15226 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15227 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15228 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15229 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15230 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15231 PostgreSQL support.
15232
15233
15234 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15235 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15236 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15237 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15238 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15239 to the host name:
15240 .code
15241 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15242 .endd
15243 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15244 spool directory.
15245 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15246 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15247 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15248
15249
15250 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15251 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15252 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15253 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15254 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15255 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15256 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15257 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15258 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15259
15260
15261 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15262 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15263 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15264 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15265 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15266 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15267 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15268 is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15269
15270 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15271 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15272 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15273 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15274 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15275 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15276 volume of mail. Use with care!
15277
15278
15279 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15280 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15281 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15282 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15283 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15284 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15285 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15286 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15287 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15288 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15289
15290 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15291 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15292 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15293 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15294 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15295 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15296
15297
15298 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15299 .cindex "printing characters"
15300 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15301 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15302 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15303 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15304 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15305 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15306 characters.
15307
15308 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15309 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15310 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15311 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15312 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15313 standards.
15314
15315
15316 .option process_log_path main string unset
15317 .cindex "process log path"
15318 .cindex "log" "process log"
15319 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15320 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15321 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15322 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15323 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15324 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15325 different spool directories.
15326
15327
15328 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15329 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15330 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15331 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15332 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15333 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15334 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15335
15336
15337 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15338 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15339 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15340 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15341 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15342 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15343 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15344 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15345 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15346
15347 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15348 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15349 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15350 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15351 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15352 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15353 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15354
15355
15356 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15357 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15358 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15359
15360
15361
15362 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15363 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15364 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15365 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15366 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15367 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15368 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15369 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15370
15371
15372 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15373 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15374 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15375 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15376 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15377
15378
15379 .option queue_only main boolean false
15380 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15381 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15382 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15383 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15384 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15385 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15386
15387 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15388 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15389 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15390 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15391
15392
15393 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15394 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15395 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15396 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15397 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15398 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15399 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15400 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15401 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15402 .code
15403 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15404 .endd
15405 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15406 &_/some/file_& exists.
15407
15408
15409 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15410 .cindex "load average"
15411 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15412 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15413 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15414 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15415 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15416 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15417 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15418 false.
15419
15420 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15421 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15422 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15423 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15424
15425
15426 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15427 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15428 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15429 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15430 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15431 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15432 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15433 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15434 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15435 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15436 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15437 re-evaluated for each message.
15438
15439
15440 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15441 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15442 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15443 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15444 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15445 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15446
15447
15448 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15449 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15450 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15451 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15452 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15453 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15454 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15455 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15456 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15457 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15458 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15459 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15460 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15461
15462
15463
15464 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15465 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15466 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15467 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15468 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15469 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15470 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15471 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15472 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15473
15474 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15475 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15476 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15477 the daemon's command line.
15478
15479 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15480 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15481 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15482 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15483 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15484 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15485 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15486 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15487 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15488 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15489 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15490 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15491 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15492 &%queue_domains%&.
15493
15494
15495 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15496 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15497 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15498 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15499 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15500 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15501 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15502
15503 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15504 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15505 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15506 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15507 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15508 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15509 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15510 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15511 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15512 header lines. The default setting is:
15513
15514 .code
15515 received_header_text = Received: \
15516 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15517 {${if def:sender_ident \
15518 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15519 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15520 by $primary_hostname \
15521 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15522 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15523 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15524 ${if def:sender_address \
15525 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15526 id $message_exim_id\
15527 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15528 .endd
15529
15530 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15531 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15532 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15533 header lines such as the following:
15534 .code
15535 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15536 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15537 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15538 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15539 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15540 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15541 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15542 .endd
15543 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15544 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15545 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15546 message was accepted.
15547
15548
15549 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15550 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15551 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15552 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15553 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15554 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15555 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15556 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15557
15558
15559 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15560 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15561 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15562 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15563 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15564 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15565 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15566 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15567 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15568 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15569 option was not set.
15570
15571
15572 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15573 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15574 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15575 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15576 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15577 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15578 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15579 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15580 done.
15581
15582 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15583 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15584 RCPT commands in a single message.
15585
15586
15587 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15588 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15589 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15590 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15591 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15592 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15593 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15594
15595
15596 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15597 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15598 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15599 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15600 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15601 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15602 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15603 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15604 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15605 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15606 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15607 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15608 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15609 tagged with its process id.
15610
15611 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15612 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15613 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15614 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15615 is received.
15616
15617 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15618 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15619 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15620 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15621 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15622 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15623 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15624 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15625 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15626 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15627 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15628
15629 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15630 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15631 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15632 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15633
15634
15635 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15636 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15637 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15638 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15639 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15640 .code
15641 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15642 .endd
15643 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15644 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15645
15646
15647 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15648 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15649 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15650 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15651 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15652 past failures.
15653
15654
15655 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15656 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15657 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15658 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15659 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15660 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15661 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15662 the default value.
15663
15664
15665 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15666 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15667 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15668 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15669 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15670 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15671 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15672 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15673 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15674 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15675
15676
15677 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15678 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15679
15680
15681 .new
15682 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15683 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15684 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15685 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15686 an item in the list.
15687 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15688 for the system.
15689 .wen
15690
15691 .new
15692 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15693 .wen
15694 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15695 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15696 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15697 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15698
15699
15700 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15701 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15702 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15703 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15704 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15705 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15706 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15707 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15708 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15709 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15710
15711
15712 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15713 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15714 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15715 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15716 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15717 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15718 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15719 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15720 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15721 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15722 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15723
15724
15725
15726 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15727 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15728 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15729 .cindex "inetd"
15730 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15731 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15732 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15733 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15734 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15735 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15736
15737 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15738 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15739 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15740 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15741
15742
15743 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15744 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15745 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15746 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15747 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15748 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15749 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15750 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15751
15752 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15753 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15754 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15755 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15756 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15757 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15758 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15759 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15760
15761
15762 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15763 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15764 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15765 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15766 live with.
15767
15768
15769 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15770 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15771 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15772 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15773 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15774 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15775 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15776 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15777 . the option name to split.
15778
15779 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15780 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15781 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15782 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15783 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15784 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15785 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15786 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15787 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15788 seen).
15789
15790
15791 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15792 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15793 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15794 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15795 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15796 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15797 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15798 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15799 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15800 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15801 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15802
15803 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15804 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15805 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15806 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15807 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15808 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15809
15810
15811
15812 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15813 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15814 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15815 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15816 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15817 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15818 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15819 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15820 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15821 to all messages received in the same connection.
15822
15823 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15824 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15825 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15826 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15827
15828
15829 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15830
15831 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15832 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15833 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15834 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15835 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15836 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15837 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15838 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15839 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15840 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15841 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15842 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15843 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15844
15845
15846 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15847 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15848 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15849 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15850 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15851 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15852 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15853 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15854 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15855 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15856 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15857 individual host.
15858
15859 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15860 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15861 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15862 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15863
15864
15865 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15866 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15867 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15868 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15869 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15870 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15871 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15872 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15873 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15874
15875 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15876 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15877 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15878 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15879
15880 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15881 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15882 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15883 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15884 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15885 For example:
15886 .code
15887 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15888 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15889 .endd
15890
15891 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15892 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15893 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15894 &%helo_data%& value.
15895
15896 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15897 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15898 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15899 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15900 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15901 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15902 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15903 .code
15904 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15905 $version_number $tod_full
15906 .endd
15907 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15908 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15909 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15910 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15911 multiline response).
15912
15913
15914 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15915 .cindex "checking disk space"
15916 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15917 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15918 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15919 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15920 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15921 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15922 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15923
15924
15925 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15926 .cindex "connection backlog"
15927 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15928 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15929 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15930 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15931 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15932 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15933 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15934 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15935 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15936 attacks by SYN flooding.
15937
15938
15939 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15940 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15941 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15942 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15943 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15944 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15945 fewer, but they still exist.
15946
15947 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15948 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15949 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15950 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15951 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15952 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15953 does detect many instances.
15954
15955 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15956 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15957 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15958 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15959
15960
15961
15962 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15963 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15964 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15965 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15966 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15967 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15968 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15969 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15970 example:
15971 .code
15972 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15973 $sender_host_address
15974 .endd
15975 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15976 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15977 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15978 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15979 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15980 the command.
15981
15982
15983 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15984 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15985 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15986 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15987 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15988
15989
15990 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15991 .cindex "load average"
15992 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15993 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15994 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15995 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15996 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15997 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15998
15999
16000
16001 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16002 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16003 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16004 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16005 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16006 .code
16007 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16008 .endd
16009 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16010 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16011 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16012 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16013 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16014
16015 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16016 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16017 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16018 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16019 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16020 not count towards the limit.
16021
16022
16023
16024 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16025 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16026 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16027 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16028 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16029 that subvert web
16030 clients
16031 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16032 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16033
16034
16035
16036 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16037 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16038 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16039 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16040 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16041 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16042 recipients.
16043
16044 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16045 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16046 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16047 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16048
16049 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16050 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16051 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16052 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16053 values:
16054
16055 .ilist
16056 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16057 .next
16058 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16059 fractional parts are allowed here.
16060 .next
16061 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16062 .next
16063 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16064 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16065 .endlist
16066
16067 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16068 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16069 .code
16070 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16071 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16072 .endd
16073 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16074 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16075 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16076 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16077
16078
16079 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16080 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16081
16082
16083 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16084 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16085
16086
16087 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16088 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16089 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16090 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16091 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16092 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16093 the message is abandoned.
16094 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16095 .code
16096 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16097 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16098 .endd
16099 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16100 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16101
16102 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16103 expanded before use and may depend on
16104 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16105
16106
16107 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16108 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16109 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16110 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16111 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16112 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16113
16114
16115 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16116 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16117 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16118
16119
16120 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16121 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16122 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16123 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16124 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16125 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16126 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16127 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16128 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16129 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16130 .code
16131 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16132 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16133 .endd
16134
16135 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16136 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16137 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16138 The default value is
16139 .code
16140 127.0.0.1 783
16141 .endd
16142 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16143
16144
16145
16146 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16147 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16148 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16149 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16150 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16151 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16152 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16153 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16154 arrival of the message.
16155
16156 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16157 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16158 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16159 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16160 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16161
16162 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16163 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16164 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16165 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16166 automatically deleted.
16167
16168 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16169 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16170 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16171 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16172 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16173 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16174 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16175 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16176 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16177
16178
16179 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16180 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16181 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16182 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16183 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16184 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16185 &$primary_hostname$&.
16186
16187 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16188 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16189 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16190 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16191 as failures in the configuration file.
16192
16193 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16194 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16195
16196 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16197 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16198 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16199 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16200
16201 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16202 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16203 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16204 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16205 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16206 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16207
16208 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16209 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16210 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16211 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16212 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16213 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16214 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16215
16216
16217 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16218 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16219 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16220 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16221 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16222 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16223 domain causes a syntax error.
16224 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16225 syntax checking.
16226
16227
16228 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16229 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16230 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16231 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16232 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16233 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16234 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16235 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16236 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16237 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16238 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16239 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16240
16241
16242 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16243 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16244 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16245 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16246 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16247 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16248 details of Exim's logging.
16249
16250
16251
16252 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16253 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16254 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16255 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16256 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16257
16258
16259
16260 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16261 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16262 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16263 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16264 details of Exim's logging.
16265
16266
16267 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16268 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16269 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16270 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16271 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16272 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16273 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16274 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16275 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16276 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16277 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16278
16279
16280 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16281 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16282 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16283 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16284 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16285 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16286
16287
16288 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16289 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16290 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16291 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16292 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16293
16294 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16295 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16296 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16297 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16298 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16299
16300 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16301 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16302 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16303 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16304 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16305 contains the pipe command.
16306
16307
16308 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16309 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16310 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16311 is used in a system filter.
16312
16313
16314 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16315 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16316 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16317 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16318 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16319 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16320 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16321 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16322 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16323 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16324
16325 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16326 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16327 transport option overrides.
16328
16329
16330 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16331 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16332 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16333 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16334 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16335 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16336 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16337 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16338 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16339 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16340 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16341 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16342 TCP_NODELAY.
16343
16344
16345 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16346 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16347 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16348 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16349 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16350 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16351 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16352 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16353 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16354 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16355
16356 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16357 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16358 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16359
16360
16361 .option timezone main string unset
16362 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16363 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16364 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16365 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16366 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16367 .code
16368 timezone = UTC
16369 .endd
16370 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16371 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16372 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16373 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16374 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16375 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16376
16377
16378 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16379 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16380 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16381 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16382 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16383 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16384 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16385 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16386
16387
16388 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16389 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16390 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16391 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16392 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16393 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16394 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16395
16396 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16397 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16398 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16399 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16400
16401 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16402 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16403 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16404 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16405
16406 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16407 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16408 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16409 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16410 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16411
16412 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16413
16414
16415 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16416 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16417 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16418 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16419 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16420 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16421
16422 The value must be at least 1024.
16423
16424 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16425 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16426 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16427
16428 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16429 number.
16430
16431 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16432 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16433 larger prime than requested.
16434
16435
16436 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16437 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16438 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16439 to be used by Exim.
16440
16441 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16442 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16443 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16444 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16445 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16446 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16447 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16448
16449 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16450 loaded by Exim.
16451
16452 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16453 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16454 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16455 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16456
16457 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16458 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16459 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16460 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16461
16462 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16463 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16464 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16465 "ike23".
16466
16467 The available primes are:
16468 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16469 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16470 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16471
16472 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16473 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16474
16475 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16476 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16477 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16478 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16479 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16480 userbase.
16481
16482 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16483 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16484 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16485 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16486 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16487 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16488 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16489
16490
16491 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16492 This option
16493 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16494 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16495 Certificate Authority.
16496
16497
16498 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16499 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16500 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16501 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16502 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16503
16504
16505
16506 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16507 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16508 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16509 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16510 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16511 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16512 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16513
16514 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16515
16516
16517 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16518 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16519 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16520 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16521 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16522 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16523 TLS session.
16524
16525
16526 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16527 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16528 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16529 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16530 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16531 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16532 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16533 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16534 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16535 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16536 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16537
16538
16539 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16540 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16541 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16542 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16543
16544
16545 .new
16546 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16547 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16548 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16549 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16550 word "system"
16551 or the absolute path to
16552 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16553 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16554
16555 The "system" value for the option will use a
16556 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16557 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16558 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16559 must be specified.
16560
16561 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
16562 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16563
16564 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16565 explicitly
16566 either by file or directory
16567 are added to those given by the system default location.
16568 .wen
16569
16570 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16571 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16572 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16573 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16574 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16575 use the explicit directory version.
16576
16577 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16578
16579 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16580 being unset.
16581
16582
16583 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16584 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16585 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16586 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16587 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16588 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16589 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16590 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16591
16592 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16593 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16594 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16595 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16596 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16597 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16598 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16599
16600 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16601 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16602 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16603 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16604 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16605 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16606 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16607 certificate"&.
16608
16609 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16610 certificates.
16611
16612
16613 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16614 .cindex "trusted groups"
16615 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16616 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16617 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16618 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16619 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16620 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16621 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16622 are trusted.
16623
16624 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16625 .cindex "trusted users"
16626 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16627 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16628 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16629 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16630 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16631 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16632 Exim user are trusted.
16633
16634 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16635 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16636 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16637 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16638 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16639 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16640 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16641 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16642 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16643 &%-F%& option.
16644
16645 .option unknown_username main string unset
16646 See &%unknown_login%&.
16647
16648 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16649 .cindex "trusted users"
16650 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16651 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16652 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16653 .cindex "envelope sender"
16654 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16655 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16656 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16657 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16658 is used) is ignored.
16659
16660 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16661 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16662 .code
16663 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16664 .endd
16665 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16666 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16667 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16668 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16669 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16670 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16671 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16672 followed by a hyphen
16673 by a setting like this:
16674 .code
16675 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16676 .endd
16677 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16678 restriction, you can use
16679 .code
16680 untrusted_set_sender = *
16681 .endd
16682 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16683 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16684 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16685 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16686 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16687 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16688 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16689 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16690
16691 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16692 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16693 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16694 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16695 sender address.
16696
16697
16698 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16699 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16700 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16701 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16702 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16703 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16704 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16705 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16706 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16707 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16708 .code
16709 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16710 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16711 .endd
16712 The pattern can be seen by running
16713 .code
16714 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16715 .endd
16716 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16717 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16718 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16719 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16720 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16721 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16722
16723
16724 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16725 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16726
16727
16728 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16729 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16730 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16731 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16732 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16733 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16734 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16735 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16736
16737
16738 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16739 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16740 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16741 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16742 .ecindex IIDconfima
16743 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16744
16745
16746
16747
16748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16750
16751 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16752 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16753 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16754 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16755 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16756
16757 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16758 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16759 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16760 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16761 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16762
16763
16764
16765 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16766 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16767 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16768 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16769 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16770 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16771 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16772
16773 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16774 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16775 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16776 routers, and the eventual transport.
16777
16778 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16779 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16780 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16781 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16782 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16783
16784 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16785 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16786 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16787 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16788 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16789
16790 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16791 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16792 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16793 .code
16794 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16795 .endd
16796 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16797 .code
16798 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16799 .endd
16800 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16801 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16802
16803 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16804 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16805 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16806 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16807 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16808 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16809 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16810
16811
16812
16813 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16814 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16815 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16816 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16817 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16818 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16819 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16820 routing.
16821
16822
16823
16824 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16825 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16826 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16827 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16828 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16829 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16830 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16831 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16832 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16833 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16834 you could put:
16835 .code
16836 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16837 .endd
16838 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16839 and
16840 .code
16841 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16842 .endd
16843 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16844 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16845 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16846 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16847
16848
16849 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16850 .cindex "case of local parts"
16851 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16852 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16853 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16854 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16855 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16856 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16857 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16858 more details.
16859
16860 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16861 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16862 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16863 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16864 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16865 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16866 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16867 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16868 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16869
16870 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16871 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16872 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16873 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16874
16875
16876
16877 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16878 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16879 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16880 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16881 .vindex "&$home$&"
16882 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16883 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16884 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16885 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16886 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16887 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16888 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16889 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16890 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16891 the router is skipped.
16892
16893 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16894 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16895 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16896 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16897 setting to achieve this. For example:
16898 .code
16899 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16900 .endd
16901 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16902 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16903 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16904
16905
16906
16907 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16908 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16909 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16910 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16911 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16912 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16913 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16914 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16915
16916 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16917 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16918
16919 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16920 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16921
16922 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16923 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16924 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16925 .code
16926 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16927 .endd
16928 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16929 .code
16930 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16931 .endd
16932
16933 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16934 .code
16935 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16936 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16937 condition = foobar
16938 .endd
16939
16940 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16941 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16942 be specified using &%condition%&.
16943
16944 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
16945 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
16946 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
16947 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
16948 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
16949 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
16950 Router rules processing behavior.
16951
16952 This is best illustrated in an example:
16953 .code
16954 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
16955 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
16956
16957 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
16958 true {yes} {no}}
16959
16960 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
16961 {yes} {no}}
16962 .endd
16963 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
16964 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
16965 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
16966 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
16967 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
16968 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
16969 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
16970 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
16971
16972 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
16973 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
16974 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
16975 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
16976 string characters.
16977
16978 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
16979 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
16980 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
16981 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
16982 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
16983
16984
16985 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16986 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16987 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16988 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16989 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16990 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16991 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16992 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16993 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16994 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16995 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16996 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16997 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16998 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16999
17000
17001
17002 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17003 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17004 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17005 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17006 transport option of the same name.
17007
17008
17009 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17010 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17011 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17012 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17013 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17014 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17015 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17016 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17017
17018
17019
17020 .option driver routers string unset
17021 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17022 to be used.
17023
17024
17025 .new
17026 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17027 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17028 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17029 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17030 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17031 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17032 Not effective on redirect routers.
17033 .wen
17034
17035
17036
17037 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17038 .cindex "envelope sender"
17039 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17040 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17041 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17042 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17043 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17044 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17045 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17046
17047 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17048 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17049 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17050 setting.
17051
17052 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17053 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17054 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17055 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17056
17057 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17058 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17059 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17060 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17061 settings:
17062 .code
17063 errors_to =
17064 errors_to = ""
17065 .endd
17066 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17067 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17068 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17069 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17070 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17071
17072 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17073 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17074 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17075 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17076 setting &%return_path%&.
17077
17078 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17079 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17080 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17081
17082
17083
17084 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17085 .cindex "address" "testing"
17086 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17087 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17088 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17089 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17090 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17091 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17092 on for the system alias file.
17093 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17094 are evaluated.
17095
17096 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17097 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17098 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17099
17100
17101
17102 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17103 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17104 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17105 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17106
17107
17108
17109 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17110 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17111 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17112
17113
17114
17115 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17116 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17117 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17118
17119
17120
17121 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17122 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17123 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17124 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17125 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17126 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17127 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17128 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17129 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17130
17131 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17132 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17133 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17134 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17135 transport for further details.
17136
17137
17138 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17139 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17140 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17141 .cindex "transport" "local"
17142 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17143 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17144 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17145 process.
17146 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17147 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17148 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17149 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17150 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17151
17152
17153
17154 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17155 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17156 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17157 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
17158 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17159 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17160 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17161 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17162 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17163 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17164 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17165 &"see"& the added header lines.
17166
17167 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17168 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17169 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17170 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17171
17172 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17173 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17174
17175 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17176 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17177
17178 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17179 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17180 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17181 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17182 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17183 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17184 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17185 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17186 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17187 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17188
17189
17190
17191 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17192 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17193 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17194 This option specifies a list of text headers, colon-separated,
17195 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17196 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17197 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17198 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17199 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17200 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17201 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17202 &"see"& the original header lines.
17203
17204 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17205 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17206 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17207 errors.
17208
17209 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17210 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17211
17212 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17213 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17214
17215 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17216 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17217 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17218 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17219
17220
17221 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17222 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17223 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17224 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17225 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17226 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17227 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17228 like
17229 .code
17230 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17231 .endd
17232 by setting
17233 .code
17234 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17235 .endd
17236 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17237 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17238 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17239 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17240 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17241 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17242
17243 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17244 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17245 .code
17246 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17247 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17248 .endd
17249 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17250 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17251
17252 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17253 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17254 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17255 domain that is being routed.
17256
17257 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17258 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17259 checked.
17260
17261 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17262 .cindex "additional groups"
17263 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17264 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17265 .cindex "transport" "local"
17266 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17267 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17268 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17269 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17270 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17271
17272
17273
17274 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17275 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17276 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17277 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17278 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17279 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17280 evaluated.
17281
17282 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17283 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17284 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17285 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17286 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17287 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17288 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17289 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17290 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17291
17292 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17293 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17294 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17295 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17296 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17297 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17298 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17299 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17300 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17301 the relevant transport.
17302
17303 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17304 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17305 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17306 callout.
17307
17308 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17309 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17310 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17311 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17312 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17313 .code
17314 real_localuser:
17315 driver = accept
17316 local_part_prefix = real-
17317 check_local_user
17318 transport = local_delivery
17319 .endd
17320 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17321 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17322 .code
17323 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17324 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17325 .endd
17326
17327 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17328 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17329 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17330 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17331
17332
17333 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17334 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17335
17336
17337
17338 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17339 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17340 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17341 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17342 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17343 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17344 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17345 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17346 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17347 &%username-foo%&.
17348
17349
17350 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17351 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17352
17353
17354
17355 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17356 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17357 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17358 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17359 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17360 are evaluated, and
17361 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17362 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17363 example:
17364 .code
17365 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17366 .endd
17367 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17368 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17369 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17370 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17371 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17372 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17373 each virtual domain:
17374 .code
17375 postmaster:
17376 driver = redirect
17377 local_parts = postmaster
17378 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17379 .endd
17380
17381
17382 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17383 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17384 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17385 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17386 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17387 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17388 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17389 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17390 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17391 redirect addresses.
17392
17393
17394
17395 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17396 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17397 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17398 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17399 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17400 delivery to be deferred.
17401
17402 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17403 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17404 .oindex "&%self%&"
17405 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17406 means of the setting
17407 .code
17408 self = pass
17409 .endd
17410 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17411 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17412 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17413
17414 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17415 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17416 controls what happens next.
17417
17418
17419 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17420 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17421 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17422 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17423 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17424 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17425 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17426 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17427
17428 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17429 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17430 applies to all of them.
17431
17432
17433
17434 .option pass_router routers string unset
17435 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17436 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17437 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17438 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17439 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17440 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17441 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17442 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17443 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17444 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17445
17446
17447
17448 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17449 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17450 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17451 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17452 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17453 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17454
17455 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17456 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17457 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17458 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17459
17460
17461
17462 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17463 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17464 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17465 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17466 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17467 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17468 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17469
17470 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17471 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17472 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17473 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17474
17475 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17476 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17477 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17478 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17479 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17480
17481 .cindex "NFS"
17482 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17483 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17484 unavailable.
17485
17486 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17487 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17488 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17489 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17490 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17491 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17492 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17493 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17494
17495 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17496 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17497 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17498 operates as follows:
17499
17500 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17501 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17502 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17503 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17504 used. For example:
17505 .code
17506 require_files = mail:/some/file
17507 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17508 .endd
17509 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17510 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17511
17512 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17513 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17514 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17515 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17516
17517 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17518 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17519 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17520 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17521 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17522
17523 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17524 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17525 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17526 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17527 check again in that process.
17528
17529 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17530 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17531 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17532 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17533 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17534 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17535 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17536 .code
17537 require_files = +/some/file
17538 .endd
17539 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17540 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17541 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17542
17543
17544
17545 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17546 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17547 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17548 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17549 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17550 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17551 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17552 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17553 latter kind.
17554
17555 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17556 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17557 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17558 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17559 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17560 same name.
17561
17562 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17563 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17564 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17565
17566
17567
17568 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17569 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17570 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17571 .vindex "&$home$&"
17572 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17573 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17574 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17575 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17576 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17577 cause the router to defer.
17578
17579 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17580 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17581 place.
17582 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17583 are evaluated.)
17584 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17585 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17586
17587 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17588 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17589 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17590 of these values that is set:
17591
17592 .ilist
17593 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17594 .next
17595 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17596 .next
17597 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17598 .next
17599 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17600 .endlist
17601
17602 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17603 router, but not for the transport.
17604
17605
17606
17607 .option self routers string freeze
17608 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17609 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17610 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17611 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17612 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17613 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17614 of remote hosts.
17615 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17616 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17617 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17618 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17619 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17620
17621 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17622 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17623 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17624 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17625 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17626 cases:
17627
17628 .vlist
17629 .vitem &%defer%&
17630 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17631
17632 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17633 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17634 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17635 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17636
17637 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17638 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17639 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17640 rewritten.
17641
17642 .vitem &%pass%&
17643 .oindex "&%more%&"
17644 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17645 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17646 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17647 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17648 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17649 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17650 combination
17651 .code
17652 self = pass
17653 no_more
17654 .endd
17655 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17656 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17657 be passed to the next router.
17658
17659 .vitem &%fail%&
17660 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17661
17662 .vitem &%send%&
17663 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17664 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17665 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17666 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17667 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17668 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17669 .endlist
17670
17671
17672
17673 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17674 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17675 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17676 address matches something on the list.
17677 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17678 are evaluated.
17679
17680 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17681 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17682 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17683 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17684 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17685 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17686 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17687 matters.
17688
17689
17690 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17691 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17692 .cindex "packet radio"
17693 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17694 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17695 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17696 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17697 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17698 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17699 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17700 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17701
17702 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17703 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17704 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17705 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17706 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17707 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17708 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17709 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17710 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17711 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17712 .code
17713 translate_ip_address = \
17714 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17715 {$value}fail}}
17716 .endd
17717 The file would contain lines like
17718 .code
17719 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17720 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17721 .endd
17722 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17723 are doing.
17724
17725
17726
17727 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17728 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17729 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17730 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17731 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17732 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17733 delivery is deferred.
17734
17735 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17736 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17737 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17738
17739
17740
17741 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17742 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17743 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17744 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17745 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17746 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17747 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17748 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17749 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17750 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17751 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17752 environment.
17753
17754
17755
17756
17757 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17758 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17759 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17760 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17761 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17762 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17763 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17764 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17765 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17766 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17767
17768 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17769 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17770 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17771 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17772 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17773
17774 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17775 environment.
17776
17777
17778
17779
17780 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17781 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17782 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17783 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17784 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17785 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17786 delivery to be deferred.
17787
17788 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17789 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17790 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17791 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17792 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17793 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17794
17795 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17796 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17797 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17798 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17799 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17800 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17801 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17802 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17803
17804 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17805 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17806 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17807 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17808 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17809 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17810 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17811 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17812 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17813 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17814
17815 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17816 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17817 subsequent routers.
17818
17819
17820 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17821 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17822 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17823 .cindex "transport" "local"
17824 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17825 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17826 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17827 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17828 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17829 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17830 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17831 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17832 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17833 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17834 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17835 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17836
17837
17838
17839 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17840 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17841 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17842
17843
17844 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17845 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17846 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
17847 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17848 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17849 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17850 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17851 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17852 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17853 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17854
17855 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17856 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17857 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17858 user or group.
17859
17860
17861 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17862 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17863 addresses,
17864 delivering in cutthrough mode
17865 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17866 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17867 are evaluated.
17868 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
17869
17870
17871 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17872 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17873 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17874 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17875 are evaluated.
17876 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
17877 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17878 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17879
17880
17881
17882
17883
17884
17885 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17887
17888 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17889 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17890 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17891 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17892 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17893 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17894 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17895 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17896 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17897 .code
17898 localusers:
17899 driver = accept
17900 domains = mydomain.example
17901 check_local_user
17902 transport = local_delivery
17903 .endd
17904 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17905 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17906 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17907 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17908
17909
17910
17911
17912
17913
17914 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17915 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17916
17917 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17918 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17919 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17920 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17921 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17922 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17923
17924 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17925 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17926 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17927 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17928 records.
17929
17930 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17931 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17932 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17933 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17934 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17935 generic option, the router declines.
17936
17937 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17938 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17939 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17940
17941 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17942 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17943 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17944 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17945 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17946 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17947
17948
17949 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17950 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17951 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17952 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17953 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17954 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17955
17956 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17957 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17958 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17959 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17960 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17961 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17962 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17963 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17964 case routing fails.
17965
17966
17967 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17968 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17969 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17970 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17971 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17972
17973 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17974 .ilist
17975 The domain does not exist in DNS
17976 .next
17977 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17978 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17979 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17980 .next
17981 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17982 .next
17983 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17984 .next
17985 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17986 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17987 .next
17988 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17989 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17990 .next
17991 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17992 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17993 .next
17994 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17995 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17996 .endlist
17997
17998
17999
18000
18001 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18002 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18003 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18004
18005 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18006 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18007 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18008 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18009 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18010 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18011 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18012
18013
18014 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18015 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18016 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18017 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18018 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18019 required. For example,
18020 .code
18021 check_srv = smtp
18022 .endd
18023 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18024 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18025 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18026 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18027 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18028 normal way.
18029
18030 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18031 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18032 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18033 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18034 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18035 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18036
18037 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18038 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18039 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18040 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18041 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18042 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18043 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18044 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18045
18046 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18047 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18048
18049
18050
18051 .option dnssec_request_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18052 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18053 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18054 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18055 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18056 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18057 the dnssec request bit set.
18058 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18059
18060
18061
18062 .option dnssec_require_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18063 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18064 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18065 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18066 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18067 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18068 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18069 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18070 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18071
18072
18073
18074 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18075 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18076 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18077 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18078 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18079 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18080 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18081 setting:
18082 .code
18083 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18084 .endd
18085 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18086 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18087 the address record.
18088
18089
18090 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18091 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18092 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18093 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18094
18095
18096
18097
18098 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18099 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18100 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18101 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18102 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18103 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18104 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18105 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18106 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18107 &'resolv.conf'&.
18108
18109
18110
18111 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18112 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18113 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18114 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18115 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18116 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18117 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18118 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18119 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18120 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18121 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18122
18123 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18124 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18125 sense.
18126
18127 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18128 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18129 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18130 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18131 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18132 header rewriting.
18133
18134
18135 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18136 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18137 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18138 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18139 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18140 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18141 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18142 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18143
18144 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18145 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18146 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18147 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18148 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18149 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18150 without processing them independently,
18151 provided the following conditions are met:
18152
18153 .ilist
18154 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18155 &%headers_remove%&.
18156 .next
18157 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18158 the domain.
18159 .endlist
18160
18161
18162
18163
18164 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18165 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18166 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18167 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18168 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18169 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18170 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18171 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18172 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18173 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18174
18175 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18176 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18177 local wildcard.
18178
18179
18180
18181 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18182 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18183 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18184 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18185
18186
18187
18188
18189 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18190 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18191 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18192 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18193 if
18194 .code
18195 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18196 .endd
18197 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18198 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18199 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18200 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18201 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18202 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18203
18204
18205 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18206 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18207 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18208 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18209 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18210
18211 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18212 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18213 such as that implied by
18214 .code
18215 domains = @mx_any
18216 .endd
18217 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18218 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18219 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18220 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18221
18222
18223
18224
18225
18226
18227
18228
18229
18230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18232
18233 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18234 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18235 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18236 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18237 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18238 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18239 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18240 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18241 router handles the address
18242 .code
18243 root@[192.168.1.1]
18244 .endd
18245 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18246 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18247 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18248 .code
18249 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18250 .endd
18251 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18252 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18253
18254 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18255 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18256 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18257 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18258
18259 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18260 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18261 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18262 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18263
18264
18265
18266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18268
18269 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18270 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18271 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18272 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18273 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18274 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18275 must set
18276 .code
18277 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18278 .endd
18279 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18280
18281 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18282 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18283 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18284 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18285 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18286 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18287 must not be specified for it.
18288
18289 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18290 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18291 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18292 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18293 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18294 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18295 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18296
18297
18298 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18299 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18300 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18301 delivery to the address is deferred.
18302
18303
18304 .option port iplookup integer 0
18305 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18306 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18307 call.
18308
18309
18310 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18311 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18312 protocols is to be used.
18313
18314
18315 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18316 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18317 default value is:
18318 .code
18319 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18320 .endd
18321 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18322 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18323
18324
18325 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18326 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18327 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18328 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18329 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18330 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18331 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18332 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18333
18334
18335 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18336 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18337 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18338 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18339 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18340 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18341 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18342 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18343 following could be used:
18344 .code
18345 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18346 reroute = $local_part@$1
18347 .endd
18348
18349 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18350 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18351 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18352 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18353
18354
18355
18356
18357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18359
18360 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18361 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18362 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18363 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18364 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18365 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18366 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18367 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18368 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18369 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18370
18371 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18372 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18373 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18374 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18375 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18376 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18377 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18378
18379 .vindex "&$host$&"
18380 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18381 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18382 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18383 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18384 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18385 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18386 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18387 text string.
18388
18389 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18390 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18391 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18392 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18393 below, following the list of private options.
18394
18395
18396 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18397
18398 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18399 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18400
18401 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18402 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18403
18404 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18405 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18406 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18407 of the following values:
18408 .code
18409 decline
18410 defer
18411 fail
18412 freeze
18413 ignore
18414 pass
18415 .endd
18416 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18417 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18418 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18419 &%pass_router%&),
18420 .oindex "&%more%&"
18421 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18422 router only if &%more%& is true.
18423
18424 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18425 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18426 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18427 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18428
18429 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18430 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18431 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18432
18433
18434 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18435 .cindex "randomized host list"
18436 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18437 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18438 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18439 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18440 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18441 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18442 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18443 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18444
18445 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18446 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18447 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18448 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18449 .code
18450 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18451 .endd
18452 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18453 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18454 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18455 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18456 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18457
18458
18459 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18460 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18461 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18462 example:
18463 .code
18464 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18465 .endd
18466 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18467 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18468 deferred.
18469
18470
18471 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18472 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18473 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18474 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18475
18476
18477 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18478 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18479 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18480 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18481 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18482 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18483 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18484 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18485
18486 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18487 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18488 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18489 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18490 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18491 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18492 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18493 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18494
18495
18496
18497
18498 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18499 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18500 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18501 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18502 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18503 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18504 .display
18505 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18506 .endd
18507 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18508 no options:
18509 .code
18510 route_list = \
18511 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18512 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18513 .endd
18514 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18515 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18516 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18517 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18518 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18519 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18520 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18521 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18522 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18523 in a &%route_list%&).
18524
18525 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18526 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18527 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18528 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18529
18530
18531
18532 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18533 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18534 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18535 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18536 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18537 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18538 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18539 like this:
18540 .code
18541 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18542 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18543 .endd
18544 This data can be accessed by setting
18545 .code
18546 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18547 .endd
18548 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18549 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18550 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18551 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18552 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18553
18554
18555
18556
18557 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18558 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18559 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18560 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18561 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18562 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18563 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18564
18565 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18566 variables are set during its expansion:
18567
18568 .ilist
18569 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18570 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18571 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18572 .code
18573 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18574 .endd
18575 .next
18576 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18577 .next
18578 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18579
18580 .next
18581 .vindex "&$value$&"
18582 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18583 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18584 .code
18585 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18586 .endd
18587 .endlist
18588
18589 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18590 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18591
18592
18593
18594 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18595 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18596 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18597 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18598 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18599 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18600
18601 .ilist
18602 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18603 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18604 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18605 .code
18606 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18607 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18608 .endd
18609 .next
18610 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18611 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18612 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18613 number follows. For example:
18614 .code
18615 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18616 .endd
18617 .endlist
18618
18619 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18620 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18621 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18622 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18623 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18624 transport.
18625
18626 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18627 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18628 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18629 records in the DNS. For example:
18630 .code
18631 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18632 .endd
18633 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18634 example:
18635 .code
18636 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18637 .endd
18638 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18639 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18640 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18641 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18642 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18643 happens is controlled by the
18644 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18645 &%self%& option of the router.
18646
18647 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18648 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18649 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18650 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18651 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18652 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18653 defined by MX preferences.
18654
18655 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18656 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18657 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18658
18659 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18660 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18661 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18662 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18663
18664 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18665 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18666 router.
18667
18668 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18669 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18670 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18671
18672 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18673 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18674
18675
18676
18677 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18678 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18679 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18680 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18681 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18682 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18683 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18684
18685 .ilist
18686 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18687 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18688 .next
18689 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18690 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18691 .next
18692 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18693 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18694 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18695 .next
18696 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18697 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18698 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18699 .endlist
18700
18701 For example:
18702 .code
18703 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18704 domain2 host4:host5
18705 .endd
18706 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18707 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18708 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18709 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18710 call.
18711
18712 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18713 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18714 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18715 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18716 function called.
18717
18718
18719
18720 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18721 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18722
18723 .vindex "&$host$&"
18724 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18725 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18726
18727
18728
18729 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18730 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18731 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18732
18733 .ilist
18734 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18735 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18736 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18737 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18738 .code
18739 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18740 .endd
18741 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18742 your first router something like this:
18743 .code
18744 smart_route:
18745 driver = manualroute
18746 domains = !+local_domains
18747 transport = remote_smtp
18748 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18749 .endd
18750 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18751 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18752 they are tried in order
18753 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18754 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18755 .code
18756 smart_route:
18757 driver = manualroute
18758 transport = remote_smtp
18759 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18760 .endd
18761 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18762 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18763 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18764 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18765 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18766 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18767 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18768 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18769
18770 .next
18771 .cindex "mail hub example"
18772 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18773 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18774 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18775 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18776 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18777 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18778 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18779 lookup is easier to manage.
18780
18781 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18782 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18783 example:
18784 .code
18785 hub_route:
18786 driver = manualroute
18787 transport = remote_smtp
18788 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18789 .endd
18790 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18791 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18792 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18793 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18794 domain can be used to find the host:
18795 .code
18796 through_firewall:
18797 driver = manualroute
18798 transport = remote_smtp
18799 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18800 .endd
18801 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18802 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18803 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18804 next router.
18805
18806 .next
18807 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18808 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18809 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18810 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18811 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18812 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18813 .code
18814 save_in_file:
18815 driver = manualroute
18816 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18817 route_list = saved.domain.example
18818 .endd
18819 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18820 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18821 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18822 .code
18823 save_in_file:
18824 driver = manualroute
18825 route_list = \
18826 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18827 *.saved.domain2.example \
18828 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18829 batch_pipe
18830 .endd
18831 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18832 .vindex "&$host$&"
18833 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18834 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18835 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18836 the address if the lookup fails.
18837
18838 .next
18839 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18840 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18841 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18842 one way it can be done:
18843 .code
18844 # Transport
18845 uucp:
18846 driver = pipe
18847 user = nobody
18848 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18849 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18850 return_fail_output = true
18851
18852 # Router
18853 uucphost:
18854 transport = uucp
18855 driver = manualroute
18856 route_data = \
18857 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18858 .endd
18859 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18860 .code
18861 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18862 .endd
18863 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18864 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18865 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18866 .endlist
18867 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18868 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18869
18870
18871
18872
18873
18874
18875
18876
18877 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18878 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18879
18880 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18881 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18882 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18883 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18884 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18885 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18886 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18887 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18888 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18889 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18890 options:
18891 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18892
18893 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18894 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18895 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18896 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18897 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18898
18899
18900 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18901 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18902 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18903 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18904 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18905 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18906
18907
18908 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18909 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18910 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18911 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18912 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18913 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18914 not set, a value for the gid also.
18915
18916 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18917 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18918 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18919 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18920 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18921 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18922 gid.
18923
18924
18925 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18926 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18927 before running the command.
18928
18929
18930 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18931 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18932 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18933 timeout.
18934
18935
18936 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18937 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18938 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18939 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18940 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18941
18942 .ilist
18943 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18944 below).
18945 .next
18946 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18947 &%no_more%& is set.
18948 .next
18949 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18950 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18951 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18952 included in the SMTP response.
18953 .next
18954 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18955 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18956 included in any SMTP response.
18957 .next
18958 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18959 .next
18960 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18961 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18962 .next
18963 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18964 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18965 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18966 .endlist
18967
18968 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18969 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18970 the page):
18971 .code
18972 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18973 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18974 .endd
18975 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18976 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18977 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18978 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18979
18980 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18981 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18982 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18983 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18984 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18985
18986 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18987 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18988 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18989 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18990 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18991
18992 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18993 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18994 variable. For example, this return line
18995 .code
18996 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18997 .endd
18998 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18999 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19000 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19001 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19002
19003
19004
19005
19006 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19007 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19008
19009 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19010 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19011 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19012 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19013 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19014 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19015 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19016 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19017 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19018 redirected in several different ways:
19019
19020 .ilist
19021 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19022 independently.
19023 .next
19024 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19025 .next
19026 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19027 .next
19028 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19029 .next
19030 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19031 .next
19032 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19033 .next
19034 It can be discarded.
19035 .endlist
19036
19037 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19038 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19039 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19040 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19041
19042 .new
19043 If success DSNs have been requested
19044 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19045 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19046 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19047 .wen
19048
19049
19050
19051 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19052 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19053 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19054 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19055 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19056 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19057 .code
19058 system_aliases:
19059 driver = redirect
19060 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19061 .endd
19062 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19063 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19064 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19065 cause delivery to be deferred.
19066
19067 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19068 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19069 .code
19070 userforward:
19071 driver = redirect
19072 check_local_user
19073 file = $home/.forward
19074 no_verify
19075 .endd
19076 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19077 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19078 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19079 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19080 comments.
19081
19082
19083
19084 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19085 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19086 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19087 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19088
19089 .ilist
19090 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19091 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19092 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19093 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19094 .next
19095 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19096 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19097 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19098 saves some resources.
19099 .endlist
19100
19101
19102
19103
19104
19105
19106 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19107 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19108 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19109 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19110 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19111
19112 .ilist
19113 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19114 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19115 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19116 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19117 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19118 document is intended for use by end users.
19119 .next
19120 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19121 described in the next section.
19122 .endlist
19123
19124 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19125 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19126 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19127 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19128 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19129
19130
19131
19132 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19133 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19134 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19135 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19136 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19137 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19138 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19139 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19140 commas or newlines.
19141 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19142 quotes.
19143
19144 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19145 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19146 next newline character is ignored.
19147
19148 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19149 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19150 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19151 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19152 removed.
19153
19154 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19155 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19156 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19157 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19158 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19159 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19160 setting:
19161 .code
19162 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19163 .endd
19164
19165
19166 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19167 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19168 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19169 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19170 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19171 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19172 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19173 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19174 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19175 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19176 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19177
19178 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19179 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19180 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19181 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19182 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19183 .code
19184 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19185 .endd
19186 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19187 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19188 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19189 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19190 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19191 synonymously.
19192
19193 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19194 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19195 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19196 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19197 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19198
19199 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19200 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19201 contains:
19202 .code
19203 Sam.Reman: spqr
19204 .endd
19205 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19206 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19207 this forward file:
19208 .code
19209 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19210 .endd
19211 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19212 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19213 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19214 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19215 should really contain
19216 .code
19217 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19218 .endd
19219 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19220 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19221 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19222
19223
19224
19225 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19226 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19227 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19228
19229 .ilist
19230 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19231 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19232 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19233 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19234 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19235 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19236 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19237
19238 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19239 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19240 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19241 in double quotes, for example:
19242 .code
19243 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19244 .endd
19245 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19246 quote just the command. An item such as
19247 .code
19248 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19249 .endd
19250 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19251
19252 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19253 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19254 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19255 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19256 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19257 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19258 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19259 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19260 an &%accept%& router.
19261
19262 .next
19263 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19264 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19265 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19266 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19267 .code
19268 /home/world/minbari
19269 .endd
19270 is treated as a file name, but
19271 .code
19272 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19273 .endd
19274 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19275 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19276 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19277 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19278
19279 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19280 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19281
19282 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19283 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19284 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19285 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19286
19287 .next
19288 .cindex "included address list"
19289 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19290 If an item is of the form
19291 .code
19292 :include:<path name>
19293 .endd
19294 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19295 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19296 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19297 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19298 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19299 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19300 .code
19301 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19302 .endd
19303 It must be given as
19304 .code
19305 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19306 .endd
19307 .next
19308 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19309 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19310 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19311 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19312 .cindex "black hole"
19313 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19314 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19315 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19316 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19317
19318 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19319 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19320 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19321 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19322 &_/dev/null_&.
19323
19324 .next
19325 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19326 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19327 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19328 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19329 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19330 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19331 redirection items of the form
19332 .code
19333 :defer:
19334 :fail:
19335 .endd
19336 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19337 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19338 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19339 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19340 .code
19341 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19342 .endd
19343 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19344 of a
19345 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19346 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19347 default.
19348 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19349 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19350 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19351
19352 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19353 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19354 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19355 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19356 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19357 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19358 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19359 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19360 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19361 ignored.
19362
19363 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19364 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19365 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19366 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19367
19368 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19369 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19370 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19371 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19372 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19373
19374 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19375 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19376 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19377 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19378 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19379 rules still apply.
19380
19381 .next
19382 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19383 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19384 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19385 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19386 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19387 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19388 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19389 .endlist
19390
19391
19392 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19393 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19394 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19395 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19396 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19397 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19398 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19399 aliasing scheme of the type
19400 .code
19401 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19402 localpart1: pipe
19403 localpart2: pipe
19404 .endd
19405 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19406 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19407 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19408 such as
19409 .code
19410 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19411 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19412 .endd
19413 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19414 the pipes are distinct.
19415
19416
19417
19418 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19419 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19420 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19421 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19422 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19423 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19424 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19425 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19426 can be used to avoid this.
19427
19428
19429 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19430 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19431 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19432 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19433 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19434 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19435 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19436
19437
19438
19439 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19440
19441 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19442 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19443
19444
19445 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19446 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19447 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19448
19449
19450 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19451 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19452 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19453 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19454
19455
19456 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19457 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19458 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19459 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19460 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19461 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19462 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19463
19464 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19465 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19466
19467
19468 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19469 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19470 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19471 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19472 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19473
19474
19475
19476 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19477 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19478 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19479 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19480 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19481 let ordinary users do.
19482
19483
19484
19485 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19486 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19487 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19488 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19489 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19490 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19491
19492 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19493 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19494 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19495 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19496 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19497 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19498 .code
19499 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19500 .endd
19501 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19502 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19503 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19504 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19505 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19506 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19507 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19508 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19509
19510
19511 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19512 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19513 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19514 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19515 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19516 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19517 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19518 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19519
19520
19521
19522 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19523 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19524 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19525 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19526 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19527 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19528
19529
19530 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19531 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19532 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19533 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19534 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19535 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19536
19537 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19538 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19539 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19540 .code
19541 data = #Exim filter\n\
19542 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19543 .endd
19544 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19545 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19546 choice into a newline.
19547
19548
19549 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19550 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19551 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19552 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19553 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19554
19555
19556 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19557 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19558 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19559 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19560 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19561 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19562 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19563 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19564
19565 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19566 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19567 runs a check on the containing directory,
19568 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19569 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19570 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19571 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19572 not, the router declines.
19573
19574
19575 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19576 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19577 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19578 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19579 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19580 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19581 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19582
19583
19584 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19585 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19586 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19587 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19588 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19589
19590
19591 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19592 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19593 redirection list.
19594
19595
19596 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19597 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19598 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19599
19600
19601
19602
19603 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19604 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19605 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19606 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19607 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19608 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19609 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19610 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19611 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19612
19613
19614 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19615 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19616 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19617 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19618 functions.
19619
19620 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19621 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19622 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19623 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19624
19625 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19626 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19627 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19628 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19629 &_.forward_& files).
19630
19631
19632 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19633 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19634 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19635
19636
19637 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19638 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19639 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19640 of the embedded Perl support.
19641
19642
19643 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19644 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19645 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19646
19647
19648 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19649 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19650 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19651
19652
19653 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19654 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19655 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19656 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19657 &%one_time%& is set.
19658
19659
19660 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19661 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19662 to make use of &%run%& items.
19663
19664
19665 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19666 If this option is true, items of the form
19667 .code
19668 :include:<path name>
19669 .endd
19670 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19671
19672
19673 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19674 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19675 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19676 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19677 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19678
19679
19680 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19681 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19682 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19683
19684
19685 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19686 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19687 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19688 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19689 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19690
19691
19692
19693
19694 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19695 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19696 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19697 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19698 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19699 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19700 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19701
19702
19703 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19704 .cindex "EACCES"
19705 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19706 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19707 file did not exist.
19708
19709
19710 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19711 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19712 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19713 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19714 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19715
19716 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19717 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19718 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19719 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19720 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19721 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19722 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19723 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19724
19725
19726
19727 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19728 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19729 redirection list must start with this directory.
19730
19731
19732 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19733 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19734 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19735
19736
19737 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19738 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19739 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19740 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19741 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19742 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19743 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19744 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19745 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19746 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19747 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19748 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19749 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19750 before they subscribed.
19751
19752 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19753 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19754 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19755 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19756 attempt.
19757
19758 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19759 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19760 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19761 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19762
19763 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19764 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19765 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19766
19767 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19768 &%one_time%&.
19769
19770 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19771 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19772 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19773 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19774 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19775 expansion.
19776
19777
19778 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19779 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19780 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19781 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19782 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19783 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19784 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19785 See &%check_owner%& above.
19786
19787
19788 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19789 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19790 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19791 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19792
19793
19794 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19795 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19796 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19797 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19798 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19799 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19800 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19801
19802
19803 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19804 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19805 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19806 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19807 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19808 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19809 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19810 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19811
19812 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19813 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19814 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19815 addresses.
19816
19817 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19818 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19819 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19820 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19821 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19822 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19823 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19824 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19825 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19826 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19827
19828
19829 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19830 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19831 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19832 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19833 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19834 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19835
19836
19837 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19838 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19839 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19840 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19841 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19842 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19843
19844
19845 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19846 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19847 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19848 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19849 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19850
19851
19852 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19853 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19854 :subaddress part of an address.
19855
19856 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19857 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19858 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19859 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19860
19861
19862 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19863 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19864 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19865 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19866 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19867 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19868 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19869
19870
19871
19872 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19873 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19874 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19875 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19876 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19877 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19878 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19879 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19880 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19881 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19882 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19883 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19884 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19885 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19886 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19887 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19888
19889 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19890 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19891 the following routers.
19892
19893 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19894 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19895 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19896 so it is passed to the following routers.
19897
19898 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19899 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19900 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19901 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19902
19903 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19904 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19905 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19906 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19907 .code
19908 userforward:
19909 driver = redirect
19910 allow_filter
19911 check_local_user
19912 file = $home/.forward
19913 file_transport = address_file
19914 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19915 reply_transport = address_reply
19916 no_verify
19917 skip_syntax_errors
19918 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19919 syntax_errors_text = \
19920 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19921 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19922 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19923 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19924 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19925 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19926 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19927 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19928 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19929 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19930 .endd
19931 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19932 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19933 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19934 .code
19935 real_localuser:
19936 driver = accept
19937 check_local_user
19938 local_part_prefix = real-
19939 transport = local_delivery
19940 .endd
19941 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19942 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19943 .code
19944 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19945 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19946 .endd
19947
19948
19949 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19950 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19951
19952
19953 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19954 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19955 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19956 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19957
19958
19959
19960
19961
19962
19963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19965
19966 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19967 "Environment for local transports"
19968 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19969 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19970 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19971 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19972 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19973 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19974 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19975
19976 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19977 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19978 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19979 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19980
19981 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19982 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19983 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19984 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19985 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19986
19987
19988
19989 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19990 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19991 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19992 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19993 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19994 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19995 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19996 time.
19997
19998 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19999 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20000 .code
20001 my_transport:
20002 driver = pipe
20003 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20004 .endd
20005 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20006 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20007 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20008 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20009
20010
20011
20012
20013 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20014 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20015 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20016 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20017 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20018 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20019 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20020 group (set by the transport). For example:
20021 .code
20022 # Routers ...
20023 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20024 local_users:
20025 driver = accept
20026 check_local_user
20027 transport = group_delivery
20028
20029 # Transports ...
20030 # This transport overrides the group
20031 group_delivery:
20032 driver = appendfile
20033 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20034 group = mail
20035 .endd
20036 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20037 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20038 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20039 set.
20040
20041 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20042 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20043 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20044 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20045 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20046 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20047
20048 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20049 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20050 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20051 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20052 original gid is also used.
20053
20054 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20055 following that is set is used:
20056
20057 .ilist
20058 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20059 .next
20060 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20061 .next
20062 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20063 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20064 .next
20065 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20066 .next
20067 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20068 the uid is the creator's uid;
20069 .next
20070 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20071 .endlist
20072
20073 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20074 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20075 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20076 The first of the following that is set is used:
20077
20078 .ilist
20079 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20080 .next
20081 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20082 .next
20083 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20084 .next
20085 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20086 .next
20087 The Exim uid.
20088 .endlist
20089
20090 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20091 &%never_users%& list.
20092
20093
20094
20095
20096
20097 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20098 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20099 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20100 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20101 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20102 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20103 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20104 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20105 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20106 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20107
20108 .ilist
20109 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20110 .next
20111 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20112 .next
20113 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20114 .next
20115 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20116 .endlist
20117
20118 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20119
20120 .ilist
20121 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20122 .next
20123 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20124 .endlist
20125
20126
20127 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20128 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20129 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20130
20131
20132
20133 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20134 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20135 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20136 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20137 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20138 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20139 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20140 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20141 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20142 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20143 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20144 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20145 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20146 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20147
20148
20149
20150
20151
20152
20153
20154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20156
20157 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20158 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20159 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20160 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20161 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20162
20163
20164 .option body_only transports boolean false
20165 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20166 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20167 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20168 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20169 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20170 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20171 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20172 automatically suppress them.
20173
20174
20175 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20176 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20177 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20178 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20179 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20180 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20181
20182
20183 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20184 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20185 deliveries by the transport or for any
20186 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20187 what you are doing.
20188
20189
20190 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20191 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20192 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20193 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20194 transport is run.
20195 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20196 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20197 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20198 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20199 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20200 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20201 one.
20202 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20203 transport and the router that called it.
20204
20205 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20206 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20207 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20208 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20209 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20210 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20211 safely be resent to other recipients.
20212
20213
20214 .option driver transports string unset
20215 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20216 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20217
20218
20219 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20220 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20221 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20222 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20223 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20224 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20225 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20226 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20227 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20228 resent to other recipients.
20229
20230
20231 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20232 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20233 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20234 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20235 &%user%& (see below).
20236
20237
20238 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20239 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20240 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20241 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
20242 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20243 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20244 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20245 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20246 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20247 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20248
20249 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20250 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20251
20252
20253 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20254 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20255 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20256 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20257 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20258 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20259 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20260 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20261
20262
20263 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20264 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20265 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20266 This option specifies a list of header names, colon-separated;
20267 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20268 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20269 routers.
20270 Each list item is separately expanded.
20271 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20272 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20273 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20274
20275 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20276 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20277
20278
20279
20280 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20281 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20282 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20283 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20284 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20285 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20286 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20287 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20288 example,
20289 .code
20290 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20291 x@y w@z
20292 .endd
20293 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20294 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20295 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20296 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20297 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20298 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20299 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20300 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20301 change envelope recipients at this time.
20302
20303
20304 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20305 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20306 .vindex "&$home$&"
20307 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20308 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20309 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20310 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20311 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20312 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20313 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20314 deferred.
20315
20316
20317 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20318 .cindex "additional groups"
20319 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20320 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20321 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20322 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20323 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20324
20325
20326 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20327 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20328 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20329 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20330 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20331 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20332 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20333 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20334 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20335 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20336 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20337 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20338 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20339 delivered.
20340
20341
20342
20343 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20344 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20345 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20346 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20347 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20348 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20349 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20350 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20351 that contains
20352 .code
20353 local_part_prefix = *-
20354 .endd
20355 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20356 is delivered with
20357 .code
20358 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20359 .endd
20360 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20361 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20362 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20363 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20364 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20365
20366
20367 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20368 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20369 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20370 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20371 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20372 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20373 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20374 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20375 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20376
20377 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20378 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20379 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20380 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20381
20382 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20383 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20384 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20385
20386
20387 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20388 .cindex "envelope sender"
20389 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20390 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20391 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20392 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20393 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20394 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20395 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20396 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20397 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20398
20399 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20400 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20401
20402 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20403 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20404 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20405 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20406 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20407 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20408 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20409
20410 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20411 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20412 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20413 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20414 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20415
20416
20417
20418 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20419 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20420 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20421 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20422 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20423 have easy access to it.
20424
20425 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20426 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20427 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20428 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20429 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20430 recipients.
20431
20432
20433 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20434 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20435
20436
20437 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20438 .cindex "shadow transport"
20439 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20440 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20441 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20442
20443 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20444 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20445 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20446 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20447 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20448 cause a log line to be written.
20449
20450 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20451 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20452 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20453 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20454 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20455 of the form
20456 .code
20457 ST=<shadow transport name>
20458 .endd
20459 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20460 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20461 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20462 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20463 headers that some sites insist on.
20464
20465
20466 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20467 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20468 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20469 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20470 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20471 individual users or via a system filter.
20472
20473 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20474 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20475 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20476 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20477 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20478
20479 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20480 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20481 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20482 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20483 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20484 &(pipe)& transports.
20485
20486 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20487 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20488 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20489 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20490 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20491
20492 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20493 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20494 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20495 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20496
20497 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20498 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20499 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20500 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20501 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20502 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20503
20504 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20505 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20506 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20507 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20508 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20509 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20510 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20511 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20512
20513 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20514 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20515 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20516 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20517 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20518 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20519 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20520 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20521 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20522 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20523
20524 .vindex "&$host$&"
20525 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20526 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20527 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20528 which the message is being sent. For example:
20529 .code
20530 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20531 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20532 .endd
20533
20534 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20535 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20536 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20537 .ilist
20538 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20539 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20540 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20541 example:
20542 .code
20543 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20544 .endd
20545 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20546 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20547 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20548 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20549 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20550 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20551 .next
20552 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20553 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20554 arguments. Consider this example:
20555 .code
20556 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20557 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20558 .endd
20559 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20560 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20561 .code
20562 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20563 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20564 .endd
20565 .endlist
20566
20567 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20568 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20569 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20570 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20571 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20572 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20573 bounced from a transport filter.
20574
20575 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20576 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20577 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20578
20579
20580 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20581 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20582 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20583 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20584 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20585 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20586 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20587 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20588 becomes a temporary error.
20589
20590
20591 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20592 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20593 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20594 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20595 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20596 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20597 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20598 option is not set.
20599
20600 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20601 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20602 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20603
20604 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20605 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20606 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20607 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20608 retry data.
20609 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20610 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20611 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20612
20613
20614
20615
20616
20617
20618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20620
20621 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20622 "Address batching"
20623 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20624 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20625 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20626 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20627 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20628 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20629 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20630
20631 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20632 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20633 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20634 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20635 local transport, for example:
20636
20637 .ilist
20638 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20639 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20640 recipients saves space.
20641 .next
20642 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20643 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20644 .next
20645 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20646 to a scanner program or
20647 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20648 acceptable.
20649 .endlist
20650
20651 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20652 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20653 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20654
20655 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20656 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20657 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20658 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20659 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20660 to certain conditions:
20661
20662 .ilist
20663 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20664 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20665 batching is possible.
20666 .next
20667 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20668 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20669 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20670 .next
20671 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20672 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20673 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20674 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20675 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20676 from taking place.
20677 .next
20678 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20679 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20680 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20681 be the same.
20682 .endlist
20683
20684 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20685 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20686 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20687 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20688 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20689 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20690 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20691 .code
20692 check_string = "."
20693 escape_string = ".."
20694 .endd
20695 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20696 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20697 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20698
20699 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20700 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20701 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20702 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20703 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20704 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20705
20706 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20707 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20708 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20709 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20710 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20711 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20712 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20713 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20714 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20715
20716
20717
20718
20719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20721
20722 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20723 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20724 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20725 .cindex "directory creation"
20726 .cindex "creating directories"
20727 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20728 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20729 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20730 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20731 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20732 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20733 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20734 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20735 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20736 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20737
20738 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20739 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20740 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20741 included.
20742
20743 .cindex "quota" "system"
20744 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20745 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20746 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20747
20748 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20749 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20750 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20751 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20752
20753 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20754 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20755 private options.
20756
20757 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20758 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20759 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20760 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20761 option).
20762
20763
20764
20765 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20766 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20767 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20768 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20769 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20770
20771 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20772 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20773 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20774 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20775 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20776 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20777 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20778 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20779 operation. There are two cases:
20780
20781 .ilist
20782 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20783 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20784 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20785 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20786 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20787 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20788 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20789 .next
20790 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20791 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20792 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20793 .endlist
20794
20795
20796 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20797 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20798 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20799 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20800 form:
20801 .code
20802 save folder23
20803 .endd
20804 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20805 .code
20806 require "fileinto";
20807 fileinto "folder23";
20808 .endd
20809 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20810 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20811 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20812 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20813 way of handling this requirement:
20814 .code
20815 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20816 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20817 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20818 {$address_file} \
20819 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20820 }} \
20821 }
20822 .endd
20823 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20824 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20825 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20826
20827 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20828 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20829 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20830 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20831 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20832 path to the transport.
20833
20834 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20835 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20836
20837
20838
20839
20840 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20841 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20842
20843
20844
20845 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20846 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20847 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20848 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20849 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20850 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20851 delivery is deferred.
20852
20853
20854 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20855 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20856 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20857 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20858 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20859 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20860 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20861 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20862
20863
20864 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20865 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20866 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20867 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20868 file.
20869
20870
20871 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20872 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20873
20874
20875 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20876 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20877 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20878 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20879 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20880
20881
20882 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20883 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20884 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20885 process is running.
20886
20887
20888 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20889 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20890 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20891 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20892 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20893 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20894 contains is significant.
20895
20896 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20897 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20898 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20899 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20900 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20901
20902 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20903 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20904 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20905 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20906 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20907 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20908 .code
20909 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20910 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20911 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20912 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20913 .endd
20914 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20915 .cindex "directory creation"
20916 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20917 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20918 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20919
20920 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20921 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20922 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20923 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20924 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20925
20926
20927
20928 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20929 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20930 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20931 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20932 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20933 beneath.
20934
20935 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20936 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20937 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20938 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20939 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20940 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20941 &%file_must_exist%&.
20942
20943
20944 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20945 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20946 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20947 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20948
20949 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20950 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20951 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20952 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20953 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20954
20955
20956 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20957 .cindex "base62"
20958 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20959 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20960 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20961 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20962 .code
20963 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20964 .endd
20965 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20966 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20967 option.
20968
20969
20970 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20971 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20972 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20973
20974
20975 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20976 See &%check_string%& above.
20977
20978
20979 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20980 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20981 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20982 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20983 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20984 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20985 &%file%&.
20986
20987 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20988 .cindex "locking files"
20989 .cindex "lock files"
20990 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20991 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20992
20993 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20994 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20995 examples:
20996 .code
20997 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20998 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20999 file = $home/inbox
21000 .endd
21001 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21002 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21003 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21004 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21005 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21006 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21007
21008
21009
21010 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21011 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21012 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21013 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21014 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21015 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21016 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21017 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21018 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21019 this added to it:
21020 .code
21021 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21022 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21023 .endd
21024 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21025 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21026 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21027 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21028 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21029 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21030 delivery is deferred.
21031
21032
21033 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21034 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21035 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21036 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21037
21038
21039 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21040 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21041 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21042 .cindex "locking files"
21043 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21044 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21045 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21046 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21047 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21048 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21049 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21050 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21051
21052 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21053 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21054 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21055 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21056
21057 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21058 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21059 retries is
21060 .code
21061 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21062 .endd
21063 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21064 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21065 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21066
21067 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21068 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21069 .code
21070 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21071 .endd
21072
21073 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21074 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21075 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21076 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21077
21078
21079 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21080 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21081 for details of locking.
21082
21083
21084 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21085 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21086 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21087
21088
21089 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21090 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21091 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21092
21093
21094 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21095 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21096 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21097 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21098 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21099
21100
21101 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21102 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21103 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21104 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21105 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21106 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21107 external source that maintains the data.
21108
21109
21110 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21111 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21112 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21113 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21114 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21115 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21116 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21117 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21118
21119
21120
21121 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21122 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21123 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21124 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21125 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21126 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21127 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21128 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21129 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21130 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21131
21132
21133 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21134 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21135 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21136 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21137 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21138 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21139 calculation. The default value is:
21140 .code
21141 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21142 .endd
21143 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21144 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21145 &_Trash_&
21146 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21147 .code
21148 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21149 .endd
21150 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21151 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21152 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21153 directly into that directory.
21154
21155
21156 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21157 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21158 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21159
21160
21161 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21162 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21163 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21164
21165
21166 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21167 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21168 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21169 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21170 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21171 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21172 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21173 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21174
21175 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21176 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21177 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21178 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21179 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21180 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21181 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21182 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21183 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21184 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21185
21186
21187 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21188 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21189 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21190 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21191 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21192 below for further details.
21193
21194
21195 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21196 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21197 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21198
21199
21200 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21201 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21202 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21203
21204
21205 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21206 .cindex "locking files"
21207 .cindex "file" "locking"
21208 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21209 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21210 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21211 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21212 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21213 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21214 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21215
21216 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21217 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21218 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21219 combination:
21220 .code
21221 mbx_format = true
21222 message_prefix =
21223 message_suffix =
21224 .endd
21225 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21226 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21227 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21228 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21229 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21230 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21231 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21232 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21233
21234 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21235 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21236 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21237 append messages to it.
21238
21239
21240 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21241 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21242 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21243 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21244 in which case it is:
21245 .code
21246 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21247 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21248 .endd
21249 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21250 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21251
21252 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21253 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21254 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21255 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21256 setting
21257 .code
21258 message_suffix =
21259 .endd
21260 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21261 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21262
21263 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21264 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21265 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21266 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21267 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21268 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21269 value, and this option is ignored.
21270
21271
21272 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21273 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21274 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21275 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21276 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21277
21278
21279 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21280 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21281 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21282 on users about incoming mail.
21283
21284
21285 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21286 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21287 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21288 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21289 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21290 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21291 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21292 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21293 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21294
21295 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21296 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21297 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21298
21299 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21300 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21301 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21302 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21303 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21304 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21305
21306 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21307 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21308 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21309 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21310 be handled.
21311
21312 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21313
21314 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21315 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21316 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21317 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21318 system quota failures.
21319
21320 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21321 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21322 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21323 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21324 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21325 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21326 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21327 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21328 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21329 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21330
21331
21332 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21333 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21334 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21335 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21336 delivery directory.
21337
21338
21339 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21340 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21341 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21342 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21343 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21344 &"no quota"&.
21345
21346
21347 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21348 See &%quota%& above.
21349
21350
21351 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21352 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21353 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21354 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21355 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21356 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21357 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21358
21359 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21360 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21361 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21362 the file length to the file name. For example:
21363 .code
21364 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21365 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21366 .endd
21367 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21368 number of lines in the message.
21369
21370 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21371 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21372 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21373
21374 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21375
21376
21377 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21378 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21379 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21380 .code
21381 quota_warn_message = "\
21382 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21383 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21384 This message is automatically created \
21385 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21386 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21387 a warning threshold that is\n\
21388 set by the system administrator.\n"
21389 .endd
21390
21391
21392 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21393 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21394 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21395 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21396 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21397 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21398 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21399 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21400 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21401 sign. For example:
21402 .code
21403 quota = 10M
21404 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21405 .endd
21406 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21407 percent sign is ignored.
21408
21409 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21410 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21411 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21412 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21413 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21414 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21415 .code
21416 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21417 .endd
21418 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21419 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21420 option.
21421
21422 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21423 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21424 percentage.
21425
21426
21427 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21428 .cindex "envelope sender"
21429 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21430 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21431 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21432 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21433 for details of batch SMTP.
21434
21435
21436 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21437 .cindex "carriage return"
21438 .cindex "linefeed"
21439 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21440 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21441 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21442 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21443
21444 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21445 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21446 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21447 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21448 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21449 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21450
21451
21452 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21453 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21454 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21455 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21456 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21457 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21458
21459
21460 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21461 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21462 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21463 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21464 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21465
21466 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21467 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21468 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21469 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21470
21471 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21472 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21473 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21474 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21475 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21476 error.
21477
21478 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21479 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21480
21481
21482 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21483 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21484 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21485 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21486 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21487 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21488 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21489
21490 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21491 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21492 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21493 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21494 file corruption.
21495
21496 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21497 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21498 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21499
21500
21501 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21502 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21503 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21504 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21505 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21506 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21507 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21508 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21509 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21510
21511 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21512 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21513 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21514 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21515
21516
21517
21518
21519 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21520 .cindex "appending to a file"
21521 .cindex "file" "appending"
21522 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21523
21524 .ilist
21525 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21526 return is given.
21527
21528 .next
21529 .cindex "directory creation"
21530 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21531 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21532 &%directory_mode%& option.
21533
21534 .next
21535 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21536 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21537 transport.
21538
21539 .next
21540 .cindex "file" "locking"
21541 .cindex "locking files"
21542 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21543 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21544 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21545
21546 .olist
21547 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21548 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21549 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21550 .next
21551 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21552 .next
21553 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21554 Unlink the hitching post name.
21555 .next
21556 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21557 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21558 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21559 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21560 .next
21561 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21562 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21563 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21564 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21565 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21566 it before trying again.
21567 .endlist olist
21568
21569 .next
21570 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21571 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21572 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21573
21574 .next
21575 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21576 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21577 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21578 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21579 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21580 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21581 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21582 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21583 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21584 checked.
21585
21586 .next
21587 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21588 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21589 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21590 delivery is deferred.
21591
21592 .next
21593 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21594 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21595 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21596 permissions.
21597
21598 .next
21599 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21600 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21601 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21602
21603 .next
21604 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21605 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21606 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21607
21608 .next
21609 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21610 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21611 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21612 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21613 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21614 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21615 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21616 that prevents link following.
21617
21618 .next
21619 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21620 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21621 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21622 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21623 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21624
21625 .next
21626 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21627
21628 .next
21629 .cindex "file" "locking"
21630 .cindex "locking files"
21631 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21632 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21633 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21634 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21635 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21636 .code
21637 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21638 .endd
21639 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21640 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21641 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21642
21643 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21644 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21645 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21646
21647 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21648 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21649 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21650 delivery is deferred.
21651
21652 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21653 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21654 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21655 immediately. It retries up to
21656 .code
21657 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21658 .endd
21659 times (rounded up).
21660 .endlist
21661
21662 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21663 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21664
21665
21666 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21667 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21668 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21669 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21670 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21671 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21672 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21673 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21674 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21675 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21676
21677 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21678 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21679 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21680 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21681 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21682 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21683 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21684
21685 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21686 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21687 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21688 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21689
21690
21691 .cindex "maildir format"
21692 .cindex "mailstore format"
21693 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21694 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21695 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21696 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21697 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21698
21699 .cindex "directory creation"
21700 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21701 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21702 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21703 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21704 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21705 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21706 deferred.
21707
21708
21709
21710 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21711 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21712 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21713 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21714 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21715 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21716 &_new_& subdirectory.
21717
21718 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21719 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21720 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21721 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21722 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21723 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21724 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21725
21726 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21727 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21728 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21729 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21730 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21731 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21732 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21733 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21734
21735 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21736 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21737 folders. Consider this example:
21738 .code
21739 maildir_format = true
21740 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21741 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21742 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21743 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21744 .endd
21745 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21746 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21747 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21748 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21749 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21750 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21751
21752 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21753 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21754 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21755 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21756 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21757
21758 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21759 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21760 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21761
21762 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21763 .cindex "maildir++"
21764 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21765 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21766 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21767 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21768 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21769 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21770 amount of space used.
21771
21772 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21773 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21774 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21775 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21776 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21777 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21778
21779
21780
21781
21782 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21783 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21784 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21785 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21786 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21787 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21788
21789
21790 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21791 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21792 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21793 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21794 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21795 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21796 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21797 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21798 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21799 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21800 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21801 backwards compatibility).
21802
21803 For one common implementation, you might set:
21804 .code
21805 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21806 .endd
21807 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21808
21809 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21810 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21811 &[stat()]& each message file.
21812
21813
21814 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21815 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21816 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21817 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21818 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21819 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21820 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21821 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21822 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21823
21824 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21825 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21826 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21827 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21828 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21829 need to know the quota.
21830
21831 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21832 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21833
21834 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21835 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21836 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21837 details.
21838
21839
21840 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21841 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21842 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21843 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21844 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21845 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21846 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21847 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21848
21849 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21850 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21851 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21852 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21853 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21854 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21855
21856 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21857 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21858 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21859 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21860 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21861 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21862
21863 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21864 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21865 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21866 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21867
21868
21869 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21870 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21871 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21872 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21873 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21874 .code
21875 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21876 .endd
21877 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21878 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21879 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21880 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21881 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21882
21883
21884
21885
21886
21887
21888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21890
21891 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21892 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21893 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21894 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21895 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21896 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21897 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21898 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21899
21900 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21901 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21902 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21903 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21904 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21905
21906
21907 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21908 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21909 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21910 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21911 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21912
21913 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21914 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21915 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21916 transport is run as a consequence of a
21917 &%mail%&
21918 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21919 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21920 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21921 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21922 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21923 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21924
21925 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21926 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21927 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21928 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21929
21930 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21931 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21932 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21933 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21934 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21935 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21936 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21937
21938 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21939 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21940 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21941 the transport defers.
21942 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21943 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21944
21945 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21946 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21947 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21948 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21949
21950 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21951 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21952 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21953 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21954 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21955 problems. They are just discarded.
21956
21957
21958
21959 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21960 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21961
21962 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21963 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21964 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21965
21966
21967 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21968 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21969 when the message is specified by the transport.
21970
21971
21972 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21973 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21974 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21975 string comes first.
21976
21977
21978 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21979 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21980 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21981
21982
21983 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21984 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21985 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21986
21987
21988 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21989 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21990 specified by the transport.
21991
21992
21993 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21994 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21995 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21996 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21997
21998
21999 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22000 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22001 the message is specified by the transport.
22002
22003
22004 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22005 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22006 used.
22007
22008
22009 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22010 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22011 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22012 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22013 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22014
22015
22016
22017 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22018 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22019 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22020 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22021
22022 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22023 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22024 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22025 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22026 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22027 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22028 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22029 infinity.
22030
22031 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22032 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22033 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22034 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22035 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22036
22037 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22038 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22039 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22040 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22041 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22042 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22043
22044
22045 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22046 See &%once%& above.
22047
22048
22049 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22050 See &%once%& above.
22051 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22052
22053
22054 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22055 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22056 specified by the transport.
22057
22058
22059 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22060 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22061 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22062 configuration option.
22063
22064
22065 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22066 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22067 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22068 automatic responses. For example:
22069 .code
22070 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22071 .endd
22072 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22073 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22074 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22075 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22076 small.
22077
22078
22079
22080 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22081 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22082 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22083 the text comes first.
22084
22085
22086 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22087 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22088 when the message is specified by the transport.
22089 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22090 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22091
22092
22093
22094
22095 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22097
22098 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22099 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22100 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22101 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22102 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22103 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22104 specified command
22105 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22106 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22107 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22108 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22109 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22110 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22111 .code
22112 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22113 .endd
22114 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22115 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22116 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22117 as follows:
22118
22119 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22120 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22121
22122
22123 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22124 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22125 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22126 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22127 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22128
22129
22130 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22131 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22132 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22133 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22134 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22135 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22136 LMTP protocol.
22137
22138 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22139 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22140 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22141 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22142 in its response to the LHLO command.
22143
22144 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22145 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22146 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22147 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22148
22149
22150 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22151 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22152 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22153 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22154 LMTP transport:
22155 .code
22156 lmtp:
22157 driver = lmtp
22158 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22159 batch_max = 20
22160 user = exim
22161 .endd
22162 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22163 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22164
22165
22166
22167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22169
22170 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22171 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22172 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22173 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22174 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22175 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22176 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22177 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22178 following ways:
22179
22180 .ilist
22181 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22182 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22183 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22184 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22185 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22186 .next
22187 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22188 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22189 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22190 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22191 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22192 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22193 that are routed to the transport.
22194 .next
22195 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22196 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22197 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22198 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22199 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22200 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22201 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22202 .endlist
22203
22204
22205 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22206 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22207 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22208
22209 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22210 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22211 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22212 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22213 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22214 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22215 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22216
22217
22218 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22219 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22220 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22221 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22222 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22223
22224
22225
22226
22227 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22228 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22229 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22230 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22231 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22232 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22233 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22234 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22235 &"local delivery failed"&.
22236
22237 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22238 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22239 will be sent as normal.
22240
22241 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22242 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22243 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22244 apply in this case.
22245
22246 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22247 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22248 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22249 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22250
22251 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22252 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22253 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22254 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22255 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22256 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22257 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22258 &%temp_errors%&.
22259
22260
22261
22262 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22263 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22264 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22265 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22266 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22267 run.
22268
22269 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22270 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22271 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22272 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22273
22274 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22275 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22276 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22277 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22278 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22279 .code
22280 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22281 .endd
22282 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22283 arguments. You have to write
22284 .code
22285 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22286 .endd
22287 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22288 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22289 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22290 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22291 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22292 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22293 example:
22294 .code
22295 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22296 .endd
22297
22298 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22299 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22300 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22301 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22302 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22303 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22304 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22305 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22306 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22307 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22308
22309 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22310 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22311 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22312 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22313 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22314 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22315 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22316 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22317
22318 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22319 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22320 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22321 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22322 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22323 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22324 control what is done with it.
22325
22326 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22327 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22328 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22329 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22330 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22331 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22332 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22333 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22334 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22335 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22336 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22337
22338
22339
22340 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22341 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22342 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22343 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22344 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22345 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22346 environment.
22347 .display
22348 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22349 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22350 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22351 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22352 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22353 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22354 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22355 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22356 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22357 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22358 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22359 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22360 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22361 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22362 &`USER `& see below
22363 .endd
22364 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22365 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22366 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22367 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22368 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22369 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22370 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22371
22372 .cindex "HOST"
22373 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22374 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22375 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22376 the router.
22377
22378 .cindex "HOME"
22379 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22380 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22381 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22382 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22383
22384
22385 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22386 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22387
22388
22389
22390 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22391 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22392 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22393 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22394 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22395 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22396 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22397 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22398 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22399 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22400 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22401 example, if
22402 .code
22403 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22404 .endd
22405 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22406 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22407 &%use_shell%& is set.
22408
22409
22410 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22411 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22412
22413
22414 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22415 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22416 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22417
22418
22419 .option check_string pipe string unset
22420 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22421 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22422 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22423 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22424 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22425 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22426 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22427 ignored.
22428
22429
22430 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22431 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22432 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22433 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22434 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22435 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22436 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22437
22438
22439 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22440 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22441 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22442 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22443 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22444 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22445 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22446
22447
22448 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22449 See &%check_string%& above.
22450
22451
22452 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22453 .cindex "exec failure"
22454 .cindex "failure of exec"
22455 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22456 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22457 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22458 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22459 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22460
22461
22462 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22463 .cindex "signal exit"
22464 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22465 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22466 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22467 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22468
22469
22470 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22471 .cindex "force command"
22472 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22473 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22474 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22475 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22476 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22477 command. For example:
22478 .code
22479 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22480 force_command
22481 .endd
22482
22483 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22484 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22485 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22486
22487 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22488 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22489 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22490 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22491 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22492 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22493
22494 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22495 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22496
22497 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22498 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22499 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22500 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22501 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22502
22503
22504 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22505 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22506 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22507 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22508 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22509 Only one of them may be set.
22510
22511
22512
22513 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22514 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22515 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22516 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22517
22518
22519
22520 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22521 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22522 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22523 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22524 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22525 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22526 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22527 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22528
22529
22530 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22531 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22532 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22533 .code
22534 message_prefix = \
22535 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22536 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22537 .endd
22538 .cindex "Cyrus"
22539 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22540 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22541 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22542 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22543 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22544 setting
22545 .code
22546 message_prefix =
22547 .endd
22548 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22549 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22550
22551
22552 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22553 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22554 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22555 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22556 .code
22557 message_suffix =
22558 .endd
22559 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22560 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22561
22562
22563 .option path pipe string "see below"
22564 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22565 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22566 .code
22567 /bin:/usr/bin
22568 .endd
22569 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22570 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22571 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22572
22573
22574 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22575 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22576 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22577 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22578 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22579 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22580 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22581 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22582 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22583
22584
22585 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22586 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22587 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22588 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22589 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22590 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22591 accept the message is used.
22592
22593
22594 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22595 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22596 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22597 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22598 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22599 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22600
22601
22602 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22603 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22604 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22605 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22606 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22607 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22608 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22609
22610
22611
22612 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22613 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22614 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22615 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22616 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22617 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22618 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22619 of them may be set.
22620
22621
22622
22623 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22624 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22625 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22626 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22627 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22628 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22629 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22630 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22631 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22632 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22633 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22634 and 73, respectively.
22635
22636
22637 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22638 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22639 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22640 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22641 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22642 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22643 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22644
22645 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22646 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22647 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22648 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22649 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22650 delivery to be deferred.
22651
22652 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22653 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22654
22655
22656 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22657 .cindex "envelope sender"
22658 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22659 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22660 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22661 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22662 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22663
22664 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22665 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22666 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22667 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22668 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22669 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22670 class database.
22671
22672
22673 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22674 .cindex "carriage return"
22675 .cindex "linefeed"
22676 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22677 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22678 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22679 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22680
22681 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22682 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22683 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22684 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22685 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22686
22687
22688 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22689 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22690 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22691 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22692 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22693 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22694 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22695 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22696 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22697 its &%-c%& option.
22698
22699
22700
22701 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22702 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22703 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22704 .cindex "external local delivery"
22705 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22706 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22707 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22708 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22709 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22710 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22711 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22712 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22713 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22714 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22715 .code
22716 # transport
22717 procmail_pipe:
22718 driver = pipe
22719 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22720 return_path_add
22721 delivery_date_add
22722 envelope_to_add
22723 check_string = "From "
22724 escape_string = ">From "
22725 umask = 077
22726 user = $local_part
22727 group = mail
22728
22729 # router
22730 procmail:
22731 driver = accept
22732 check_local_user
22733 transport = procmail_pipe
22734 .endd
22735 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22736 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22737 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22738 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22739 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22740 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22741
22742 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22743 .code
22744 IFS=" "
22745 .endd
22746 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22747 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22748
22749 .cindex "Cyrus"
22750 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22751 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22752 .code
22753 # transport
22754 local_delivery_cyrus:
22755 driver = pipe
22756 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22757 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22758 user = cyrus
22759 group = mail
22760 return_output
22761 log_output
22762 message_prefix =
22763 message_suffix =
22764
22765 # router
22766 local_user_cyrus:
22767 driver = accept
22768 check_local_user
22769 local_part_suffix = .*
22770 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22771 .endd
22772 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22773 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22774 sender.
22775 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22776 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22777
22778
22779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22780 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22781
22782 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22783 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22784 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22785 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22786 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22787 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22788 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22789 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22790
22791
22792 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22793 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22794 two ways:
22795
22796 .ilist
22797 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22798 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22799 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22800 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22801 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22802 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22803 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22804 .next
22805 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22806 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22807 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22808 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22809 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22810 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22811 process.
22812 .endlist
22813
22814
22815 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22816 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22817 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22818
22819
22820
22821 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22822 .vindex "&$host$&"
22823 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22824 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22825 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22826 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22827 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22828 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22829 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22830 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22831
22832
22833 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22834 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22835 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22836 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22837 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22838 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22839 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22840 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22841 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22842 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22843 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22844 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22845 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22846 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22847
22848 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22849 and will be removed in a future release.
22850
22851
22852 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22853 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22854 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22855
22856
22857 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22858 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22859 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22860 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22861 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22862 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22863 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22864 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22865
22866 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22867 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22868 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22869 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22870 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22871 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22872 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22873 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22874 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22875
22876
22877 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22878 .cindex "Cyrus"
22879 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22880 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22881 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22882 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22883 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22884 ignored.
22885
22886 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22887 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22888 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22889 particular connection.
22890
22891 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22892 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22893 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22894 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22895
22896 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22897 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22898 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22899 .code
22900 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22901 .endd
22902 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22903 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22904
22905 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22906 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22907 value.
22908
22909
22910 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22911 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22912 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22913 authenticated as a client.
22914
22915
22916 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22917 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22918 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22919 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22920
22921
22922 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22923 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22924 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22925 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22926 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22927 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22928 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22929
22930
22931 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22932 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22933 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22934 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22935 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22936 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22937 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22938 option.
22939
22940
22941 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22942 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22943 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22944 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22945
22946
22947 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22948 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22949 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22950 cutoff times.
22951
22952 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22953 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22954 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22955 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22956 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22957 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22958
22959 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22960 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22961 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22962 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22963 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22964 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22965 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22966 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22967 to them.
22968
22969
22970 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22971 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22972 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22973 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22974 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22975
22976
22977 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22978 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22979 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22980 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22981 details.
22982
22983
22984 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22985 .cindex "MX record" "security"
22986 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22987 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22988 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
22989 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
22990 the dnssec request bit set.
22991 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
22992
22993
22994
22995 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22996 .cindex "MX record" "security"
22997 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22998 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22999 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23000 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23001 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23002 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23003 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23004
23005
23006
23007 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23008 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23009 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23010 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23011 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23012 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23013 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23014
23015 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23016 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23017 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23018 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23019 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23020
23021
23022 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23023 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23024 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23025 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23026 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23027 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23028 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23029 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23030
23031 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23032 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23033 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23034 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23035 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23036 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23037
23038 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23039 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23040 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23041 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23042 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23043
23044 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23045 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23046 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23047 copy of the message is sent.
23048
23049 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23050 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23051 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23052 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23053 fails"& facility.
23054
23055
23056 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23057 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23058 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23059 zero.
23060
23061 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23062 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23063 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23064 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23065 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23066 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23067
23068 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23069 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23070 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23071 implementations of TLS.
23072
23073 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23074 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23075 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23076 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23077 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23078 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23079 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23080 option is:
23081 .code
23082 $primary_hostname
23083 .endd
23084 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23085 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23086 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23087 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23088 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23089 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23090 interface address, you could use this:
23091 .code
23092 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23093 {$primary_hostname}}
23094 .endd
23095 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23096 callouts.
23097
23098 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23099 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23100 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23101 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23102 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23103 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23104
23105 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23106 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23107 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23108 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23109
23110 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23111 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23112 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23113 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23114 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23115 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23116 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23117
23118 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23119 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23120 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23121 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23122 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23123 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23124 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23125 address are used.
23126
23127 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23128 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23129
23130
23131 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23132 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23133 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23134 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23135 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23136 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23137 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23138 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23139 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23140 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23141
23142
23143 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23144 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23145 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23146 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23147
23148
23149 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23150 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23151 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23152 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23153
23154 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
23155 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23156 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23157 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23158 to any host that matches this list.
23159 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
23160
23161
23162 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23163 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23164 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23165 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23166 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23167 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23168 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23169 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23170
23171
23172 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23173 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23174 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23175 why it exists.
23176
23177
23178
23179 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23180 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23181 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23182 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23183 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23184 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23185 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23186 explanation of when this might be needed.
23187
23188
23189 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23190 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23191 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23192 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23193 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23194
23195
23196 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23197 .cindex "randomized host list"
23198 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23199 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23200 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23201 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23202 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23203 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23204 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23205 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23206
23207 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23208 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23209 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23210 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23211 .code
23212 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23213 .endd
23214 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23215 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23216 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23217
23218 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23219 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23220 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23221 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23222 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23223 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23224 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23225 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23226 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23227
23228
23229 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23230 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23231 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23232 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23233 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23234
23235 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23236 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23237 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23238 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23239 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23240
23241 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23242 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23243 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23244 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23245 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23246 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23247
23248 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23249 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23250 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23251 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23252 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23253 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23254 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23255
23256 .new
23257 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23258 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23259 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23260 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23261 for multi-recipient messages.
23262 The option can usually be left as default.
23263 .wen
23264
23265 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23266 .cindex "bind IP address"
23267 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23268 .vindex "&$host$&"
23269 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23270 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23271 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23272 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23273 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23274 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23275 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23276 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23277 unknown.
23278
23279 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23280 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23281 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23282 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23283 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23284 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23285 .code
23286 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23287 .endd
23288 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23289 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23290 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23291 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23292
23293
23294 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23295 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23296 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23297 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23298 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23299 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23300 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23301 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23302 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23303 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23304 unreachable hosts.
23305
23306
23307 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23308 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23309 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23310 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23311 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23312
23313 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23314 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23315 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23316 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23317 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23318 permits this.
23319
23320
23321 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23322 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23323 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23324 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23325 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23326 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23327 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23328 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23329
23330 .new
23331 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23332 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23333 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23334 .wen
23335
23336 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23337 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23338 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23339 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23340 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23341 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23342 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23343 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23344
23345 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23346 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23347 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23348 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23349 is deferred.
23350
23351
23352
23353 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23354 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23355 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23356 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23357 .vindex "&$port$&"
23358 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23359 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23360 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23361 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23362 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23363
23364 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23365 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23366 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23367 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23368
23369
23370 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23371 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23372 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23373 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23374 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23375 addresses is not affected.
23376
23377 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23378 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23379 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23380 Exim to use only the host name.
23381 .new
23382 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23383 .wen
23384
23385
23386 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23387 .cindex "serializing connections"
23388 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23389 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23390 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23391 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23392 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23393 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23394 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23395
23396 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23397 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23398 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23399 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23400 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23401 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23402
23403 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23404 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23405 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23406 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23407 are used for ETRN serialization.
23408
23409
23410 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23411 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23412 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23413 .cindex "size" "of message"
23414 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23415 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23416 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23417 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23418 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23419 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23420 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23421 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23422
23423 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23424 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23425
23426
23427 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23428 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23429 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23430 .vindex "&$host$&"
23431 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23432 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23433 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23434 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23435 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23436 details of TLS.
23437
23438 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23439 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23440 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23441 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23442 client.
23443
23444
23445 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23446 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23447 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23448 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23449 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23450
23451
23452 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23453 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23454 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23455 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23456 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23457 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23458 will fail.
23459
23460 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23461
23462
23463 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23464 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23465 .vindex "&$host$&"
23466 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23467 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23468 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23469 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23470 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23471 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23472 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23473 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23474
23475
23476 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23477 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23478 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23479 .vindex "&$host$&"
23480 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23481 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23482 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23483 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23484 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23485 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23486 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23487 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23488 ciphers is a preference order.
23489
23490
23491
23492 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23493 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23494 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23495 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23496 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23497 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23498 certificate and private key for the session.
23499
23500 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23501
23502 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23503 TLS extensions.
23504
23505
23506
23507
23508 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23509 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23510 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23511 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23512 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23513 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23514 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23515 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23516 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23517 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23518 in clear.
23519
23520
23521 .new
23522 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23523 .wen
23524 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23525 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23526 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23527 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23528 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23529 Note that unless the host is in this list
23530 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23531 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23532 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23533 certificate verification succeeds.
23534
23535
23536 .new
23537 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23538 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23539 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23540 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23541 while verifying the server certificate,
23542 checks will be included on the host name
23543 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23544 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23545 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23546
23547 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23548 .wen
23549
23550
23551 .new
23552 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23553 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23554 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23555 .vindex "&$host$&"
23556 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23557 The value of this option must be either the
23558 word "system"
23559 or the absolute path to
23560 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23561 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23562
23563 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23564 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23565 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23566 must be specified.
23567
23568 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
23569 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23570 .wen
23571
23572 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23573 explicitly
23574 either by file or directory
23575 are added to those given by the system default location.
23576
23577 The values of &$host$& and
23578 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23579 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23580
23581 For back-compatability,
23582 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23583 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23584 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23585
23586
23587 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23588 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23589 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23590 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23591 certificate verification must succeed.
23592 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23593 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23594 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23595
23596
23597
23598
23599 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23600 "SECTvalhosmax"
23601 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23602 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23603 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23604 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23605 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23606
23607
23608 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23609 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23610 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23611 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23612 retrying.
23613
23614 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23615 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23616 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23617
23618 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23619 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23620 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23621 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23622 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23623
23624 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23625 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23626 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23627 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23628 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23629 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23630 see below for an exception).
23631
23632 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23633 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23634 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23635 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23636 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23637
23638 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23639 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23640 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23641 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23642 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23643 reached their retry times.
23644
23645 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23646 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23647 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23648 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23649 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23650 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23651 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23652 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23653 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23654 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23655 reached.
23656
23657 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23658 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23659 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23660 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23661 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23662 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23663
23664 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23665 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23666 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23667 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23668 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23669 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23670
23671
23672
23673
23674
23675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23677
23678 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23679 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23680 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23681 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23682 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23683 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23684
23685 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23686 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23687 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23688 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23689 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23690 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23691 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23692
23693 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23694 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23695 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23696 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23697
23698
23699 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23700 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23701 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23702 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23703
23704 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23705 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23706 facility; you do not have to use it.
23707
23708 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23709 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23710 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23711 address to which it applies.
23712
23713 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23714 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23715 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23716 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23717 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23718 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23719 rules.
23720
23721 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23722 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23723 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23724 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23725
23726
23727 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23728 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23729 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23730 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23731 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23732 discouraged.
23733
23734 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23735 illustrated by these examples:
23736
23737 .ilist
23738 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23739 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23740 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23741 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23742 .next
23743 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23744 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23745 .endlist
23746
23747
23748
23749 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23750 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23751 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23752 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23753 message's processing.
23754
23755 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23756 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23757 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23758 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23759 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23760 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23761 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23762 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23763 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23764
23765 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23766 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23767 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23768 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23769 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23770 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23771 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23772 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23773 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23774 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23775
23776 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23777 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23778 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23779 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23780 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23781 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23782
23783 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23784 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23785 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23786
23787 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23788 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23789 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23790 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23791 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23792 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23793 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23794 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23795 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23796
23797 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23798 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23799 transport time.
23800
23801
23802
23803
23804 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23805 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23806 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23807 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23808 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23809 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23810 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23811 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23812 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23813 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23814 .code
23815 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23816 .endd
23817 might produce the output
23818 .code
23819 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23820 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23821 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23822 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23823 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23824 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23825 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23826 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23827 .endd
23828 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23829 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23830 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23831 set for a particular transport.
23832
23833
23834 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23835 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23836 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23837 rules in the form
23838 .display
23839 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23840 .endd
23841 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23842 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23843 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23844 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23845
23846 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23847 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23848 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23849 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23850 ignored.
23851
23852 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23853 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23854 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23855
23856 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23857 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23858 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23859 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23860 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23861 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23862 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23863
23864 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23865 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23866 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23867 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23868 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23869 .code
23870 *@* ${lookup ...
23871 .endd
23872 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23873 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23874
23875
23876 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23877 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23878 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23879 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23880 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23881 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23882 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23883 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23884 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23885
23886 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23887 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23888 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23889
23890 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23891 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23892 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23893 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23894 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23895 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23896 of pattern they are set as follows:
23897
23898 .ilist
23899 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23900 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23901 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23902 pattern
23903 .code
23904 *queen@*.fict.example
23905 .endd
23906 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23907 .code
23908 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23909 $1 = hearts-
23910 $2 = wonderland
23911 .endd
23912 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23913 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23914
23915 .next
23916 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23917 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23918 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23919 rewriting rule of the form
23920 .display
23921 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23922 .endd
23923 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23924 .code
23925 $1 = foo
23926 $2 = bar
23927 $3 = baz.example
23928 .endd
23929 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23930 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23931 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23932 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23933 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23934 .endlist
23935
23936
23937 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23938 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23939 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23940 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23941 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23942 .code
23943 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23944 .endd
23945 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23946 &'From:'& headers.
23947
23948 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23949 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23950 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23951 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23952 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23953 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23954 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23955 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23956 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23957 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23958 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23959 entry written to the panic log.
23960
23961
23962
23963 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23964 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23965
23966 .ilist
23967 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23968 c, f, h, r, s, t.
23969 .next
23970 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23971 .next
23972 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23973 .endlist
23974
23975 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23976 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23977
23978
23979
23980 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23981 "SECID154"
23982 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23983 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23984 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23985 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23986 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23987 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23988 .display
23989 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23990 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23991 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23992 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23993 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23994 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23995 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23996 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23997 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23998 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23999 .endd
24000 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24001 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24002 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24003
24004 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24005 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24006
24007
24008 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24009 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24010 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24011 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24012 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24013 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24014 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24015 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24016 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24017
24018 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24019 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24020 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24021 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24022 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24023 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24024 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24025 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24026
24027
24028 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24029 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24030 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24031 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24032
24033 .ilist
24034 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24035 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24036 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24037 .next
24038 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24039 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24040 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24041 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24042 .next
24043 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24044 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24045 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24046 .next
24047 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24048 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24049 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24050 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24051 .code
24052 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24053 .endd
24054 into
24055 .code
24056 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24057 .endd
24058 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24059 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24060 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24061 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24062 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24063 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24064 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24065 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24066 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24067
24068 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24069 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24070 .endlist
24071
24072
24073 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24074 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24075 .code
24076 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24077 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24078 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24079 .endd
24080 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24081 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24082 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24083 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24084 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24085 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24086 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24087 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24088
24089 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24090 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24091 .code
24092 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24093 .endd
24094 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24095 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24096
24097 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24098 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24099 messages that originate outside the local host:
24100 .code
24101 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24102 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24103 .endd
24104 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24105 space.
24106
24107 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24108 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24109 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24110 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24111 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24112 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24113 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24114 components. For example, the rule
24115 .code
24116 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24117 .endd
24118 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24119 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24120 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24121 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24122 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24123 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24124 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24125 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24126
24127
24128
24129
24130
24131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24133
24134 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24135 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24136 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24137 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24138 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24139 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24140 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24141 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24142 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24143 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24144 address, domain and error.
24145
24146 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24147 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24148 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24149 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24150 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24151 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24152 log selector is set, the message
24153 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24154 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24155 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24156 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24157
24158 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24159 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24160 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24161 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24162 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24163 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24164 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24165 domain are maintained independently.
24166
24167 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24168 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24169 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24170 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24171 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24172 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24173 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24174 the local address is reached.
24175
24176 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24177 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24178 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24179 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24180 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24181
24182 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24183 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24184 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24185 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24186 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24187 messages that it should now be retaining.
24188
24189
24190
24191 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24192 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24193 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24194 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24195 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24196 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24197 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24198 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24199 message's sender, respectively.
24200
24201
24202 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24203 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24204 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24205 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24206 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24207 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24208 example,
24209 .code
24210 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24211 .endd
24212 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24213 whereas
24214 .code
24215 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24216 .endd
24217 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24218 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24219 part.
24220
24221 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24222 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24223 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24224 expressions work in address lists.
24225 .display
24226 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24227 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24228 .endd
24229
24230
24231 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24232 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24233 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24234 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24235 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24236 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24237 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24238 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24239 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24240
24241 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24242 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24243 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24244 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24245 local transports).
24246
24247 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24248 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24249 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24250 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24251 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24252 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24253 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24254 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24255 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24256 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24257 commands.
24258
24259
24260
24261 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24262 "SECID160"
24263 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24264 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24265 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24266 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24267 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24268 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24269 .code
24270 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24271 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24272 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24273 .endd
24274 and the retry rules are
24275 .code
24276 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24277 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24278 .endd
24279 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24280 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24281 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24282 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24283 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24284 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24285
24286 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24287 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24288 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24289 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24290
24291 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24292 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24293 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24294 .code
24295 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24296 .endd
24297 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24298 textual form of the IP address.
24299
24300 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24301 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24302 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24303 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24304
24305 .vlist
24306 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24307 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24308 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24309
24310 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24311 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24312 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24313
24314 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24315 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24316
24317 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24318 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24319 .endlist
24320
24321 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24322 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24323 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24324 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24325 retry rule of this form:
24326 .code
24327 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24328 .endd
24329 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24330 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24331
24332 .vlist
24333 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24334 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24335 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24336 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24337
24338 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24339 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24340
24341 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24342 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24343
24344 .vitem &%refused%&
24345 A connection was refused.
24346
24347 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24348 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24349
24350 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24351 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24352
24353 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24354 A connection attempt timed out.
24355
24356 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24357 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24358 obtained from an MX record.
24359
24360 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24361 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24362 obtained from an MX record.
24363
24364 .vitem &%timeout%&
24365 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24366
24367 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24368 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24369 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24370 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24371
24372 .vitem &%quota%&
24373 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24374 transport.
24375
24376 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24377 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24378 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24379 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24380 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24381 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24382 for four days.
24383 .endlist
24384
24385 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24386 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24387 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24388 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24389 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24390 heuristic rules:
24391
24392 .ilist
24393 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24394 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24395 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24396 .next
24397 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24398 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24399 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24400 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24401 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24402 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24403 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24404 .next
24405 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24406 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24407 .endlist
24408
24409 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24410 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24411 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24412 error).
24413
24414
24415
24416 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24417 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24418 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24419 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24420 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24421 form:
24422 .display
24423 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24424 .endd
24425 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24426 .code
24427 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24428 .endd
24429 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24430 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24431 For example:
24432 .code
24433 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24434 .endd
24435 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24436 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24437 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24438 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24439 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24440
24441 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24442 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24443 .code
24444 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24445 .endd
24446 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24447 list is never matched.
24448
24449
24450
24451
24452
24453 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24454 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24455 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24456 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24457 .display
24458 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24459 .endd
24460 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24461 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24462 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24463 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24464 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24465
24466 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24467 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24468 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24469 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24470 The available algorithms are:
24471
24472 .ilist
24473 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24474 the interval.
24475 .next
24476 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24477 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24478 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24479 .next
24480 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24481 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24482 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24483 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24484 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24485 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24486 queue processing times.
24487 .endlist
24488
24489 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24490 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24491 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24492 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24493 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24494 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24495 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24496 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24497 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24498 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24499 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24500 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24501
24502 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24503 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24504 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24505 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24506 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24507 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24508 time.
24509
24510 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24511 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24512 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24513 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24514 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24515 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24516 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24517 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24518 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24519 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24520 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24521 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24522
24523 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24524 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24525 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24526 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24527 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24528 deliveries that have been deferred.
24529
24530
24531 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24532 Here are some example retry rules:
24533 .code
24534 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24535 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24536 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24537 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24538 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24539 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24540 .endd
24541 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24542 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24543 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24544 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24545 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24546 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24547 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24548 days.
24549
24550 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24551 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24552 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24553 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24554 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24555
24556 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24557 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24558 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24559 were not obtained from an MX record.
24560
24561 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24562 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24563 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24564 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24565 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24566
24567
24568
24569 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24570 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24571 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24572 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24573 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24574 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24575 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24576 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24577 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24578 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24579 failing for the first time.
24580
24581 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24582 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24583 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24584 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24585
24586 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24587 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24588 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24589
24590
24591
24592
24593 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24594 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24595 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24596 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24597 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24598 default retry rule:
24599 .code
24600 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24601 .endd
24602 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24603 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24604 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24605
24606 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24607 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24608 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24609 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24610 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24611
24612 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24613 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24614 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24615
24616 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24617 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24618 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24619 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24620 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24621 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24622 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24623 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24624
24625 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24626 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24627 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24628 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24629 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24630 notice.
24631
24632 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24633 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24634 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24635 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24636 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24637 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24638 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24639 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24640 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24641 true.
24642
24643 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24644 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24645 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24646 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24647 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24648 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24649 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24650 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24651 reached.
24652
24653 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24654 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24655 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24656 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24657 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24658 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24659 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24660 time out the address.
24661
24662 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24663 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24664 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24665 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24666 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24667 considered immediately.
24668 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24669 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24670
24671
24672
24673
24674
24675
24676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24678
24679 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24680 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24681 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24682 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24683 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24684 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24685 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24686 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24687 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24688 other.
24689
24690 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24691 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24692
24693 .ilist
24694 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24695 the client's EHLO command.
24696 .next
24697 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24698 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24699 .next
24700 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24701 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24702 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24703 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24704 with the AUTH command.
24705 .next
24706 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24707 .next
24708 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24709 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24710 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24711 connection.
24712 .next
24713 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24714 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24715 unauthenticated connection.
24716 .endlist
24717
24718 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24719 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24720 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24721 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24722 .display
24723 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24724 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24725 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24726 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24727 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24728 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24729 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24730 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24731 &`250-PIPELINING`&
24732 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24733 &`250 HELP`&
24734 .endd
24735 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24736 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24737 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24738 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24739 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24740 included by setting
24741 .code
24742 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24743 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24744 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24745 AUTH_GSASL=yes
24746 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24747 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24748 AUTH_SPA=yes
24749 .endd
24750 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24751 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24752 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24753 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24754 work via a socket interface.
24755 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24756 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24757 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24758 supporting setting a server keytab.
24759 The sixth can be configured to support
24760 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24761 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24762 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24763
24764 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24765 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24766 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24767 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24768 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24769 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24770 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24771
24772 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24773 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24774 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24775 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24776 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24777 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24778 .code
24779 cram:
24780 driver = cram_md5
24781 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24782 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24783 client_name = ph10
24784 client_secret = secret2
24785 .endd
24786 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24787 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24788
24789 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24790 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24791 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24792 in Exim.
24793
24794 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24795 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24796 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24797 authenticating data.
24798
24799 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24800 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24801 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24802 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24803 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24804 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24805 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24806 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24807 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24808 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24809 choose to honour.
24810
24811 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24812 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24813 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24814 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24815
24816
24817
24818 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24819 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24820 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24821
24822 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24823 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24824 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24825 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24826 encrypted by a setting such as:
24827 .code
24828 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24829 .endd
24830
24831
24832 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24833 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24834 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24835 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24836
24837
24838 .option driver authenticators string unset
24839 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24840 authenticators is to be used.
24841
24842
24843 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24844 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24845 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24846 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24847 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24848 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24849
24850
24851 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24852 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24853 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24854 mechanism is not advertised.
24855 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24856 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24857 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24858
24859
24860 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24861 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24862 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24863 for details.
24864
24865 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24866 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24867
24868 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24869 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24870 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24871 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24872 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24873 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24874 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24875 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24876 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24877 the error text.
24878
24879
24880 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24881 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24882 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24883 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24884 out the values of variables.
24885 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24886 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24887
24888
24889 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24890 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24891 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24892 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24893 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24894 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24895 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24896 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24897 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24898
24899
24900 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24901 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24902 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24903 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24904 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24905 remembered for later use.
24906 How it is used is described in the following section.
24907
24908
24909
24910
24911
24912 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24913 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24914 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24915 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24916 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24917 message:
24918
24919 .ilist
24920 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24921 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24922 .next
24923 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24924 .next
24925 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24926 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24927 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24928 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24929 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24930 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24931 given for the MAIL command.
24932 .next
24933 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24934 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24935 authenticated.
24936 .next
24937 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24938 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24939 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24940 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24941 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24942 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24943 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24944 message.
24945 .endlist
24946
24947
24948 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24949 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24950 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24951 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24952
24953 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24954 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24955 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24956 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24957 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24958 ACL is run.
24959
24960
24961
24962 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24963 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24964 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24965 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24966 conditions:
24967
24968 .ilist
24969 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24970 .next
24971 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24972 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24973 .endlist
24974
24975 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24976 the mechanisms are advertised.
24977
24978 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24979 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24980 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24981 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24982 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24983 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24984 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24985 .code
24986 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24987 .endd
24988 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24989
24990 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24991 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24992 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24993 such as:
24994 .code
24995 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24996 .endd
24997 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24998 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24999 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25000
25001 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25002 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25003 command. This is the case if
25004
25005 .ilist
25006 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25007 .next
25008 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25009 .next
25010 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25011 server authenticators.
25012 .endlist
25013
25014
25015 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25016 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25017 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25018
25019 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25020 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25021 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25022 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25023 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25024 rejected with a 504 error.
25025
25026 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25027 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25028 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25029 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25030 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25031 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25032 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25033 no successful authentication.
25034
25035
25036
25037
25038 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25039 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25040 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25041 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25042 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25043 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25044 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25045 script:
25046 .code
25047 use MIME::Base64;
25048 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25049 .endd
25050 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25051 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25052 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25053 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25054 command line to run this script on such data might be
25055 .code
25056 encode '\0user\0password'
25057 .endd
25058 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25059 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25060 whose code value is zero.
25061
25062 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25063 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25064 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25065 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25066
25067 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25068 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25069 example, a command such as
25070 .code
25071 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25072 .endd
25073 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25074
25075 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25076 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25077 .code
25078 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25079 .endd
25080 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25081 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25082 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25083 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25084
25085
25086
25087 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25088 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25089 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25090 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25091 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25092 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25093
25094 .ilist
25095 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25096 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25097 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25098 of the authenticator.
25099 .next
25100 .vindex "&$host$&"
25101 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25102 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25103 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25104 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25105 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25106 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25107 delivery to be deferred.
25108 .next
25109 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25110 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25111 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25112 usual way.
25113 .next
25114 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25115 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25116 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25117 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25118 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25119 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25120 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25121 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25122 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25123 .endlist
25124
25125 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25126 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25127 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25128 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25129 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25130 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25131 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25132 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25133 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25134 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25135 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25136 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25137 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25138
25139
25140
25141
25142
25143
25144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25146
25147 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25148 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25149 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25150 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25151 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25152 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25153 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25154 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25155 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25156 connections as you do for login accounts.
25157
25158 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25159 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25160 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25161
25162 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25163 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25164 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25165
25166 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25167 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25168 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25169 given.
25170
25171 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25172 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25173 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25174 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25175 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25176 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25177 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25178
25179 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25180 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25181 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25182 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25183 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25184 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25185 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25186
25187 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25188 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25189 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25190 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25191
25192 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25193 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25194 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25195
25196 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25197 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25198 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25199 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25200 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25201 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25202 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25203 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25204 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25205 string as the error text
25206
25207 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25208 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25209 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25210
25211
25212
25213 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25214 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25215 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25216 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25217 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25218 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25219 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25220 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25221
25222 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25223 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25224 configured as follows:
25225 .code
25226 fixed_plain:
25227 driver = plaintext
25228 public_name = PLAIN
25229 server_prompts = :
25230 server_condition = \
25231 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25232 server_set_id = $auth2
25233 .endd
25234 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25235 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25236 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25237 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25238
25239 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25240 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25241 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25242 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25243 .code
25244 250-AUTH PLAIN
25245 .endd
25246 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25247 .code
25248 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25249 .endd
25250 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25251 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25252 .code
25253 AUTH PLAIN
25254 .endd
25255 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25256 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25257
25258 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25259 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25260 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25261 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25262 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25263
25264 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25265 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25266 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25267
25268 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25269 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25270 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25271 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25272 This is an incorrect example:
25273 .code
25274 server_condition = \
25275 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25276 .endd
25277 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25278 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25279 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25280 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25281 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25282 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25283 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25284 .code
25285 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25286 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25287 .endd
25288 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25289 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25290 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25291 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25292 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25293
25294
25295 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25296 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25297 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25298 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25299 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25300 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25301 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25302 .code
25303 fixed_login:
25304 driver = plaintext
25305 public_name = LOGIN
25306 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25307 server_condition = \
25308 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25309 server_set_id = $auth1
25310 .endd
25311 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25312 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25313 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25314 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25315
25316 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25317 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25318 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25319 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25320 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25321 .code
25322 login:
25323 driver = plaintext
25324 public_name = LOGIN
25325 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25326 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25327 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25328 ldapauth{\
25329 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25330 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25331 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25332 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25333 .endd
25334 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25335 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25336 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25337 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25338 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25339 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25340 uninterpreted string.
25341
25342
25343 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25344 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25345 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25346 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25347 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25348 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25349
25350
25351
25352
25353 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25354 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25355 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25356
25357 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25358 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25359 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25360 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25361 usual.
25362
25363 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25364 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25365 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25366 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25367 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25368 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25369 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25370 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25371 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25372 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25373 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25374 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25375
25376 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25377 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25378
25379 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25380 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25381 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25382 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25383 the string.
25384
25385 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25386 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25387 .code
25388 fixed_plain:
25389 driver = plaintext
25390 public_name = PLAIN
25391 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25392 .endd
25393 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25394 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25395 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25396 .code
25397 fixed_login:
25398 driver = plaintext
25399 public_name = LOGIN
25400 client_send = : username : mysecret
25401 .endd
25402 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25403 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25404 prompts.
25405 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25406 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25407
25408
25409
25410
25411 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25412 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25413
25414 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25415 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25416 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25417 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25418 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25419 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25420 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25421 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25422 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25423 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25424 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25425 available in plain text at either end.
25426
25427
25428 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25429 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25430 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25431 authenticator as a server:
25432
25433 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25434 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25435 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25436 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25437 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25438 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25439 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25440 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25441 returned to the client.
25442
25443 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25444 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25445 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25446 numeric variables for other things.
25447
25448 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25449 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25450 user name, authentication fails.
25451 .code
25452 fixed_cram:
25453 driver = cram_md5
25454 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25455 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25456 server_set_id = $auth1
25457 .endd
25458 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25459 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25460 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25461 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25462 .code
25463 lookup_cram:
25464 driver = cram_md5
25465 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25466 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25467 {$value}fail}
25468 server_set_id = $auth1
25469 .endd
25470 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25471 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25472
25473 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25474 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25475 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25476 realm, with:
25477 .code
25478 cyrusless_crammd5:
25479 driver = cram_md5
25480 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25481 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25482 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
25483 server_set_id = $auth1
25484 .endd
25485
25486 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25487 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25488 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25489
25490
25491
25492 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25493 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25494 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25495
25496
25497 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25498 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25499 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25500
25501
25502 .vindex "&$host$&"
25503 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25504 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25505 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25506 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25507 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25508 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25509 send the message to the current server.
25510
25511 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25512 strings, is:
25513 .code
25514 fixed_cram:
25515 driver = cram_md5
25516 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25517 client_name = ph10
25518 client_secret = secret
25519 .endd
25520 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25521 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25522
25523
25524
25525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25527
25528 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25529 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25530 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25531 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25532 .cindex "Kerberos"
25533 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25534 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25535
25536 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25537 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25538 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25539 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25540 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25541
25542 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25543 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25544 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25545 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25546
25547 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25548 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25549 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25550 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25551 depending on the driver you are using.
25552
25553 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25554 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25555 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25556 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25557 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25558 implementation.
25559
25560 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25561 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25562 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25563 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25564 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25565 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25566 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25567 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25568
25569
25570 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25571 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25572 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25573 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25574 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25575 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25576 things.
25577
25578
25579 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25580 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25581 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25582 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25583
25584
25585 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25586 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25587 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25588 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25589 example:
25590 .code
25591 sasl:
25592 driver = cyrus_sasl
25593 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25594 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25595 server_set_id = $auth1
25596 .endd
25597
25598 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25599 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25600
25601
25602 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25603 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25604
25605
25606 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25607 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25608 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25609 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25610 .code
25611 sasl_cram_md5:
25612 driver = cyrus_sasl
25613 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25614 server_set_id = $auth1
25615
25616 sasl_plain:
25617 driver = cyrus_sasl
25618 public_name = PLAIN
25619 server_set_id = $auth2
25620 .endd
25621 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25622 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25623 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25624 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25625 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25626
25627
25628
25629
25630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25632 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25633 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25634 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25635 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25636 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25637 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25638 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25639 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25640 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25641
25642 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25643
25644 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25645 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25646 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25647 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25648 .code
25649 dovecot_plain:
25650 driver = dovecot
25651 public_name = PLAIN
25652 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25653 server_set_id = $auth1
25654
25655 dovecot_ntlm:
25656 driver = dovecot
25657 public_name = NTLM
25658 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25659 server_set_id = $auth1
25660 .endd
25661 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25662 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25663 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25664 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25665 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25666 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25667 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25668 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25669
25670
25671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25673 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25674 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25675 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25676 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25677 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25678 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25679 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25680 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25681 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25682 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25683 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25684 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25685 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25686 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25687 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25688 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25689 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25690 without code changes in Exim.
25691
25692
25693 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25694 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25695 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25696 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25697 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25698 context.
25699
25700 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25701 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25702 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25703
25704 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25705 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25706 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25707
25708 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25709 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25710 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25711
25712
25713 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25714 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25715 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25716 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25717
25718
25719 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25720 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25721 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25722 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25723 example:
25724 .code
25725 sasl:
25726 driver = gsasl
25727 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25728 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25729 server_set_id = $auth1
25730 .endd
25731
25732
25733 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25734 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25735 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25736 the password itself.
25737
25738 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25739 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25740 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25741 if available, else the empty string.
25742 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25743 else the empty string.
25744
25745 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25746
25747 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25748 option to be simply "true".
25749
25750
25751 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25752 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25753 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25754
25755
25756 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25757 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25758 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25759 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25760
25761
25762 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25763 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25764 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25765 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25766
25767
25768 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25769 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25770 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25771
25772
25773 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25774 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25775 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25776 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25777
25778 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25779 meanings for these variables:
25780
25781 .ilist
25782 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25783 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25784 .next
25785 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25786 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25787 .next
25788 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25789 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25790 .endlist
25791
25792 On a per-mechanism basis:
25793
25794 .ilist
25795 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25796 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25797 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25798 .next
25799 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25800 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25801 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25802 .next
25803 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25804 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25805 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25806 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25807 .endlist
25808
25809 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25810 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25811 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25812
25813
25814 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25815 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25816 .code
25817 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25818 driver = gsasl
25819 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25820 server_realm = imap.example.org
25821 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25822 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25823 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25824 server_condition = yes
25825 .endd
25826
25827
25828 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25829 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25830
25831 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25832 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25833 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25834 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25835 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25836 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25837 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25838 reliably.
25839
25840 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25841 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25842 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25843 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25844
25845 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25846 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25847 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25848 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25849
25850 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25851 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25852 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25853 from the keytab.
25854
25855
25856 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25857 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25858 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25859 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25860
25861 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25862 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25863 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25864 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25865
25866 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25867 .ilist
25868 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25869 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25870 .next
25871 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25872 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25873 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25874 GSS Display Name.
25875 .endlist
25876
25877
25878 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25880
25881 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25882 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25883 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25884 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25885 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25886 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25887 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25888 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25889 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25890 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25891 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25892 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25893 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25894 follows:
25895
25896 .ilist
25897 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25898 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25899 .next
25900 The server sends back a challenge.
25901 .next
25902 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25903 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25904 .endlist
25905
25906 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25907
25908
25909
25910 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25911 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25912 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25913
25914 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25915 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25916 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25917 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25918 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25919 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25920 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25921 for other things. For example:
25922 .code
25923 spa:
25924 driver = spa
25925 public_name = NTLM
25926 server_password = \
25927 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25928 .endd
25929 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25930 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25931
25932
25933
25934
25935
25936 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25937 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25938 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25939
25940
25941
25942 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25943 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25944
25945
25946 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25947 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25948
25949
25950 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25951 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25952 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25953 &'msn.com'&:
25954 .code
25955 msn:
25956 driver = spa
25957 public_name = MSN
25958 client_username = msn/msn_username
25959 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25960 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25961 .endd
25962 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25963 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25964
25965
25966
25967
25968
25969 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25970 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25971
25972 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25973 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25974 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25975 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25976 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25977 .cindex "OpenSSL"
25978 .cindex "GnuTLS"
25979 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25980 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25981 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25982 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25983 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25984 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25985 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25986 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25987 certificates are used.
25988
25989 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25990 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25991 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25992 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25993 between them is encrypted.
25994
25995 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25996 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25997 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25998 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25999 encryption state.
26000
26001 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26002 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26003 in order to get TLS to work.
26004
26005
26006
26007 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26008 "SECID284"
26009 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26010 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26011 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26012 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26013 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26014 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26015 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26016 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26017 allocated for this purpose.
26018
26019 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26020 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26021 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26022 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26023 .code
26024 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26025 .endd
26026 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26027 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26028 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26029 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26030 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26031 defined elsewhere.
26032
26033 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26034 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26035
26036
26037
26038
26039
26040
26041 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26042 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26043 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26044 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26045 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26046 .code
26047 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26048 .endd
26049 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26050 .code
26051 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26052 .endd
26053 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26054 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26055
26056 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26057
26058 .ilist
26059 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26060 cannot be the path of a directory
26061 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26062 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26063 .next
26064 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26065 .next
26066 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26067 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26068 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26069 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26070 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26071 .next
26072 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26073 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26074 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26075 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26076 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26077 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26078 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26079 option).
26080 .next
26081 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26082 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26083 .next
26084 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26085 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26086 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26087 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26088 .next
26089 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26090 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26091 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26092 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26093 .endlist
26094
26095
26096 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26097 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26098 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26099 but not the chosen filename.
26100 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26101 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26102
26103 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26104 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26105 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26106 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26107 of bits requested.
26108 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26109 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26110 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26111 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26112 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26113 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26114 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26115
26116 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26117 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26118 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26119 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26120 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26121
26122 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26123 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26124 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26125 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26126 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26127 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26128
26129 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26130 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26131 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26132
26133 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26134 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26135 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26136 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26137 .code
26138 # ls
26139 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26140 # rm -f new-params
26141 # touch new-params
26142 # chown exim:exim new-params
26143 # chmod 0600 new-params
26144 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26145 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26146 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26147 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26148 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26149 # chmod 0400 new-params
26150 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26151 .endd
26152 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26153 stalling is removed.
26154
26155 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26156 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26157 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26158 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26159 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26160 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26161 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26162 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26163 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26164 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26165 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26166
26167 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26168 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26169 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26170 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26171
26172 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26173 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26174 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26175 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26176 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26177
26178
26179 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26180 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26181 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26182 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26183 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26184 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26185 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26186 directly to this function call.
26187 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26188 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26189 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26190 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26191
26192 .ilist
26193 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26194 .next
26195 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26196 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26197 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26198 SSL v3 algorithms.
26199 .next
26200 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26201 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26202 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26203 algorithms.
26204 .endlist
26205
26206 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26207 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26208 .ilist
26209 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26210 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26211 stated.
26212 .next
26213 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26214 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26215 .next
26216 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26217 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26218 .endlist
26219
26220 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26221 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26222 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26223 not be moved to the end of the list.
26224 .endlist
26225
26226 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26227 string:
26228 .code
26229 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26230 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26231 .endd
26232
26233 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26234 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26235 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26236 choice of clients used:
26237 .code
26238 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26239 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26240 {DEFAULT}\
26241 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26242 .endd
26243
26244
26245
26246 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26247 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26248 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26249 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26250 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26251 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26252 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26253 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26254 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26255 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26256 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26257 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26258
26259 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26260 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26261
26262 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26263 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26264 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26265 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26266 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26267 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26268
26269 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26270 "Priority strings". This is online as
26271 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26272 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26273 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26274 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26275 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26276
26277 For example:
26278 .code
26279 # Disable older versions of protocols
26280 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26281 .endd
26282
26283 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26284 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26285 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26286
26287 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26288 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26289 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26290 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26291 used:
26292 .code
26293 # GnuTLS variant
26294 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26295 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26296 {SECURE128}}
26297 .endd
26298
26299
26300 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26301 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26302 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26303 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26304 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26305 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26306 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26307 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26308
26309 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26310 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26311 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26312 with the error
26313 .code
26314 554 Security failure
26315 .endd
26316 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26317 rejected with a 554 error code.
26318
26319 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26320 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26321 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26322 without some further configuration at the server end.
26323
26324 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26325 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26326 .code
26327 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26328 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26329 .endd
26330 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26331 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26332 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26333 that goes with it. These files need to be
26334 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26335 always be given as full path names.
26336 The key must not be password-protected.
26337 They can be the same file if both the
26338 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26339 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26340 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26341 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26342 the server's certificate.
26343
26344 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26345 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26346 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26347
26348 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26349 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26350 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26351 transport.
26352
26353 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26354 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26355 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26356 .code
26357 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26358 .endd
26359 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26360 with the parameters contained in the file.
26361 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26362 available:
26363 .code
26364 tls_dhparam = none
26365 .endd
26366 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26367 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26368 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26369 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26370
26371 See the command
26372 .code
26373 openssl dhparam
26374 .endd
26375 for a way of generating file data.
26376
26377 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26378 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26379 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26380 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26381 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26382
26383 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26384 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26385 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26386 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26387 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26388 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26389 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26390 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26391 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26392
26393 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26394 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26395 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26396 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26397 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26398 documentation for more details.
26399
26400 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26401 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26402
26403
26404 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26405 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26406 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26407 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26408 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26409 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26410 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26411 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26412 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26413 expected certificates.
26414 .new
26415 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26416 .wen
26417 an explicit file or,
26418 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26419 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26420
26421 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26422 directory is used
26423 (OpenSSL only),
26424 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26425 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26426 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26427 .code
26428 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26429 .endd
26430 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26431
26432 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26433 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26434 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26435 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26436 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26437 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26438 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26439 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26440 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26441 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26442
26443 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26444 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26445 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26446 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26447
26448 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26449 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26450 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26451 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26452 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26453 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26454
26455
26456 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26457 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26458 .cindex "revocation list"
26459 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26460 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26461 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26462 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26463 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26464 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26465 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26466 CRL in PEM format.
26467 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26468 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26469
26470 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26471 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26472 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26473 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26474 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26475 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26476
26477 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26478 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26479 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26480 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26481
26482 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26483 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26484 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26485 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26486 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26487 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26488 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26489 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26490
26491 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26492 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26493 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26494
26495 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26496 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26497 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26498 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26499 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26500
26501 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26502 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26503 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26504 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26505 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26506 next connection.
26507
26508 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26509 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26510 ignored.
26511
26512 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26513 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26514 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26515 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26516 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26517 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26518
26519 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26520 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26521
26522 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26523
26524 .code
26525 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26526 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26527 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26528
26529 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26530 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26531 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26532 .endd
26533
26534
26535
26536
26537 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26538 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26539 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26540 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26541 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26542 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26543 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26544 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26545 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26546
26547 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26548 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26549 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26550 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26551 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26552
26553 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26554 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26555 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26556 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26557 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26558 usual way.
26559
26560 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26561 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26562 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26563 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26564 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26565 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26566 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26567 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26568 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26569 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26570 unencrypted.
26571
26572 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26573 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26574 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26575 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26576
26577 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26578 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26579 .new
26580 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26581 .wen
26582 a file or,
26583 depnding on liibrary version, a directory,
26584 must name a file or,
26585 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26586 The client verifies the server's certificate
26587 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26588 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26589 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26590 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26591
26592 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26593 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26594 or need not succeed respectively.
26595
26596 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26597 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26598 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26599 value is empty.
26600 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26601 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26602 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26603 otherwise.
26604
26605 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26606 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26607 for OCSP to be relevant.
26608
26609 If
26610 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26611 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26612 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26613 alternative hosts, if any.
26614
26615 &*Note*&:
26616 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26617 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26618 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26619 client.
26620
26621 .vindex "&$host$&"
26622 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26623 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26624 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26625 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26626 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26627
26628 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26629 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26630 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26631 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26632 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26633 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26634 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26635 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26636 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26637 outgoing connection.
26638
26639
26640
26641 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26642 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26643 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26644 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26645 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26646 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26647 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26648 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26649 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26650 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26651 for this session.
26652
26653 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26654 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26655 address.
26656
26657 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26658 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26659 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26660 be of limited use in that environment.
26661
26662 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26663 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26664 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26665 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26666 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26667
26668 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26669 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26670 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26671 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26672 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26673
26674 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26675 received from a client.
26676 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26677
26678 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26679 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26680 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26681
26682 .ilist
26683 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26684 &%tls_certificate%&
26685 .next
26686 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26687 &%tls_crl%&
26688 .next
26689 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26690 &%tls_privatekey%&
26691 .next
26692 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26693 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26694 .next
26695 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
26696 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
26697 .endlist
26698
26699 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26700 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26701 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26702 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26703
26704 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26705 are re-expanded.
26706
26707 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26708 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26709 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26710 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26711
26712 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26713 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26714 built, then you have SNI support).
26715
26716
26717
26718 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26719 "SECTmulmessam"
26720 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26721 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26722 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26723 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26724 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26725 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26726 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26727 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26728 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26729 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26730 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26731
26732 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26733 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26734 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26735 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26736 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26737 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26738 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26739 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26740 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26741
26742 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26743 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26744 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26745 information is recorded.
26746
26747 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26748 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26749 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26750
26751
26752
26753
26754 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26755 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26756 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26757 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26758 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26759 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26760 to Apache, currently at
26761 .display
26762 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26763 .endd
26764 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26765 links to further files.
26766 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
26767 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26768 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26769 .display
26770 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26771 .endd
26772
26773
26774 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26775 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26776 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26777 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26778 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26779 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26780 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26781 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26782 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26783 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26784 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26785 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26786 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26787
26788 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
26789 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
26790 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
26791 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
26792
26793
26794
26795 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26796 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26797 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26798 with OpenSSL, like this:
26799 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26800 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26801 .code
26802 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26803 -days 9999 -nodes
26804 .endd
26805 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26806 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26807 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26808 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26809 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26810 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26811 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26812
26813 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26814 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26815 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26816 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26817 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26818 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26819 . ==== -pdp, 2012
26820 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26821 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26822 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26823 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26824 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26825 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26826 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26827 be a sensible resolution).
26828
26829 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26830 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26831 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26832
26833 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26834 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26835 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26836 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26837 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26838 signed with that self-signed certificate.
26839
26840 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26841 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26842 Open-source PKI book, available online at
26843 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26844 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26845 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26846
26847
26848
26849 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26850 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26851
26852 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26853 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26854 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
26855 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26856 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26857 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26858 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26859 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26860 one very small ACL:
26861 .code
26862 begin acl
26863 small_acl:
26864 accept hosts = one.host.only
26865 .endd
26866 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26867 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26868
26869 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26870 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26871 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26872 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26873 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26874 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26875 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26876 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26877
26878
26879 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26880 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26881 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26882 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26883 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26884
26885
26886
26887 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26888 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26889 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26890 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26891 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26892 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26893 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26894 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26895 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26896 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26897 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26898 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26899 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26900 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26901 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26902 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26903 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26904 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26905 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
26906
26907 .table2 140pt
26908 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26909 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26910 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26911 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26912 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26913 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26914 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
26915 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26916 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26917 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26918 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26919 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26920 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26921 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26922 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26923 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26924 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26925 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26926 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26927 .endtable
26928
26929 For example, if you set
26930 .code
26931 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26932 .endd
26933 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26934 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26935 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26936 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26937 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26938 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26939 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26940
26941
26942 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26943 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26944 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26945 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26946 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26947 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26948 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26949 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26950 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26951 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26952 in any of these ACLs.
26953
26954 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26955 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26956 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26957 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26958 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26959 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26960 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26961 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26962 .code
26963 control = suppress_local_fixups
26964 .endd
26965 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26966 run, it is too late.
26967
26968 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26969 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26970
26971 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26972 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26973 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26974
26975
26976 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26977 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26978 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26979 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26980 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26981 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26982 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26983 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26984 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26985
26986
26987 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26988 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26989 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26990 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26991 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26992 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26993 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26994 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26995 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26996
26997 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26998 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26999 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27000 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27001 an EHLO response.
27002
27003
27004 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27005 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27006 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27007 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27008 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27009 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27010 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27011 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27012 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27013 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27014
27015 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27016 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27017 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27018 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27019 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27020 associated with the DATA command.
27021
27022 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27023 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27024 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27025 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27026 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27027 your resources.
27028
27029 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27030 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27031 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27032 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27033
27034 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27035 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27036 enabled (which is the default).
27037
27038 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27039 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27040 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27041
27042 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27043
27044 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27045
27046
27047 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27048 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27049 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27050
27051 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27052
27053
27054 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27055 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27056 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27057 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27058 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27059 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27060 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27061 has been accepted.
27062
27063 The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27064 has been recieved, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27065 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27066 The test may accept, defer or deny for inividual recipients.
27067 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27068 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27069 for some or all recipients.
27070
27071 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27072 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27073 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27074 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
27075 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27076 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27077 will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
27078
27079 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27080 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27081
27082 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27083 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27084 the feature was not requested by the client.
27085
27086 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27087 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27088 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27089 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27090 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
27091 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
27092
27093 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27094 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27095 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27096 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27097
27098 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27099 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27100
27101 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27102 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27103 response to QUIT.
27104
27105 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27106 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27107 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27108 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27109 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27110
27111
27112 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27113 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27114 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27115 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27116 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27117 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27118 situation even worse.
27119
27120 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27121 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27122 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27123 and &%warn%&.
27124
27125 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27126 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27127 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27128 connection. The possible values are:
27129 .table2
27130 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27131 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27132 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27133 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27134 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27135 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27136 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27137 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27138 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27139 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27140 .endtable
27141 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27142 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27143 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27144 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27145 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27146 used.
27147
27148
27149 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27150 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27151 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27152 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27153 .code
27154 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27155 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27156 .endd
27157 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27158 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27159 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27160 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27161 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27162
27163 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27164 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27165 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27166
27167 .ilist
27168 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27169 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27170 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27171 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27172 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27173 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27174 .code
27175 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27176 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27177 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27178 .endd
27179 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27180 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27181 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27182 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27183 .next
27184 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27185 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27186 matches the string.
27187 .next
27188 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27189 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27190 want to have something like
27191 .code
27192 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27193 .endd
27194 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27195 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27196 .endlist
27197
27198
27199
27200
27201 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27202 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27203 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27204 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27205 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27206 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27207 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27208 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27209 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27210
27211 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27212 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27213 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27214
27215
27216 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27217 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27218 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27219 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27220
27221 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27222 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27223 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27224 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27225 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27226 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27227 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27228
27229
27230 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27231 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27232 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27233
27234
27235
27236 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27237 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27238 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27239 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27240 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27241 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27242
27243 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27244 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27245 used to accept or reject anything.
27246
27247 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27248 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27249 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27250 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27251
27252 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27253 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27254 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27255 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27256 configuration file.
27257
27258
27259
27260
27261 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27262 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27263 .vindex &$domain$&
27264 .vindex &$local_part$&
27265 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27266 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27267 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27268 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27269 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27270 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27271 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27272 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27273 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27274
27275 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27276 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27277 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27278 how it is used.
27279
27280 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27281 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27282 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27283 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27284 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27285 received).
27286
27287 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27288 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27289 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27290 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27291 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27292 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27293 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27294 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27295
27296
27297
27298
27299
27300 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27301 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27302 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27303 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27304 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27305 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27306 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27307 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27308 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27309 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27310 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27311 unencrypted connections.
27312 .code
27313 acl_check_auth:
27314 accept encrypted = *
27315 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27316 {CRAM-MD5}}
27317 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27318 .endd
27319 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27320 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27321 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27322 option to do this.)
27323
27324
27325
27326 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27327 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27328 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27329 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27330 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27331 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27332 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27333
27334 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27335 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27336 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27337 example:
27338 .code
27339 deny dnslists = list1.example
27340 dnslists = list2.example
27341 .endd
27342 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27343 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27344 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27345 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27346 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27347
27348
27349 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27350 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27351
27352 .ilist
27353 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27354 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27355 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27356 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27357 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27358 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27359 check a RCPT command:
27360 .code
27361 accept domains = +local_domains
27362 endpass
27363 verify = recipient
27364 .endd
27365 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27366 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27367 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27368 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27369 &%endpass%&.
27370
27371 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27372 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27373 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27374 configuration.
27375
27376 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27377 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27378 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27379 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27380 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27381 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27382 .display
27383 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27384 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27385 .endd
27386 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27387 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27388 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27389
27390 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27391 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27392 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27393 of &%endpass%&.
27394
27395
27396 .next
27397 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27398 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27399 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27400 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27401 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27402 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27403 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27404
27405
27406 .next
27407 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27408 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27409 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27410 example,
27411 .code
27412 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27413 .endd
27414 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27415
27416
27417 .next
27418 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27419 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27420 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27421 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27422 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27423 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27424 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27425 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27426 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27427
27428 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27429 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27430 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27431
27432
27433 .next
27434 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27435 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27436 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27437 .code
27438 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27439 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27440 .endd
27441 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27442 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27443
27444 .next
27445 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27446 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27447 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27448 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27449 .code
27450 require message = Sender did not verify
27451 verify = sender
27452 .endd
27453 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27454 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27455 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27456 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27457
27458 .next
27459 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27460 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27461 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27462 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27463 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27464 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27465 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27466
27467 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27468 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27469 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27470 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27471 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27472
27473 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27474 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27475 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27476 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27477 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27478 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27479 onwards.
27480
27481
27482 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27483 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27484 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27485 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27486 .code
27487 warn !verify = sender
27488 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27489 .endd
27490 .endlist
27491
27492 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27493
27494 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27495 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27496 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27497 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27498 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27499
27500
27501
27502 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27503 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27504 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27505 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27506 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27507 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27508 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27509 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27510 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27511 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27512 .ilist
27513 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27514 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27515 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27516 on the same SMTP connection.
27517 .next
27518 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27519 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27520 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27521 .endlist
27522
27523 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27524 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27525 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27526 .code
27527 accept hosts = whatever
27528 set acl_m4 = some value
27529 accept authenticated = *
27530 set acl_c_auth = yes
27531 .endd
27532 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27533 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27534 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27535
27536 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27537 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27538 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27539 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27540 error is generated.
27541
27542 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27543 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27544
27545
27546 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27547 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27548 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27549 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27550 .code
27551 deny domains = *.dom.example
27552 !verify = recipient
27553 .endd
27554 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27555 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27556 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27557 two statements are equivalent:
27558 .code
27559 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27560 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27561 .endd
27562 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27563 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27564
27565 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27566 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27567 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27568 .code
27569 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27570 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27571 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27572 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27573 .endd
27574 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27575 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27576 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27577 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27578 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27579 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27580 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27581
27582 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27583 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27584 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27585 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27586 message is handled.
27587
27588 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27589 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27590 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27591 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27592 .code
27593 require message = Can't verify sender
27594 verify = sender
27595 message = Can't verify recipient
27596 verify = recipient
27597 message = This message cannot be used
27598 .endd
27599 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27600 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27601 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27602 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27603 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27604 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27605
27606 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27607 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27608 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27609 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27610 .code
27611 deny hosts = ...
27612 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27613 message = Invalid sender from client host
27614 .endd
27615 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27616 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27617
27618
27619
27620 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27621 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27622 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27623
27624 .vlist
27625 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27626 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27627 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27628 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27629
27630 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27631 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27632 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27633 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27634 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27635 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27636 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27637 write rather ugly lines like this:
27638 .display
27639 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27640 .endd
27641 Instead, all you need is
27642 .display
27643 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27644 .endd
27645
27646 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27647 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27648 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27649 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27650 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27651 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27652 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27653 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27654
27655 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27656 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27657 in several different ways. For example:
27658
27659 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27660 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27661 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27662 . ==== way.
27663
27664 .ilist
27665 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27666 .code
27667 accept ...some conditions
27668 control = queue_only
27669 .endd
27670 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27671 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27672
27673 .next
27674 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27675 .code
27676 accept ...some conditions...
27677 control = queue_only
27678 ...some more conditions...
27679 .endd
27680 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27681 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27682 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27683 to be relevant.
27684
27685 .next
27686 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27687 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27688 example:
27689 .code
27690 warn ...some conditions...
27691 control = freeze
27692 accept ...
27693 .endd
27694 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27695 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27696 log entry.
27697
27698 .next
27699 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27700 &%require%& verb. For example:
27701 .code
27702 require control = no_multiline_responses
27703 .endd
27704 .endlist
27705
27706 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27707 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27708 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
27709 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27710 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27711 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27712 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27713 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27714 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27715
27716 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27717 example:
27718 .code
27719 deny ...some conditions...
27720 delay = 30s
27721 .endd
27722 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27723 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27724 .code
27725 deny delay = 30s
27726 ...some conditions...
27727 .endd
27728 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27729 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27730 .code
27731 warn ...some conditions...
27732 delay = 2m
27733 control = freeze
27734 accept ...
27735 .endd
27736
27737 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27738 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27739 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27740 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27741 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27742 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27743 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27744
27745
27746 .vitem &*endpass*&
27747 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27748 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27749 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27750 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27751 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27752 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27753 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27754
27755
27756 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27757 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27758 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27759 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27760 .code
27761 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27762 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27763 .endd
27764 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27765 example:
27766 .display
27767 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27768 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27769 .endd
27770 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27771 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27772 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27773 message.
27774
27775 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27776 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27777 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27778 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27779 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27780 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27781 ignored.
27782
27783 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27784 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27785 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27786 error message.
27787
27788 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27789 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27790 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27791 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27792 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27793 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27794
27795 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27796 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27797 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27798 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27799 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27800 logging rejections.
27801
27802
27803 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27804 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27805 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27806 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27807 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27808 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27809 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27810 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27811 .display
27812 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27813 &` log_reject_target =`&
27814 .endd
27815 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27816 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27817 current ACL.
27818
27819
27820 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27821 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27822 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27823 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27824 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27825 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27826 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27827 ACLs. For example:
27828 .display
27829 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27830 &` control = freeze`&
27831 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27832 .endd
27833 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27834 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27835 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27836 example:
27837 .code
27838 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27839 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27840 .endd
27841
27842
27843 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27844 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27845 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27846 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27847 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27848 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27849 &%accept%& for details.)
27850
27851 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27852 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27853 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27854 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27855 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27856 .code
27857 require message = Host not recognized
27858 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
27859 .endd
27860 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27861 processed.)
27862
27863 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27864 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27865 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27866 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27867 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27868 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27869 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27870 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27871 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27872 EHLO options.
27873
27874 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27875 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27876 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27877 .code
27878 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27879 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27880 .endd
27881 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27882 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27883 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
27884 2&'xx'&.
27885
27886 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27887 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27888
27889 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27890 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27891 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27892 response.
27893
27894 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27895 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
27896 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
27897
27898 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27899 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27900 However, the original message is available in the variable
27901 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27902 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27903 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27904 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27905
27906 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27907 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27908 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27909 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27910 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27911 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27912 effect.
27913
27914
27915 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27916 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27917 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27918 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27919
27920
27921 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27922 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27923 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27924 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27925
27926
27927 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27928 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27929 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27930 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27931 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27932 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27933 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27934 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27935 when:
27936 .code
27937 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27938 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27939 .endd
27940 .endlist
27941
27942
27943
27944
27945 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27946 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27947 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27948
27949 .vlist
27950 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27951 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27952 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27953 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27954 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27955 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27956 not work without it. For example:
27957 .code
27958 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27959 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27960 .endd
27961 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27962 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27963 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27964 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27965 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27966
27967
27968 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27969 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27970 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27971 .cindex "case of local parts"
27972 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27973 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27974 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27975 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27976 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27977 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27978 is encountered.
27979
27980 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27981 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27982 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27983 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27984 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27985
27986 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27987 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27988 spam score:
27989 .code
27990 warn control = caseful_local_part
27991 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27992 $acl_m4 + \
27993 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27994 }
27995 control = caselower_local_part
27996 .endd
27997 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27998 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27999
28000
28001 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28002 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28003 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28004 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28005
28006 The option usable in the RCPT ACL.
28007 If enabled for a message recieved via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28008 and the message has only one recipient,
28009 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28010 and data is copied from one to the other.
28011
28012 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28013 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data,
28014 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28015
28016 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28017 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28018 Note also that headers cannot be
28019 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28020 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28021
28022 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28023 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28024 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28025
28026 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28027 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28028 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28029 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28030 the log line is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears
28031 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28032
28033 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28034 (possibly faked)
28035 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28036
28037
28038 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28039 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28040 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28041 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28042 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28043 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28044 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28045 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28046 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28047 contexts):
28048 .code
28049 control = debug
28050 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28051 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28052 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28053 .endd
28054
28055
28056 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28057 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28058 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28059 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28060 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28061
28062
28063 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28064 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28065 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28066 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28067 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28068 strings or to numeric value.
28069 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28070 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28071 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28072
28073 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28074 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28075 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28076 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28077 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28078
28079
28080 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28081 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28082 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28083 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28084 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28085 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28086 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28087 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28088
28089 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28090 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28091 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28092 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28093 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28094 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28095 work with.
28096
28097
28098 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28099 .cindex "fake defer"
28100 .cindex "defer, fake"
28101 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28102 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28103 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28104 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28105 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28106
28107 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28108 .cindex "fake rejection"
28109 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28110 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28111 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28112 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28113 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28114 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28115 the same SMTP connection.
28116
28117 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28118 message is supplied, the following is used:
28119 .code
28120 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28121 550-kept for evaluation.
28122 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28123 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28124 .endd
28125 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28126
28127 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28128 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28129 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28130 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28131 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28132 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28133 SMTP connection.
28134
28135 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28136 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28137 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28138 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28139
28140 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28141 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28142 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28143 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28144 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28145 disables such output flushing.
28146
28147 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28148 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28149 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28150 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28151 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28152 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28153
28154 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28155 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28156 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28157 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28158 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28159 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28160 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28161 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28162 to be useful in production.
28163
28164 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28165 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28166 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28167 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28168 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28169
28170 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28171 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28172 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28173 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28174 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28175 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28176
28177 .ilist
28178 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28179 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28180 verification failed"&) is sent.
28181 .next
28182 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28183 line is output.
28184 .endlist
28185
28186 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28187 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28188
28189 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28190 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28191 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28192 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28193 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28194 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28195 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28196
28197 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28198 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28199 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28200 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28201 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28202 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28203 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28204 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28205 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28206 same SMTP connection.
28207
28208 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28209 .cindex "message" "submission"
28210 .cindex "submission mode"
28211 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28212 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28213 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28214 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28215 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28216 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28217 late (the message has already been created).
28218
28219 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28220 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28221 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28222 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28223 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28224
28225 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28226 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28227 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28228 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28229 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28230
28231 .ilist
28232 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28233 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28234 .next
28235 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28236 .next
28237 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28238 .endlist ilist
28239
28240 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28241 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28242 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28243 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28244 data is read.
28245
28246 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28247 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28248 .endlist vlist
28249
28250
28251 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28252 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28253
28254 .ilist
28255 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28256 .next
28257 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28258 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28259 .next
28260 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28261 .next
28262 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28263 .endlist
28264
28265
28266
28267 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28268 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28269 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28270 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28271 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28272 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28273 .code
28274 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28275 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28276 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28277 .endd
28278 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28279 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28280 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28281 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28282 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28283 RCPT ACL).
28284
28285 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28286 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28287
28288 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28289 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28290 contains one or more newlines that
28291 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28292 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28293 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28294
28295 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28296 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28297 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28298 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28299 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28300 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28301 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28302 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28303 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28304 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28305 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28306
28307 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28308 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28309 of message headers
28310 until they are added to the
28311 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28312 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28313 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28314 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28315 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28316 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28317 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28318
28319 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28320
28321 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28322 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28323 .display
28324 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28325 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28326
28327 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28328 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28329 .endd
28330 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28331 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28332 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28333 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28334 honoured.
28335
28336 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28337 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28338 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28339 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28340 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28341 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28342 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28343 specifications.
28344
28345 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28346 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28347 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28348 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28349 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28350
28351 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28352 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28353 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28354 to be a header name first.) For example:
28355 .code
28356 warn add_header = \
28357 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28358 .endd
28359 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28360 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28361 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28362 up in reverse order.
28363
28364 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28365 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28366 system filter or in a router or transport.
28367
28368
28369
28370 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28371 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28372 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28373 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28374 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28375 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28376 .code
28377 warn message = Remove internal headers
28378 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28379 .endd
28380 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28381 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28382 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28383 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28384 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28385 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28386
28387 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28388 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28389
28390 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28391 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28392 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28393 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28394 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28395 .code
28396 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28397 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28398 warn message = Remove internal headers
28399 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28400 .endd
28401 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28402 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28403 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28404 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28405 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28406 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28407 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28408 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28409 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28410 would have been removed.
28411
28412 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28413 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28414 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28415 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28416 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28417 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28418 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28419 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28420 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28421
28422 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28423 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28424 .display
28425 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28426 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28427
28428 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28429 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28430 .endd
28431 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28432 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28433 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28434 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28435 are honoured.
28436
28437 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28438 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28439 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28440
28441
28442
28443
28444 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28445 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28446 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28447 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28448 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28449 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28450
28451 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28452 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28453 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28454 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28455 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28456 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28457 The conditions are as follows:
28458
28459
28460 .vlist
28461 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28462 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28463 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28464 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28465 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28466 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28467 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28468 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28469 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28470 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28471 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28472 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28473
28474 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28475 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28476 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28477 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28478 The name and values are expanded separately.
28479 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28480 will act as argument separators.
28481
28482 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28483 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28484 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28485 conditions are tested.
28486
28487 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28488 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28489 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28490 for different local users or different local domains.
28491
28492 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28493 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28494 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28495 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28496 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28497 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28498 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28499 .code
28500 authenticated = *
28501 .endd
28502
28503 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28504 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28505 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28506 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28507 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28508 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28509 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28510 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28511 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28512 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28513 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28514 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28515 negative.
28516
28517 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28518 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28519 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28520 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28521 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28522 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28523 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28524 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28525
28526 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28527 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28528 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28529 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28530 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28531
28532 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28533 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28534 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28535 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28536 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28537 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28538 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28539 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28540 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28541 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28542
28543 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28544 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28545 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28546 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28547 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28548 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28549 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28550 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28551 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28552 &%domains%& test.
28553
28554 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28555 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28556
28557
28558 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28559 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28560 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28561 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28562 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28563 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28564 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28565 .code
28566 encrypted = *
28567 .endd
28568
28569
28570 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28571 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28572 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28573 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28574 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28575 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28576 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28577 .code
28578 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28579 .endd
28580 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28581 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28582 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28583
28584 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28585 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28586 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28587 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28588 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28589 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28590
28591 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28592 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28593 .code
28594 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28595 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28596 .endd
28597 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28598 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28599 statement can then check the IP address.
28600
28601 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28602 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28603 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28604 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28605 .code
28606 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28607 message = $host_data
28608 .endd
28609 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28610
28611 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28612 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28613 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28614 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28615 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28616 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28617 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28618 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28619 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28620 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28621
28622 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28623 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28624 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28625 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28626 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28627 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28628 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28629
28630 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28631 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28632 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28633 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28634 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28635 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28636 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28637 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28638
28639 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28640 .cindex "rate limiting"
28641 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28642 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28643
28644 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28645 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28646 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28647 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28648 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28649 recipient address against a list of recipients.
28650
28651 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28652 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28653 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28654 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28655 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28656 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28657 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28658
28659 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28660 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
28661 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28662 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
28663 .vindex "&$domain$&"
28664 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
28665 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
28666 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
28667 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
28668 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
28669 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
28670 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
28671 influence the sender checking.
28672
28673 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28674 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28675
28676 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28677 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28678 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28679 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28680 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28681 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28682 .code
28683 senders = :
28684 .endd
28685 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28686 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28687
28688 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28689 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28690 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28691 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28692 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28693 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28694
28695 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28696 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28697 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28698 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28699 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28700 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28701 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28702 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28703 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28704 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28705
28706 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28707 .cindex "CSA verification"
28708 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28709 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28710 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28711
28712 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28713 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28714 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28715 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28716 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28717 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28718 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28719 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28720 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28721 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28722
28723 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28724 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28725 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28726
28727 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28728 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28729 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28730 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28731 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28732 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28733 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28734 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28735 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28736 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28737 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28738 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28739 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28740 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28741 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28742
28743 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28744 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
28745 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
28746 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
28747 .code
28748 deny senders = :
28749 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
28750 !verify = header_sender
28751 .endd
28752
28753 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
28754 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28755 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
28756 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
28757 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
28758 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28759 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28760 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
28761 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
28762 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
28763 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
28764 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
28765 appropriate.
28766
28767 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
28768 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28769 .code
28770 To: @
28771 .endd
28772 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28773 common as they used to be.
28774
28775 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28776 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28777 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28778 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28779 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28780 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28781 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28782 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28783 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28784 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28785 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28786 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28787 independently of this condition.
28788
28789 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28790 option), this condition is always true.
28791
28792
28793 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28794 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28795 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28796 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28797 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28798 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28799 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28800 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28801 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28802
28803 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28804 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28805
28806
28807 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28808 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28809 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28810 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28811 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28812 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28813 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28814 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28815 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28816 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28817 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28818 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28819 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28820 value for the child address.
28821
28822 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28823 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28824 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28825 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28826 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28827 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28828 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28829 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28830 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28831 original IP address.
28832
28833 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28834 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28835
28836 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28837 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28838 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28839 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
28840 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
28841 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28842 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28843 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28844 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28845
28846 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28847 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28848 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28849 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28850 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28851 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28852 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28853
28854 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28855 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28856 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28857
28858 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28859 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28860 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28861 verified as a sender.
28862 .endlist
28863
28864
28865
28866 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28867 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28868 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28869 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28870 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28871 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28872 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28873 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28874 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28875 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28876 .code
28877 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28878 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28879 .endd
28880 the following records are looked up:
28881 .code
28882 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28883 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28884 .endd
28885 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28886 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28887 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28888 use two separate conditions:
28889 .code
28890 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28891 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28892 .endd
28893 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28894 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28895 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28896 processed.
28897
28898 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28899 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28900 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28901 following special items in the list:
28902 .display
28903 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28904 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28905 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28906 .endd
28907 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28908 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28909 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28910 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28911 .code
28912 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28913 .endd
28914 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28915 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28916 .code
28917 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28918 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28919 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28920 .endd
28921 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28922 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28923 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28924 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28925
28926
28927
28928 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28929 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28930 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28931 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28932 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28933 .code
28934 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28935 .endd
28936 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28937 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28938 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28939 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28940
28941
28942
28943
28944 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28945 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28946 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28947 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28948 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28949 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28950 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28951 .code
28952 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28953 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28954 .endd
28955 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28956 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28957 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28958 up by this example is
28959 .code
28960 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28961 .endd
28962 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28963 addresses. For example:
28964 .code
28965 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28966 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28967 .endd
28968 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28969 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28970
28971
28972
28973
28974 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28975 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28976 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28977 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28978 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28979 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28980 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28981 either to double the separators like this:
28982 .code
28983 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28984 .endd
28985 or to change the separator character, like this:
28986 .code
28987 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28988 .endd
28989 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28990 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28991 occurs. Consider this condition:
28992 .code
28993 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28994 .endd
28995 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28996 .code
28997 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28998 a.domain.black.list.tld
28999 .endd
29000 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29001 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29002 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29003 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29004 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29005 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29006 error for a previous item.
29007
29008 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29009 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29010 .code
29011 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29012 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29013 .endd
29014 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29015 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29016 .code
29017 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29018 $sender_address_domain \
29019 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29020 see $dnslist_text.
29021 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29022 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29023 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29024 .endd
29025 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29026 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29027 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29028 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29029 .code
29030 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29031 .endd
29032 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29033 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29034
29035 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29036 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29037
29038
29039
29040
29041 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29042 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29043 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29044 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29045 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29046 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29047 .display
29048 127.1.0.1 RBL
29049 127.1.0.2 DUL
29050 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29051 127.1.0.4 RSS
29052 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29053 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29054 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29055 .endd
29056 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29057 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29058 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29059
29060
29061 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29062 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29063 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29064 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29065 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29066 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29067 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29068 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29069 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29070 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29071 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29072 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29073 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29074 cases, for example:
29075 .code
29076 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29077 .endd
29078 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29079 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29080 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29081 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29082 .code
29083 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29084 .endd
29085 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29086 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29087
29088 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29089 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29090 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29091 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29092 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29093 information.
29094
29095 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29096 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29097 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29098 .code
29099 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29100 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29101 at $dnslist_domain
29102 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29103 .endd
29104
29105
29106
29107 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29108 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29109 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29110 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29111 For example,
29112 .code
29113 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29114 .endd
29115 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29116 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29117 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29118 describes how multiple records are handled.
29119
29120 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29121 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29122 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29123 .code
29124 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29125 .endd
29126 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29127 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29128 first. For example:
29129 .code
29130 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29131 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29132 .endd
29133
29134 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29135 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29136 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29137 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29138 tested. For example:
29139 .code
29140 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29141 .endd
29142 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29143 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29144 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29145 .code
29146 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29147 .endd
29148 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29149 an odd number.
29150
29151
29152
29153 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29154 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29155 condition. Whereas
29156 .code
29157 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29158 .endd
29159 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29160 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29161 .code
29162 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29163 .endd
29164 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29165 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29166 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29167 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29168
29169 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29170 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29171
29172 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29173 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29174 .code
29175 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29176 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29177 .endd
29178 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29179 Consider this example:
29180 .code
29181 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29182 list.dsbl.org : \
29183 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29184 relays.ordb.org
29185 .endd
29186 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29187 .code
29188 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29189 list.dsbl.org
29190 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29191 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29192 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29193 .endd
29194 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29195
29196
29197
29198
29199 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29200 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29201 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29202 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29203 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29204 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29205 .code
29206 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29207 .endd
29208 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29209 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29210 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29211 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29212 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29213 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29214
29215 .ilist
29216 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29217 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29218 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29219 .next
29220 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29221 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29222 changed to:
29223 .code
29224 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29225 .endd
29226 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29227 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29228 .code
29229 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29230 .endd
29231 for the condition to be true.
29232 .endlist
29233
29234 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29235 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29236 .ilist
29237 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29238 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29239 .code
29240 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29241 .endd
29242 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29243 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29244 .next
29245 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29246 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29247 .code
29248 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29249 .endd
29250 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29251 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29252 .code
29253 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29254 .endd
29255 for the condition to be false.
29256 .endlist
29257 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29258 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29259
29260
29261
29262
29263 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29264 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29265 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29266 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29267 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29268 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29269 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29270 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29271 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29272 lists.
29273
29274 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29275 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29276 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29277 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29278 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29279 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29280 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29281 .code
29282 reject message = \
29283 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29284 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29285 dnslists = \
29286 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29287 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29288 .endd
29289 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29290 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29291 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29292 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29293 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29294 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29295
29296 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29297 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29298 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29299 .code
29300 reject dnslists = \
29301 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29302 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29303 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29304 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29305 .endd
29306 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29307 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29308 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29309
29310
29311
29312 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29313 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29314 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29315 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29316 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29317 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29318 .code
29319 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29320 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29321 .endd
29322 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29323 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29324 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29325 .code
29326 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29327 .endd
29328 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29329 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29330
29331 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29332 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29333 .code
29334 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29335 dnslists = some.list.example
29336 .endd
29337
29338 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29339 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29340 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29341 .code
29342 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29343 .endd
29344
29345 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29346 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29347 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29348 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29349 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29350 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29351 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29352 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29353 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29354 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29355 .display
29356 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29357 .endd
29358 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29359 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29360
29361 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29362 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29363 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29364 of &'p'&.
29365
29366 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29367 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29368 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29369 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29370 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29371 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29372 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29373 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29374 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29375
29376 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29377 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29378 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29379 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29380
29381 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29382 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29383 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29384 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29385 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29386 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29387 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29388 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29389 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29390 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29391
29392 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29393 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29394 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29395 ACL.
29396
29397 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29398 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29399 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29400 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29401 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29402 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29403
29404 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29405 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29406 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29407 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29408 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29409 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29410 the &%count=%& option.
29411
29412
29413 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29414 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29415 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29416 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29417 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29418
29419 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29420 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29421 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29422 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29423
29424 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29425 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29426 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29427 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29428 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29429 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29430 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29431
29432 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29433 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29434 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29435 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29436 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
29437 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29438 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29439
29440 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29441 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29442 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29443 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29444 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29445
29446 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29447 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29448 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29449 multiple different commands.
29450
29451 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29452 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29453 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29454 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29455 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29456
29457 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29458
29459
29460 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29461 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29462 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29463 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29464 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29465
29466 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29467 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29468
29469 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29470 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29471 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29472 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29473 new rate.
29474 .code
29475 acl_check_connect:
29476 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29477 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29478 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29479 # ...
29480 acl_check_mail:
29481 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29482 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29483 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29484 .endd
29485
29486 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29487 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29488 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29489 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29490 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29491 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29492 checks.
29493
29494 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29495 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29496 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29497 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29498 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29499
29500
29501 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29502 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29503 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29504 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29505 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29506 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29507 rest of the ACL.
29508
29509 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29510 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29511 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29512 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29513 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29514 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29515 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29516 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29517 from getting any email through.
29518
29519 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29520 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29521 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29522 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29523 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29524 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29525 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29526 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29527 .code
29528 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29529 .endd
29530
29531
29532 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29533 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29534 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29535 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29536 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29537 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29538 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29539 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29540 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29541
29542 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29543 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29544 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29545 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29546 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29547 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29548
29549 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29550 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29551 rate.
29552
29553 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29554 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29555 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29556 required increases with larger limits.
29557
29558 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29559 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29560 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29561 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29562 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29563 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29564 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29565 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29566 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29567 as intended.
29568
29569
29570 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29571 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29572 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29573 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29574 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29575 message. For example:
29576 .code
29577 # Log all senders' rates
29578 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29579 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29580
29581 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29582 # at the decimal point.
29583 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29584 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29585 $sender_rate_limit }s
29586
29587 # Keep authenticated users under control
29588 deny authenticated = *
29589 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29590
29591 # System-wide rate limit
29592 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29593 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29594
29595 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29596 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29597 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29598 messages per $sender_rate_period
29599 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29600 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29601 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29602 .endd
29603 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29604 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29605 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29606 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29607 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29608 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29609 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29610
29611
29612
29613 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29614 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29615 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29616 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29617 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29618 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29619 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29620 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29621 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29622 .code
29623 verify = sender/callout
29624 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29625 .endd
29626 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29627 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29628 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29629 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29630 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29631 The available options are as follows:
29632
29633 .ilist
29634 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29635 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29636 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29637 .next
29638 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29639 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29640 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29641 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29642 .next
29643 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29644 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29645 .next
29646 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29647 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
29648 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
29649 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
29650 .endlist
29651
29652 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
29653 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
29654 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
29655 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29656 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
29657 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
29658 coding like this:
29659 .code
29660 warn !verify = sender
29661 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
29662 .endd
29663 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
29664 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
29665 verification failure.
29666
29667 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
29668 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
29669
29670 .ilist
29671 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
29672 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
29673 .next
29674 &%route%&: Routing failed.
29675 .next
29676 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29677 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29678 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29679 .next
29680 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29681 .next
29682 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29683 .endlist
29684
29685 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29686 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29687
29688
29689
29690
29691 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29692 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29693 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29694 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29695 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29696 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29697 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29698 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29699 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29700 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29701 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29702 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29703 sender's domain.
29704
29705 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29706 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29707 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29708 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29709 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29710 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29711
29712 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29713 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29714 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29715 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29716 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29717
29718 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29719 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29720 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29721 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29722 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29723 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29724 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29725 supplies a host list.
29726 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29727
29728 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29729 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29730 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29731 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29732 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29733 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29734 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29735
29736 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29737 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29738 following SMTP commands are sent:
29739 .display
29740 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29741 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
29742 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
29743 &`QUIT`&
29744 .endd
29745 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
29746 set to &"lmtp"&.
29747
29748 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
29749 settings.
29750
29751 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
29752 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
29753 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
29754 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
29755 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
29756 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
29757
29758 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
29759 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
29760 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
29761 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
29762 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
29763
29764 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29765 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
29766 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
29767 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
29768 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
29769
29770
29771
29772
29773 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
29774 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
29775 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
29776 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
29777 .code
29778 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29779 .endd
29780 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29781 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29782 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29783
29784
29785 .vlist
29786 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29787 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29788 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29789 For example:
29790 .code
29791 verify = sender/callout=5s
29792 .endd
29793 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29794 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29795 the &%connect%& parameter.
29796
29797
29798 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29799 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29800 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29801 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29802 .code
29803 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29804 .endd
29805 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29806
29807 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
29808 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29809 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29810 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29811 updated in this circumstance.
29812
29813 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29814 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29815 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29816 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29817 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29818 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29819
29820
29821 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29822 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29823 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29824 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29825 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29826 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29827 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29828 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29829 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29830 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29831 .code
29832 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29833 .endd
29834 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29835
29836
29837 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29838 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29839 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29840 For example:
29841 .code
29842 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29843 .endd
29844 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29845 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29846 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29847 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29848 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
29849
29850
29851 .vitem &*no_cache*&
29852 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29853 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29854 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29855
29856 .vitem &*postmaster*&
29857 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29858 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29859 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29860 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29861 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29862 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29863 made, until the cache record expires.
29864
29865 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29866 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29867 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29868 For example:
29869 .code
29870 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29871 .endd
29872 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29873 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29874 .code
29875 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29876 .endd
29877 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29878 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29879 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29880 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29881
29882
29883 .vitem &*random*&
29884 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29885 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29886 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29887 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29888 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29889 .code
29890 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29891 .endd
29892 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29893 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29894 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29895 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29896 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29897
29898 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29899 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29900 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29901 .code
29902 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29903 .endd
29904 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29905 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29906 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29907 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29908 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29909
29910 .vitem &*use_sender*&
29911 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29912 .code
29913 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29914 .endd
29915 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29916 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29917 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29918 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29919 usefulness of callout caching.
29920 .endlist
29921
29922 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29923 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29924 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29925 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29926 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29927 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29928 these circumstances.
29929
29930 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29931 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29932 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29933 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29934 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29935 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29936 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29937
29938 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29939 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29940 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29941 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29942
29943
29944
29945
29946 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29947 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29948 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29949 .cindex "caching" "callout"
29950 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29951 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29952 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29953 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29954 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29955 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29956
29957 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29958 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29959 is not available.
29960
29961 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29962 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29963 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29964
29965 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29966 commands up to and including
29967 .code
29968 MAIL FROM:<>
29969 .endd
29970 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29971 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29972 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29973 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29974 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29975 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29976 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29977
29978 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29979 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29980 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29981 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29982 will eventually be noticed.
29983
29984 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29985 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29986 behaviour will be the same.
29987
29988
29989
29990 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29991 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29992 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29993 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29994 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29995 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29996 you might see:
29997 .code
29998 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29999 250 OK
30000 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30001 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30002 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30003 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30004 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30005 550 Sender verification failed
30006 .endd
30007 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30008 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30009 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30010 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30011 example:
30012 .code
30013 verify = sender/no_details
30014 .endd
30015
30016 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30017 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30018 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30019 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30020 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30021 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30022 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30023
30024 .ilist
30025 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30026 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30027 verification also fails.
30028 .next
30029 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30030 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30031 .endlist
30032
30033 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30034 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30035 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30036 .code
30037 A.Wol: aw123
30038 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30039 .endd
30040 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30041 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30042 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30043 verification to succeed.
30044
30045 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30046 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30047 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30048 option. For example:
30049 .code
30050 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30051 .endd
30052 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30053 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30054
30055 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30056 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30057 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30058 address and a report is output for each of them.
30059
30060
30061
30062 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30063 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30064 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30065 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30066 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30067 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30068 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30069 .code
30070 verify = csa
30071 .endd
30072 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30073 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30074 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30075 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30076 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30077 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30078
30079 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30080 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30081 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30082 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30083
30084 .ilist
30085 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30086 .next
30087 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30088 .next
30089 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30090 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30091 .next
30092 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30093 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30094 .endlist
30095
30096 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30097 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30098 .code
30099 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30100 .endd
30101 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30102 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30103 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30104 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30105 meaningful to say:
30106 .code
30107 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30108 .endd
30109 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30110 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30111 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30112
30113 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30114 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30115 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30116 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30117 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30118 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30119 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30120 of legitimate HELO domains.
30121
30122 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30123 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30124 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30125 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30126 lookup such as:
30127 .code
30128 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30129 .endd
30130 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30131 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30132 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30133
30134
30135
30136
30137 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30138 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30139 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30140 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30141 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30142 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30143 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30144 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30145
30146 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30147 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30148 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30149 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30150 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30151 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30152 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30153
30154 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30155 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30156 like this:
30157 .code
30158 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30159 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30160 }{$value}}
30161 .endd
30162 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30163 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30164 use this:
30165 .code
30166 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30167 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30168 senders = :
30169 recipients = +batv_senders
30170
30171 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30172 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30173 senders = :
30174 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30175 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30176 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30177 .endd
30178 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30179 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30180 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30181 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30182 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30183
30184 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30185 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30186 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30187 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30188 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30189 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30190 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30191
30192 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30193 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30194 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30195 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30196 .code
30197 batv_redirect:
30198 driver = redirect
30199 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30200 .endd
30201 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30202 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30203 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30204 local addresses.
30205
30206 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30207 can be used:
30208 .code
30209 external_smtp_batv:
30210 driver = smtp
30211 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30212 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30213 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30214 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30215 {$value}fail}}}
30216 .endd
30217 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30218
30219
30220
30221 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30222 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30223 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30224 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30225 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30226 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30227 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30228 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30229 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30230 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30231
30232 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30233 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30234 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30235 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30236 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30237 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30238 . ///
30239 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30240 . ///
30241 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30242 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30243 system to arbitrary domains.
30244
30245
30246 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30247 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30248 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30249 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30250
30251 .ilist
30252 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30253 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30254 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30255 .next
30256 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30257 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30258 .next
30259 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30260 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30261 .endlist
30262
30263
30264 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30265 .code
30266 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30267 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30268 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30269 .endd
30270 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30271 command:
30272 .code
30273 acl_check_rcpt:
30274 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30275 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30276 .endd
30277 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30278 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30279 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30280 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30281 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30282 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30283 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30284
30285
30286
30287 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30288 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30289 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30290 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30291 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30292
30293 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30294 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30295 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30296 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30297 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30298 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30299 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30300 .ecindex IIDacl
30301
30302
30303
30304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30306
30307 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30308 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30309 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30310 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30311 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30312 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30313 specification.
30314
30315 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30316 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30317 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30318 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30319 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30320
30321 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30322 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30323 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30324
30325 .ilist
30326 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30327 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30328 .next
30329 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30330 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30331 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30332 .next
30333 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30334 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30335 .next
30336 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30337 conditions.
30338 .next
30339 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30340 .endlist
30341
30342 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30343 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30344 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30345
30346 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30347 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30348 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30349 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30350 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30351 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30352
30353 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30354 temporarily created in a file called:
30355 .display
30356 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30357 .endd
30358 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30359 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30360 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30361 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30362 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30363 .code
30364 control = no_mbox_unspool
30365 .endd
30366 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30367 same directory by default.
30368
30369
30370
30371 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30372 .cindex "virus scanning"
30373 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30374 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30375 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30376 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30377 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30378 in memory and thus are much faster.
30379
30380 .new
30381 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30382 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30383 .wen
30384
30385 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30386 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30387 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30388 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30389 .display
30390 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30391 .endd
30392 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30393 .code
30394 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30395 .endd
30396 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30397 before use.
30398 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30399 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30400
30401 .vlist
30402 .new
30403 .vitem &%avast%&
30404 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30405 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30406 Security (currenty at version 1.1.7).
30407 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30408 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30409 This scanner type takes one option,
30410 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30411 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30412 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30413 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30414 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30415 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30416 For example:
30417 .code
30418 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30419 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30420 .endd
30421 If you omit the argument, the default path
30422 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30423 is used.
30424 If you use a remote host,
30425 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30426 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30427 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30428 .code
30429 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30430 FLAGS
30431 SENSITIVITY
30432 PACK
30433 .endd
30434 .wen
30435
30436
30437 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30438 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30439 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30440 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30441 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30442 example:
30443 .code
30444 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30445 .endd
30446
30447
30448 .vitem &%clamd%&
30449 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30450 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30451 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30452 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30453 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
30454 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
30455 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
30456 .code
30457 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30458 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30459 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30460 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30461 .endd
30462 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
30463 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30464 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30465 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30466 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30467 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30468 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30469
30470 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30471 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30472 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30473 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30474 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30475 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30476 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30477 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30478 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30479 .code
30480 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30481 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30482 (Connection refused)
30483 .endd
30484
30485 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30486 contributing the code for this scanner.
30487
30488 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30489 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30490 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30491 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30492 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30493
30494 .olist
30495 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30496 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30497
30498 .next
30499 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30500 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30501 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30502 the &"trigger"& expression.
30503
30504 .next
30505 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30506 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30507 &"name"& expression.
30508 .endlist olist
30509
30510 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30511 .code
30512 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30513 .endd
30514 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30515 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30516 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30517 configuration setting:
30518 .code
30519 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30520 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30521 found in file:'(.+)'
30522 .endd
30523 .vitem &%drweb%&
30524 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30525 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30526 takes one option,
30527 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30528 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30529 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30530 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30531 For example:
30532 .code
30533 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30534 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30535 .endd
30536 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30537 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30538
30539 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30540 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30541 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30542 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30543 (or port-range).
30544 For example:
30545 .code
30546 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30547 .endd
30548 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30549
30550 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30551 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30552 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30553 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30554 .code
30555 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30556 .endd
30557 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30558 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30559
30560 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30561 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30562 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30563 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30564 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30565 For example:
30566 .code
30567 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30568 .endd
30569 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30570
30571 .vitem &%mksd%&
30572 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30573 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30574 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30575 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30576 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30577 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30578 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30579 .code
30580 av_scanner = mksd:2
30581 .endd
30582 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30583
30584 .vitem &%sock%&
30585 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30586 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30587 running on the local machine.
30588 There are four options:
30589 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30590 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30591 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30592 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30593 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30594 For example:
30595 .code
30596 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30597 .endd
30598 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30599 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30600 Both regular-expressions are required.
30601
30602 .vitem &%sophie%&
30603 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30604 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30605 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30606 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30607 client communication. For example:
30608 .code
30609 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30610 .endd
30611 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30612 the option.
30613 .endlist
30614
30615 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30616 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30617 ACL.
30618
30619 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30620 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30621 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30622 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30623 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30624 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30625 message.
30626
30627 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30628 .new
30629 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
30630 .wen
30631 The first element can then be one of
30632
30633 .ilist
30634 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
30635 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
30636 recommended usage.
30637 .next
30638 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
30639 the condition fails immediately.
30640 .next
30641 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
30642 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
30643 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
30644 .new
30645 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
30646 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
30647 .wen
30648 .endlist
30649
30650 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
30651 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
30652 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
30653
30654 .new
30655 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
30656 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
30657 For example:
30658 .code
30659 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
30660 .endd
30661 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
30662 .wen
30663
30664 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
30665 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
30666 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
30667 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
30668 logging data.
30669
30670 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
30671 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
30672 &%malware%& condition.
30673
30674 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
30675 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
30676
30677 Here is a very simple scanning example:
30678 .code
30679 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30680 demime = *
30681 malware = *
30682 .endd
30683 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
30684 .code
30685 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30686 demime = *
30687 malware = */defer_ok
30688 .endd
30689 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
30690 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
30691 .code
30692 av_scanner = $acl_m0
30693 .endd
30694 in the main Exim configuration.
30695 .code
30696 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30697 set acl_m0 = sophie
30698 malware = *
30699
30700 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30701 set acl_m0 = aveserver
30702 malware = *
30703 .endd
30704
30705
30706 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
30707 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
30708 .cindex "spam scanning"
30709 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
30710 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
30711 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
30712 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
30713 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
30714 .code
30715 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
30716 .endd
30717 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
30718 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
30719 nicely, however.
30720
30721 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
30722 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
30723 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
30724 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
30725 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
30726 .code
30727 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
30728 .endd
30729 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
30730 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
30731 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
30732 address/port pair:
30733 .code
30734 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
30735 .endd
30736 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
30737 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
30738 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
30739 option, separated with colons:
30740 .code
30741 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
30742 192.168.2.11 783 : \
30743 192.168.2.12 783
30744 .endd
30745 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
30746 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
30747 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
30748 condition defers.
30749
30750 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
30751 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
30752
30753 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
30754 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
30755 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
30756 expansion.
30757
30758 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
30759 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
30760 .code
30761 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30762 spam = joe
30763 .endd
30764 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
30765 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
30766 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
30767 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
30768 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
30769
30770 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
30771 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
30772 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
30773 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
30774 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
30775 are not set.
30776
30777 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
30778 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
30779 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
30780
30781
30782 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
30783 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
30784 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
30785 example:
30786 .code
30787 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30788 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
30789 spam = nobody
30790 .endd
30791
30792 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
30793 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
30794 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
30795 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
30796
30797 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
30798 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
30799 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
30800 available for use at delivery time.
30801
30802 .vlist
30803 .vitem &$spam_score$&
30804 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
30805 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
30806
30807 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
30808 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
30809 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
30810 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
30811 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
30812
30813 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
30814 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
30815 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
30816 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
30817 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
30818
30819 .vitem &$spam_report$&
30820 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
30821 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
30822 .endlist
30823
30824 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
30825 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
30826 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
30827
30828 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
30829 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
30830 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
30831 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
30832 spam condition, like this:
30833 .code
30834 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30835 spam = joe/defer_ok
30836 .endd
30837 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
30838
30839 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
30840 condition:
30841 .code
30842 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
30843 warn spam = nobody:true
30844 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
30845 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
30846
30847 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
30848 # is over threshold
30849 warn spam = nobody
30850 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
30851
30852 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
30853 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
30854 spam = nobody:true
30855 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
30856 .endd
30857
30858
30859
30860 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
30861 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
30862 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30863 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
30864 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
30865 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
30866 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
30867 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
30868 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
30869 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
30870 cases.
30871
30872 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
30873 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
30874 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
30875 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
30876 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
30877 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
30878 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
30879
30880 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
30881 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
30882 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
30883 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
30884 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
30885
30886 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30887 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30888 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30889 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30890 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30891 syntax is:
30892 .display
30893 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30894 .endd
30895 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30896 the value can be:
30897
30898 .olist
30899 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30900 .next
30901 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30902 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30903 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30904 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30905 .next
30906 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30907 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30908 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30909 the full path and file name.
30910 .next
30911 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30912 filename, and the default path is then used.
30913 .endlist
30914 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30915 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30916 a file with its original, proposed filename using
30917 .code
30918 decode = $mime_filename
30919 .endd
30920 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30921 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30922 automatically unlinked.
30923
30924 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30925 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30926 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30927 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30928 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30929
30930 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30931 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30932 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30933
30934 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30935 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30936 available in the MIME ACL:
30937
30938 .vlist
30939 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30940 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30941 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30942 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30943 contains the empty string.
30944
30945 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
30946 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30947 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30948 .code
30949 us-ascii
30950 gb2312 (Chinese)
30951 iso-8859-1
30952 .endd
30953 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30954 case-insensitively.
30955
30956 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30957 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30958 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30959 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30960 only used for display purposes.
30961
30962 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30963 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30964 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30965
30966 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30967 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30968 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30969
30970 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30971 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30972 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30973 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30974 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30975
30976 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30977 This variable contains the normalized content of the
30978 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30979 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30980
30981 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30982 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30983 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30984 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30985 .code
30986 text/plain
30987 text/html
30988 application/octet-stream
30989 image/jpeg
30990 audio/midi
30991 .endd
30992 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30993 empty string.
30994
30995 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30996 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30997 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30998 containing the decoded data.
30999 .endlist
31000
31001 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31002 .vlist
31003 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31004 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31005 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31006 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31007 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
31008 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31009
31010 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31011 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31012 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31013 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31014
31015 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31016 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31017 follows:
31018
31019 .olist
31020 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31021
31022 .next
31023 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31024 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31025
31026 .next
31027 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31028 and the rest are attachments.
31029
31030 .next
31031 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31032 .endlist olist
31033
31034 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31035 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31036 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31037 .code
31038 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31039 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31040 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31041 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31042 .endd
31043 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31044 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31045 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31046 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31047 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31048
31049 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31050 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31051 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31052 decoding is fully recursive.
31053
31054 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31055 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31056 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31057 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31058 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31059 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31060 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31061 .endlist
31062
31063
31064
31065 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31066 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31067 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31068 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31069 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31070
31071 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31072 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31073 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31074 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31075 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31076
31077 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31078 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31079 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31080 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31081 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31082 32K characters are checked.
31083
31084 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31085 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31086 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31087 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31088 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31089 .code
31090 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31091 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31092 .endd
31093 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31094 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31095 matching regular expression.
31096
31097 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31098 CPU-intensive.
31099
31100
31101
31102
31103 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31104 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31105 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31106 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31107 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31108 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31109 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31110 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31111 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31112 use the &%demime%& condition.
31113
31114 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31115 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31116 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31117 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31118 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31119 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31120
31121 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31122 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31123 example:
31124 .code
31125 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31126 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31127 .endd
31128 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31129 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31130 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31131 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31132
31133 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31134 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31135 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31136
31137 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31138
31139 .vlist
31140 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31141 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31142 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31143 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31144 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31145 zero, no error occurred.
31146
31147 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31148 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31149 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31150 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31151 .endlist
31152
31153 .vlist
31154 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31155 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31156 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31157 extension it found.
31158 .endlist
31159
31160 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31161 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31162
31163 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31164 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31165 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31166 facility:
31167 .code
31168 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31169 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31170 demime = *
31171 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31172
31173 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31174 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31175 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31176 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31177
31178 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31179 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31180 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31181 demime = exe:doc
31182 control = freeze
31183 .endd
31184 .ecindex IIDcosca
31185
31186
31187
31188
31189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31191
31192 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31193 "Local scan function"
31194 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31195 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31196 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31197 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31198 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31199
31200 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31201 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31202 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31203 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31204 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31205
31206 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31207 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31208 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31209 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31210
31211 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31212 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31213 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31214 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31215
31216 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31217 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31218 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31219 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31220 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31221 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31222 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31223 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31224 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31225
31226
31227
31228 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31229 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31230 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31231 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31232 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31233 directory, so you might set
31234 .code
31235 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31236 .endd
31237 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31238 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31239 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31240 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31241 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31242 _src/local_scan.c_.
31243
31244 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31245 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31246 .code
31247 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31248 .endd
31249 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31250
31251
31252
31253
31254 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31255 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31256 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31257 .code
31258 #include "local_scan.h"
31259 .endd
31260 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31261 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31262 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31263 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31264 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31265 strings and pointers to character strings:
31266 .code
31267 #define CS (char *)
31268 #define CCS (const char *)
31269 #define CSS (char **)
31270 #define US (unsigned char *)
31271 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31272 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31273 .endd
31274 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31275 .code
31276 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31277 .endd
31278 The arguments are as follows:
31279
31280 .ilist
31281 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31282 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31283 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31284
31285 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31286 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31287 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31288 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31289 case this changes in some future version.
31290 .next
31291 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31292 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31293 .endlist
31294
31295 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31296
31297 .vlist
31298 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31299 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31300 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31301 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31302 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31303 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31304
31305 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31306 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31307 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31308
31309 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31310 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31311 queued without immediate delivery.
31312
31313 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31314 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31315 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31316 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31317 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31318 used.
31319
31320 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31321 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31322 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31323 problem"& is used.
31324
31325 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31326 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31327 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31328 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31329 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31330 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31331 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31332
31333 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31334 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31335 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31336 .endlist
31337
31338 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31339 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31340 &%-oe%& command line options.
31341
31342
31343
31344 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31345 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31346 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31347 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31348 want to do this, you must have the line
31349 .code
31350 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31351 .endd
31352 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31353 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31354 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31355 to define them.
31356
31357 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31358 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31359 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31360 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31361 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31362 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31363 .code
31364 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31365 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31366
31367 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31368 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31369 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31370 };
31371
31372 int local_scan_options_count =
31373 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31374 .endd
31375 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31376 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31377 .code
31378 begin local_scan
31379 my_integer = 99
31380 my_string = some string of text...
31381 .endd
31382 The available types of option data are as follows:
31383
31384 .vlist
31385 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31386 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31387 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31388 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31389 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31390 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31391 values.)
31392
31393 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31394 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31395 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31396 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31397
31398 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31399 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31400 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31401 Exim.
31402
31403 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31404 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31405 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31406 printed with the suffix K or M.
31407
31408 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31409 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31410 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31411 always output in octal.
31412
31413 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31414 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31415 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31416
31417 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31418 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31419 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31420 .endlist
31421
31422 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31423 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31424
31425
31426
31427 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31428 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31429 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31430 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31431 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31432 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31433 C variables are as follows:
31434
31435 .vlist
31436 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31437 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31438
31439 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31440 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31441
31442 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31443 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31444 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31445 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31446
31447 .ilist
31448 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31449 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31450 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31451
31452 .next
31453 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31454 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31455 of debugging bits.
31456 .endlist ilist
31457
31458 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31459 selected, you should use code like this:
31460 .code
31461 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31462 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31463 .endd
31464 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31465 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31466 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31467
31468 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31469 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31470 discussed below.
31471
31472 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31473 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31474
31475 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31476 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31477
31478 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31479 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31480 &%-bh%& command line option.
31481
31482 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31483 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31484 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31485
31486 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31487 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31488 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31489 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31490
31491 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31492 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31493 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31494
31495 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31496 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31497
31498 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31499 The number of accepted recipients.
31500
31501 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31502 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31503 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31504 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31505 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31506 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31507 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31508 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31509 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31510 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31511 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31512 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31513
31514 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31515 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31516
31517 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31518 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31519 locally-submitted messages.
31520
31521 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31522 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31523 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31524
31525 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31526 The name of the sending host, if known.
31527
31528 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31529 The port on the sending host.
31530
31531 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31532 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31533
31534 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31535 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31536
31537 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31538 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31539 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31540 .endlist
31541
31542
31543 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31544 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31545 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31546 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31547 their type to *.
31548
31549
31550 .vlist
31551 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
31552 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
31553
31554 .vitem &*int&~type*&
31555 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
31556 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
31557 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
31558 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
31559 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
31560 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
31561
31562 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
31563 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
31564 internal newlines.
31565
31566 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
31567 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
31568 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
31569 .endlist
31570
31571
31572
31573 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
31574 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
31575
31576 .vlist
31577 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
31578 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
31579
31580 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
31581 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
31582 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
31583 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
31584
31585 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
31586 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
31587 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
31588 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
31589 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
31590 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
31591 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
31592 is NULL for all recipients.
31593 .endlist
31594
31595
31596
31597 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
31598 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
31599 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
31600 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
31601 release:
31602
31603 .vlist
31604 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
31605 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
31606
31607 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
31608 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
31609 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
31610 for the process in &%newumask%&.
31611
31612 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
31613 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
31614 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
31615 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
31616 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
31617
31618 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
31619
31620 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
31621 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
31622 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
31623 return value is as follows:
31624
31625 .ilist
31626 >= 0
31627
31628 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
31629 ending status.
31630
31631 .next
31632 < 0 and > &--256
31633
31634 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
31635 signal number.
31636
31637 .next
31638 &--256
31639
31640 The process timed out.
31641 .next
31642 &--257
31643
31644 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
31645 .endlist
31646
31647 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
31648 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
31649 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
31650 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
31651 forks a subprocess that is running
31652 .code
31653 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
31654 .endd
31655 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
31656 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
31657 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
31658 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
31659
31660 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
31661 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
31662 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
31663 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
31664
31665
31666 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
31667 *sender_authentication)*&
31668 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
31669 that it runs is:
31670 .display
31671 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
31672 .endd
31673 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
31674
31675
31676 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31677 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
31678 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
31679 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
31680 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
31681 .code
31682 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31683 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31684 .endd
31685
31686 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
31687 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
31688 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
31689 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
31690 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
31691 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
31692 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
31693 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
31694
31695 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
31696 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
31697 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
31698 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
31699 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
31700 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
31701
31702 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31703 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
31704 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
31705 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
31706
31707 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
31708 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
31709 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
31710 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
31711 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
31712 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
31713 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
31714 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
31715 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
31716 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
31717 .code
31718 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
31719 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
31720 .endd
31721 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
31722 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
31723
31724
31725 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
31726 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
31727 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
31728 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
31729 match the specification, the function does nothing.
31730
31731
31732 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31733 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
31734 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
31735 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
31736 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
31737 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
31738 .code
31739 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
31740 .endd
31741 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
31742 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
31743 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
31744 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
31745 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
31746 zero-terminated.
31747
31748 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
31749 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
31750 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
31751 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
31752 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
31753 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
31754 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
31755 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
31756
31757 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
31758 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
31759 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
31760 .display
31761 &`OK `& match succeeded
31762 &`FAIL `& match failed
31763 &`DEFER `& match deferred
31764 .endd
31765 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
31766 inability to contact a database.
31767
31768 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31769 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31770 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
31771 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
31772 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31773
31774 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31775 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31776 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
31777 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
31778 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31779
31780 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
31781 uschar&~*list)*&"
31782 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
31783 expected to be
31784 .code
31785 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
31786 .endd
31787 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
31788 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
31789 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
31790 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
31791 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
31792 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
31793 failed.
31794
31795 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
31796 *format,&~...)*&"
31797 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
31798 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
31799 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
31800 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
31801 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
31802 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
31803
31804
31805 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
31806 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
31807 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
31808 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
31809
31810 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
31811 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
31812 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
31813 value afterwards. For example:
31814 .code
31815 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
31816 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
31817 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
31818 .endd
31819
31820 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
31821 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
31822 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
31823 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
31824 address.
31825 .endlist
31826
31827
31828 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31829 .vlist
31830 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
31831 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
31832 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
31833 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
31834 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
31835 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
31836 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
31837 binary string is returned with an error message.
31838
31839 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
31840 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
31841 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
31842
31843 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
31844 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
31845 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
31846 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
31847 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
31848
31849 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
31850 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
31851 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
31852
31853 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
31854 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
31855 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
31856 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
31857 with translation.
31858
31859
31860 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
31861 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
31862 below.
31863
31864 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31865 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
31866 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
31867 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
31868 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
31869 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
31870 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
31871 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
31872 is involved.
31873
31874 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
31875 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
31876
31877 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
31878 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
31879 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
31880 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
31881 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
31882 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
31883 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
31884 .code
31885 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
31886 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31887 .endd
31888 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31889 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31890 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31891 multiple output lines.
31892
31893 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31894 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31895 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31896 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31897 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31898 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31899 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31900 is an error.
31901
31902 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31903 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31904 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31905 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31906
31907 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31908 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31909 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31910
31911 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31912 See below.
31913
31914 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31915 See below.
31916
31917 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31918 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31919 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31920 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31921 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31922 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31923 more discussion.
31924 .endlist
31925
31926
31927
31928 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31929 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31930 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31931 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31932 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31933 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31934 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31935 terminates.
31936
31937 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31938 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31939 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31940 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31941
31942 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31943 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31944 .code
31945 store_pool = POOL_PERM
31946 .endd
31947 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31948 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31949 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31950 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31951
31952 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31953 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31954 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31955 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31956 &%store_pool%&.
31957 .ecindex IIDlosca
31958
31959
31960
31961
31962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31964
31965 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31966 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31967 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31968 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31969 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31970 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31971 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31972 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31973
31974 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31975 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31976 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31977 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31978 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31979
31980 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31981 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31982 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31983 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31984 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31985 prevent it happening on retries.
31986
31987 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31988 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31989 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31990 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31991 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31992 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31993 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31994 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31995
31996
31997 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31998 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31999 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32000 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32001 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32002 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32003 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32004 .code
32005 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32006 system_filter_user = exim
32007 .endd
32008 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32009 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32010 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32011 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32012 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32013 by the &%reply%& command.
32014
32015
32016 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32017 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32018 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32019 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32020
32021 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32022 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32023
32024
32025
32026 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32027 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32028 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32029 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32030 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32031 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32032 they cause errors.
32033
32034 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32035 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32036 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32037 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32038 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32039 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32040 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32041
32042 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32043 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32044 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32045 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32046 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32047
32048 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32049 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32050 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32051 to which users' filter files can refer.
32052
32053
32054
32055 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32056 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32057 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32058 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32059 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32060
32061
32062
32063 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32064 .cindex "freezing messages"
32065 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32066 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32067 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32068 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32069 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32070 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32071 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32072 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32073 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32074 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32075 .code
32076 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32077 .endd
32078 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32079
32080 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32081 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32082 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32083 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32084 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32085 run.
32086
32087 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32088 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32089 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32090 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32091
32092 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32093 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32094 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32095 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32096 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32097 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32098 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32099 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32100 message. For example:
32101 .code
32102 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32103 because it contains attachments that we are \
32104 not prepared to receive."
32105 .endd
32106
32107 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32108 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32109 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32110 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32111 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32112 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32113 use, for example
32114 .code
32115 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32116 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32117 .endd
32118 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32119 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32120 generated by the filter.
32121
32122 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32123 &%defer%&,
32124 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32125 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32126 as
32127 .code
32128 mail ...
32129 freeze
32130 .endd
32131 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32132 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32133 take place.
32134
32135
32136
32137 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32138 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32139 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32140 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32141 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32142 .code
32143 headers add <string>
32144 headers remove <string>
32145 .endd
32146 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32147 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32148 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32149 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32150 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32151
32152 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32153 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32154 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32155 example:
32156 .code
32157 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32158 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32159 X-header-2: ...."
32160 .endd
32161 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32162 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32163 space after input continuations is ignored.
32164
32165 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32166 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32167 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32168 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32169 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32170
32171 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32172 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32173 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32174 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32175 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32176 used for all recipients of the message.
32177
32178 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32179 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32180 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32181 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32182 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32183 until the message is actually being written (see section
32184 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32185
32186 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32187 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32188 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32189 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32190 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32191 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32192 modified more than once.
32193
32194 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32195 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32196 For example:
32197 .code
32198 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32199 headers remove "Subject"
32200 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32201 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32202 .endd
32203
32204
32205
32206 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32207 .cindex "envelope sender"
32208 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32209 .code
32210 errors_to <some address>
32211 .endd
32212 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32213 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32214 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32215 might use
32216 .code
32217 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32218 .endd
32219 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32220 address if its delivery failed.
32221
32222
32223
32224 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32225 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32226 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32227 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32228 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32229 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32230 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32231 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32232 which implements such a filter:
32233 .code
32234 central_filter:
32235 check_local_user
32236 driver = redirect
32237 domains = +local_domains
32238 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32239 no_verify
32240 allow_filter
32241 allow_freeze
32242 .endd
32243 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32244 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32245 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32246 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32247
32248 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32249 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32250 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32251 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32252 normal way.
32253 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32254 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32255 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32256
32257
32258
32259
32260
32261
32262 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32263 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32264
32265 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32266 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32267 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32268 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32269 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32270 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32271 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32272 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32273
32274 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32275 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32276 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32277 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32278 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32279
32280 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32281 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32282 loopback interface specially in any way.
32283
32284 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32285 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32286
32287
32288
32289
32290 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32291 .cindex "message" "submission"
32292 .cindex "submission mode"
32293 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32294 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32295 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32296 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32297 .code
32298 control = submission
32299 .endd
32300 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32301 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32302 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32303 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32304 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32305 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32306 .code
32307 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32308 control = submission
32309 .endd
32310 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32311 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32312 is used to separate options. For example:
32313 .code
32314 control = submission/sender_retain
32315 .endd
32316 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32317 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32318 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32319 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32320 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32321 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32322 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32323
32324 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32325 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32326 example:
32327 .code
32328 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32329 .endd
32330 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32331 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32332 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32333 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32334 .code
32335 accept authenticated = *
32336 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32337 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32338 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32339 .endd
32340 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32341 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32342 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32343 .code
32344 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32345 .endd
32346 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32347 line would be:
32348 .code
32349 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32350 .endd
32351 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32352 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32353 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32354 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32355
32356 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32357 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32358 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32359 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32360 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32361 spoof another's address.
32362
32363 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32364 .cindex "line endings"
32365 .cindex "carriage return"
32366 .cindex "linefeed"
32367 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32368 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32369 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32370 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32371 use CRLF or just CR.
32372
32373 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32374 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32375 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32376 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32377 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32378 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32379 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32380 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32381 follows:
32382
32383 .ilist
32384 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32385 .next
32386 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32387 is ignored.
32388 .next
32389 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32390 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32391 terminator.
32392 .next
32393 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32394 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32395 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32396 people trying to play silly games.
32397 .next
32398 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32399 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32400 line.
32401 .endlist
32402
32403
32404
32405
32406
32407 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32408 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32409 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32410 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32411 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32412 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32413 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32414 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32415
32416 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32417 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32418 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32419 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32420 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32421
32422 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32423 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32424 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32425 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32426 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32427 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32428 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32429 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32430
32431
32432
32433
32434 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32435 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32436 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32437 .cindex "sender" "address"
32438 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32439 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32440 .cindex "envelope sender"
32441 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32442 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32443 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32444 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32445 .code
32446 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32447 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32448 .endd
32449 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32450 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32451 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32452 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32453 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32454 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32455 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32456 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32457 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32458
32459 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32460 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32461 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32462 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32463 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32464 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32465 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32466
32467 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32468 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32469 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32470
32471 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32472 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32473 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32474 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32475
32476
32477
32478 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32479 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32480 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32481 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32482 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32483 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32484 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32485
32486 .blockquote
32487 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32488 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32489 .endblockquote
32490
32491 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32492 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32493 follows:
32494
32495 .ilist
32496 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32497 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32498 .next
32499 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32500 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32501 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32502 .next
32503 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32504 also removed.
32505 .next
32506 For a locally-submitted message,
32507 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32508 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32509 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32510 included in log lines in this case.
32511 .next
32512 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32513 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32514 .endlist
32515
32516
32517
32518
32519 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32520 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32521 includes the header line:
32522 .code
32523 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32524 .endd
32525
32526 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32527 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32528 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32529 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32530 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32531 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32532
32533
32534 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32535 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32536 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32537 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32538 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32539
32540 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32541 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32542 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32543 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32544 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32545 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32546 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32547 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32548 messages.
32549
32550
32551 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
32552 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
32553 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
32554 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
32555 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
32556 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
32557 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
32558 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
32559 messages.
32560
32561
32562 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
32563 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
32564 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32565 .cindex "message" "submission"
32566 .cindex "submission mode"
32567 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
32568 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
32569
32570 .ilist
32571 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
32572 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
32573 .next
32574 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32575 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
32576 .olist
32577 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32578 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32579 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32580 .next
32581 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
32582 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32583 .next
32584 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32585 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32586 .endlist
32587 .endlist
32588
32589 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
32590
32591 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
32592 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
32593 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
32594 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32595 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
32596 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
32597 &%qualify_domain%&.
32598
32599 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
32600 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
32601 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
32602 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32603
32604
32605 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
32606 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
32607 .cindex "message" "submission"
32608 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
32609 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
32610 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
32611 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
32612 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
32613 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
32614 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
32615 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
32616 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
32617 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
32618
32619
32620 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
32621 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
32622 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
32623 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
32624 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
32625
32626 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
32627 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
32628 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
32629 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
32630
32631 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
32632 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
32633 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
32634
32635
32636 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
32637 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
32638 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
32639 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
32640 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
32641 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
32642 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
32643 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
32644 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
32645 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
32646 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
32647
32648
32649
32650 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
32651 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
32652 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
32653 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
32654 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
32655 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
32656 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
32657 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
32658
32659
32660
32661 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
32662 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
32663 .cindex "message" "submission"
32664 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
32665 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
32666 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
32667 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32668 control setting.
32669
32670 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
32671 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32672 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
32673 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
32674 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
32675 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
32676 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
32677 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
32678 line is added to the message.
32679
32680 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
32681 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
32682 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
32683 options true at the same time.
32684
32685 .cindex "submission mode"
32686 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
32687 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
32688 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
32689 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
32690
32691 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32692 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
32693 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
32694 created as follows:
32695
32696 .ilist
32697 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32698 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32699 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32700 .next
32701 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
32702 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32703 .next
32704 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32705 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32706 .endlist
32707
32708 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
32709 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
32710 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
32711 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
32712
32713 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
32714 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
32715 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
32716 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
32717
32718
32719
32720 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
32721 "SECTheadersaddrem"
32722 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
32723 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
32724 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
32725 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
32726 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
32727 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
32728 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
32729
32730 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
32731 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
32732 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
32733 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
32734 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
32735 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
32736
32737 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
32738 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
32739 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
32740
32741 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
32742 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
32743 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
32744 .code
32745 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
32746 X-added-second: another added header line
32747 .endd
32748 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
32749
32750 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
32751 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
32752 Each header-line is separately expanded.
32753
32754 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
32755 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
32756 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
32757 not part of the names. For example:
32758 .code
32759 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
32760 .endd
32761
32762 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
32763 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
32764 Each item is separately expanded.
32765 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
32766 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
32767 will act as list separators.
32768
32769 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
32770 items are expanded at routing time,
32771 and then associated with all addresses that are
32772 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
32773 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
32774 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
32775
32776 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
32777 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
32778 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
32779 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
32780
32781 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
32782 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
32783 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
32784 requirements.
32785
32786 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
32787 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
32788 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
32789 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
32790 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
32791 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
32792 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
32793
32794 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
32795 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
32796 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
32797 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
32798
32799 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
32800 the following consequences:
32801
32802 .ilist
32803 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
32804 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
32805 to it, at all times.
32806 .next
32807 Header lines that are added by a router's
32808 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
32809 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
32810 .next
32811 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
32812 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
32813 .next
32814 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
32815 a later router or by a transport.
32816 .next
32817 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
32818 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
32819 .code
32820 headers_remove = subject
32821 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
32822 .endd
32823 .endlist
32824
32825 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
32826 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
32827
32828
32829
32830
32831
32832 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
32833 .cindex "address" "constructed"
32834 .cindex "constructed address"
32835 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
32836 the form
32837 .display
32838 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
32839 .endd
32840 For example:
32841 .code
32842 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
32843 .endd
32844 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
32845 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
32846 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
32847 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
32848 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
32849 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
32850 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
32851 there is no password file entry.
32852
32853 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32854 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
32855 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
32856 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
32857 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
32858 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
32859 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
32860 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
32861 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
32862
32863
32864
32865 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
32866 .cindex "case of local parts"
32867 .cindex "local part" "case of"
32868 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
32869 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
32870 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
32871 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
32872 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
32873 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
32874 router option.
32875
32876 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
32877 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
32878 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
32879 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
32880 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
32881 .code
32882 correct_case:
32883 driver = redirect
32884 domains = +local_domains
32885 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
32886 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
32887 @$domain
32888 .endd
32889 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
32890 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32891 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32892 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32893 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32894
32895
32896
32897 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32898 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
32899 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
32900 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32901 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32902 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32903 empty components for compatibility.
32904
32905
32906
32907 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32908 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32909 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32910 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32911 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32912 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32913
32914 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32915 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32916 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32917 example, a header such as
32918 .code
32919 To: hare@teaparty
32920 .endd
32921 might get rewritten as
32922 .code
32923 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32924 .endd
32925 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32926 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32927 been routed.
32928
32929 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32930 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32931 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32932 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32933 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32934 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32935 .ecindex IIDmesproc
32936
32937
32938
32939 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32940 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32941
32942 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32943 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32944 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32945 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32946 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32947 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32948 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32949
32950 .ilist
32951 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32952 .next
32953 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32954 .next
32955 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32956 .endlist
32957
32958 For mail delivery, the following are available:
32959
32960 .ilist
32961 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32962 .next
32963 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32964 &"lmtp"&);
32965 .next
32966 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32967 transport);
32968 .next
32969 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32970 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32971 .endlist
32972
32973 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32974 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32975 used to contain the envelope information.
32976
32977
32978
32979 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32980 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32981 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32982 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32983 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32984 .cindex "EHLO"
32985 .cindex "HELO"
32986 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32987 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32988 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32989 processing is the same in both cases.
32990
32991 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32992 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32993 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32994 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32995 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32996 .cindex "transport" "filter"
32997 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32998 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32999 suppressed.
33000
33001 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33002 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33003 required for the transaction.
33004
33005 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33006 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33007 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33008 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33009 is called for verification.
33010
33011 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33012 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33013 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33014
33015 .cindex "carriage return"
33016 .cindex "linefeed"
33017 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33018 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33019 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33020 line terminator.
33021
33022 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33023 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33024 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33025 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33026 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33027 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33028 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33029 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33030 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33031
33032 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33033 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33034 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33035 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33036
33037 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33038 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33039 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33040 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33041
33042 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33043 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33044 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33045 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33046 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33047 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33048 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33049 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33050 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33051 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33052
33053 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33054 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33055
33056 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33057 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33058 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33059 square bracket of the IP address.
33060
33061
33062
33063
33064 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33065 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33066 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33067 .cindex "host" "error"
33068 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33069 message errors, and recipient errors.
33070
33071 .vlist
33072 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33073 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33074 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33075
33076 .ilist
33077 Connection refused or timed out,
33078 .next
33079 Any error response code on connection,
33080 .next
33081 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33082 .next
33083 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33084 .next
33085 I/O errors at any time,
33086 .next
33087 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33088 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33089 .endlist ilist
33090
33091 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33092 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33093 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33094 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33095 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33096 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33097 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33098 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33099
33100 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33101 .cindex "message" "error"
33102 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33103 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33104 message errors are:
33105
33106 .ilist
33107 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33108 the data,
33109 .next
33110 Timeout after MAIL,
33111 .next
33112 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33113 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33114 connection at any other time.
33115 .endlist ilist
33116
33117 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33118 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33119 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33120 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33121 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33122 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33123 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33124 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33125 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33126 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33127
33128 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33129 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33130 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33131 response to MAIL.
33132
33133 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33134 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33135 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33136 recipient errors are:
33137
33138 .ilist
33139 Any error response to RCPT,
33140 .next
33141 Timeout after RCPT.
33142 .endlist
33143
33144 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33145 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33146 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33147 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33148 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33149 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33150 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33151 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33152 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33153 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33154 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33155 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33156 the retry clock is reset.
33157
33158 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33159 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33160 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33161 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33162 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33163 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33164 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33165 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33166 recipient's retry time.
33167 .endlist
33168
33169 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33170 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33171 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33172 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33173 until the next delivery attempt.
33174
33175 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33176 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33177 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33178 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33179 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33180 is created.
33181
33182 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33183 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33184 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33185 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33186 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33187 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33188 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33189
33190 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33191 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33192 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33193 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33194 then to be treated as a host error.
33195
33196 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33197 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33198 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33199 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33200 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33201
33202
33203
33204
33205 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33206 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33207 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33208 .cindex "inetd"
33209 .cindex "daemon"
33210 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33211 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33212 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33213 .code
33214 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33215 .endd
33216 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33217 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33218 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33219 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33220 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33221 stream and exits with an error code.
33222
33223 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33224 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33225 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33226 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33227
33228 .cindex "carriage return"
33229 .cindex "linefeed"
33230 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33231 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33232 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33233 line terminator.
33234 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33235 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33236 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33237
33238 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33239 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33240 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33241 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33242 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33243 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33244 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33245 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33246
33247 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33248 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33249 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33250 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33251 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33252 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33253 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33254 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33255 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33256
33257 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33258 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33259 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33260
33261 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33262 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33263 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33264 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33265 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33266
33267 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33268 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33269 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33270 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33271 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33272 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33273 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33274
33275 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33276 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33277 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33278 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33279 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33280
33281 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33282 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33283 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33284 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33285 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33286 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33287 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33288 a delivery process.
33289
33290 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33291 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33292 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33293 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33294 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33295
33296 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33297 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33298 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33299 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33300
33301 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33302 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33303 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33304
33305
33306
33307 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33308 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33309 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33310 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33311 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33312 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33313 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33314 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33315
33316
33317 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33318 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33319 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33320 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33321 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33322 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33323 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33324 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33325 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33326 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33327 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33328
33329
33330
33331 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33332 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33333 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33334 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33335 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33336 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33337 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33338 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33339
33340 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33341 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33342 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33343 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33344 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33345 counted.
33346
33347 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33348 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33349 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33350
33351 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33352 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33353 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33354 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33355 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33356
33357
33358
33359
33360 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33361 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33362 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33363 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33364 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33365
33366 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33367 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33368 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33369
33370 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33371 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33372 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33373 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33374 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33375 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33376 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33377 RCPT failures.
33378
33379
33380
33381 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33382 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33383 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33384 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33385 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33386 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33387 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33388
33389 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33390 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33391 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33392 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33393 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33394 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33395 argument. For example,
33396 .code
33397 ETRN #brigadoon
33398 .endd
33399 runs the command
33400 .code
33401 exim -R brigadoon
33402 .endd
33403 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33404 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33405 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33406 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33407 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33408
33409 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33410 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33411 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33412 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33413 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33414 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33415 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33416 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33417
33418 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33419 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33420 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33421 whatever the form of its argument. For
33422 example:
33423 .code
33424 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33425 $sender_host_address
33426 .endd
33427 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33428 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33429 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33430 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33431 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33432 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33433 for it to change them before running the command.
33434
33435
33436
33437 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33438 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33439 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33440 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33441 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33442 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33443 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33444 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33445 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33446 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33447 runs for RCPT commands:
33448 .code
33449 accept hosts = :
33450 .endd
33451 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33452
33453
33454
33455 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33456 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33457 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33458 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33459 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33460 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33461 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33462 envelope along with the message.
33463
33464 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33465 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33466 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33467 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33468 can be used to specify it.
33469
33470 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33471 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33472 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33473 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33474 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33475
33476 .vindex "&$host$&"
33477 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33478 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33479 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33480 router:
33481 .code
33482 begin routers
33483 route_append:
33484 driver = manualroute
33485 transport = smtp_appendfile
33486 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33487
33488 begin transports
33489 smtp_appendfile:
33490 driver = appendfile
33491 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33492 batch_max = 1000
33493 use_bsmtp
33494 user = exim
33495 .endd
33496 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33497 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33498 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33499
33500
33501
33502 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33503 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33504 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33505 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33506 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33507 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33508 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33509 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33510 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33511 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33512
33513 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33514 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33515
33516 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33517 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33518 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33519 make some use of automatically, for example:
33520 .code
33521 554 Unexpected end of file
33522 Transaction started in line 10
33523 Error detected in line 14
33524 .endd
33525 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33526 file, for example:
33527 .code
33528 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33529 The error message was:
33530
33531 501 '>' missing at end of address
33532
33533 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33534 The error was detected in line 12.
33535 The SMTP command at fault was:
33536
33537 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33538
33539 1 previous message was successfully processed.
33540 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33541 .endd
33542 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33543 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33544 accepted.
33545 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33546 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33547
33548
33549
33550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33552
33553 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
33554 "Customizing messages"
33555 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
33556 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
33557 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
33558 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
33559 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
33560
33561 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
33562 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
33563 option. Exim also adds the line
33564 .code
33565 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
33566 .endd
33567 to all warning and bounce messages,
33568
33569
33570 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
33571 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
33572 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
33573 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
33574 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
33575 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
33576 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
33577
33578 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
33579 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
33580 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
33581 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
33582 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
33583 item.
33584
33585 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
33586 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
33587 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
33588 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
33589 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
33590 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
33591 option, rounded to a whole number.
33592
33593 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
33594
33595 .ilist
33596 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33597 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33598 .next
33599 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
33600 failing addresses with their error messages.
33601 .next
33602 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
33603 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
33604 .next
33605 .new
33606 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
33607 The fields exist for back-compatibility
33608 .wen
33609 .endlist
33610
33611 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
33612 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
33613 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
33614 .code
33615 Subject: Mail delivery failed
33616 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33617 {: returning message to sender}}
33618 ****
33619 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33620
33621 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33622 {that you sent }{sent by
33623
33624 <$sender_address>
33625
33626 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
33627 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
33628 ****
33629 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
33630 ****
33631 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
33632 ------
33633 ****
33634 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
33635 only the first
33636 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
33637 ****
33638 .endd
33639 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
33640 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
33641 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
33642 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
33643 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
33644 text sections:
33645
33646 .ilist
33647 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33648 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33649 .next
33650 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
33651 the delayed addresses.
33652 .next
33653 The third item then ends the message.
33654 .endlist
33655
33656 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
33657 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
33658 .code
33659 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
33660 $warn_message_delay
33661 ****
33662 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33663
33664 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
33665 {that you sent }{sent by
33666
33667 <$sender_address>
33668
33669 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
33670 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
33671
33672 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
33673 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
33674 The date of the message is: $h_date
33675
33676 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
33677 ****
33678 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
33679 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
33680 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
33681 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
33682 the message will be returned to you.
33683 .endd
33684 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
33685 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
33686 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
33687 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
33688 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
33689 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
33690 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
33691 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
33692 handled them.
33693
33694
33695
33696
33697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33699
33700 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
33701 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
33702 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
33703
33704
33705
33706 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
33707 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
33708 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
33709 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
33710 routing explicitly:
33711 .code
33712 send_to_smart_host:
33713 driver = manualroute
33714 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
33715 transport = remote_smtp
33716 .endd
33717 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
33718 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
33719 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
33720 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
33721 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
33722
33723
33724
33725
33726 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
33727 .cindex "mailing lists"
33728 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
33729 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
33730 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
33731
33732 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
33733 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
33734 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
33735 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
33736 .code
33737 lists:
33738 driver = redirect
33739 domains = lists.example
33740 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33741 forbid_pipe
33742 forbid_file
33743 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33744 no_more
33745 .endd
33746 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
33747 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
33748 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
33749 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
33750
33751 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
33752 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
33753 a mailing list.
33754
33755 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
33756 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
33757 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
33758 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
33759 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
33760
33761 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
33762 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
33763 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
33764 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
33765 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
33766 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
33767 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
33768 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
33769 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
33770
33771
33772
33773 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
33774 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
33775 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
33776 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
33777 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
33778 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
33779 addresses are not rigorously checked.
33780
33781 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
33782 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
33783 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
33784 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
33785 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
33786
33787
33788
33789 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
33790 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
33791 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
33792 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
33793 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
33794 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
33795 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
33796 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
33797 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
33798 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
33799
33800 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
33801 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
33802 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
33803 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
33804 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
33805 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
33806 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
33807 pre-existing messages.
33808
33809 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
33810 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
33811 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
33812 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
33813 one level of expansion anyway.
33814
33815
33816
33817 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
33818 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
33819 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
33820 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
33821 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
33822 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
33823
33824 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
33825 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
33826 .code
33827 lists_request:
33828 driver = redirect
33829 domains = lists.example
33830 local_part_suffix = -request
33831 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
33832 no_more
33833
33834 lists_post:
33835 driver = redirect
33836 domains = lists.example
33837 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
33838 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
33839 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33840 forbid_pipe
33841 forbid_file
33842 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33843 no_more
33844
33845 lists_closed:
33846 driver = redirect
33847 domains = lists.example
33848 allow_fail
33849 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
33850 .endd
33851 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
33852 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
33853 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
33854 mailing list.
33855
33856 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
33857 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
33858 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
33859 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
33860 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
33861 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
33862 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
33863 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
33864 &"unrouteable address"& error.
33865
33866 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
33867 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
33868 the address, giving a suitable error message.
33869
33870
33871
33872
33873 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
33874 .cindex "VERP"
33875 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
33876 .cindex "envelope sender"
33877 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
33878 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
33879 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
33880 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
33881 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
33882 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
33883
33884 .oindex &%errors_to%&
33885 .oindex &%return_path%&
33886 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
33887 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33888 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33889 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33890 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33891 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33892 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33893 .code
33894 verp_smtp:
33895 driver = smtp
33896 max_rcpt = 1
33897 return_path = \
33898 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33899 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33900 .endd
33901 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33902 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33903 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33904 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33905 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33906 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33907 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33908 rewritten as
33909 .code
33910 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33911 .endd
33912 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33913 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33914 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33915 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33916 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33917 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33918
33919 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33920 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33921 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33922 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33923 .code
33924 dnslookup:
33925 driver = dnslookup
33926 domains = ! +local_domains
33927 transport = \
33928 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33929 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33930 no_more
33931 .endd
33932 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33933 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33934 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33935 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33936 address.
33937
33938 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33939 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33940 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33941 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33942 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33943 .code
33944 verp_dnslookup:
33945 driver = dnslookup
33946 domains = ! +local_domains
33947 transport = remote_smtp
33948 errors_to = \
33949 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33950 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33951 no_more
33952 .endd
33953 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33954 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33955 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33956 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33957 them.
33958
33959 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33960 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33961 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33962 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33963 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33964 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33965 used).
33966
33967
33968
33969
33970
33971
33972 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33973 .cindex "virtual domains"
33974 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
33975 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33976 meanings:
33977
33978 .ilist
33979 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33980 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33981 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33982 .next
33983 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33984 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33985 have login accounts on that host.
33986 .endlist
33987
33988 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33989 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33990 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33991 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33992 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33993 to a router of this form:
33994 .code
33995 virtual:
33996 driver = redirect
33997 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33998 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33999 no_more
34000 .endd
34001 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34002 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34003 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34004 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34005 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34006 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34007
34008 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34009 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34010 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34011 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34012
34013 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34014 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34015 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34016 .code
34017 my_domains:
34018 driver = accept
34019 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34020 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34021 transport = my_mailboxes
34022 .endd
34023 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34024 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34025 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34026 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34027 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34028 follows:
34029 .code
34030 my_mailboxes:
34031 driver = appendfile
34032 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34033 user = mail
34034 .endd
34035 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34036 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34037
34038 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34039 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34040 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34041 information about the domains.
34042
34043
34044
34045 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34046 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34047 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34048 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34049 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34050 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34051 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34052 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34053 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34054 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34055 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34056 example, consider this router:
34057 .code
34058 userforward:
34059 driver = redirect
34060 check_local_user
34061 file = $home/.forward
34062 local_part_suffix = -*
34063 local_part_suffix_optional
34064 allow_filter
34065 .endd
34066 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34067 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34068 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34069 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34070 .code
34071 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34072 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34073 endif
34074 .endd
34075 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34076 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34077 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34078 control over which suffixes are valid.
34079
34080 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34081 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34082 another MTA:
34083 .code
34084 userforward:
34085 driver = redirect
34086 check_local_user
34087 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34088 local_part_suffix = -*
34089 local_part_suffix_optional
34090 allow_filter
34091 .endd
34092 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34093 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34094 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34095 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34096 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34097
34098
34099
34100 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34101 .cindex "vacation processing"
34102 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34103 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34104 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34105 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34106 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34107
34108 .ilist
34109 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34110 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34111 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34112 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34113 .code
34114 spqr, vacation-spqr
34115 .endd
34116 .next
34117 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34118 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34119 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34120 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34121 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34122 message.
34123 .endlist
34124
34125 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34126 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34127
34128
34129
34130 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34131 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34132 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34133 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34134 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34135 each day's messages.
34136
34137 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34138 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34139 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34140 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34141
34142
34143
34144 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34145 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34146 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34147 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34148 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34149 permanently connected.
34150
34151 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34152 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34153 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34154
34155
34156 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34157 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34158 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34159 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34160 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34161 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34162 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34163 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34164
34165 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34166 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34167 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34168 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34169 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34170 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34171 if required.
34172
34173 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34174 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34175 intermittent host. For example:
34176 .code
34177 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34178 .endd
34179 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34180 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34181 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34182 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34183 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34184 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34185 immediately.
34186
34187 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34188 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34189 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34190 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34191 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34192 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34193 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34194
34195
34196
34197 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34198 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34199 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34200 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34201 delivered immediately.
34202
34203 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34204 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34205 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34206 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34207 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34208 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34209 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34210 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34211 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34212 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34213 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34214 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34215 single SMTP connection.
34216
34217
34218
34219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34221
34222 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34223 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34224 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34225 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34226 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34227 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34228 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34229 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34230 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34231 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34232 messages this way.
34233
34234 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34235 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34236 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34237 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34238 email is not desirable.
34239
34240 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34241 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34242 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34243 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34244 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34245 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34246 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34247
34248 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34249 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34250 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34251 before sending a message to the smart host.
34252
34253 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34254 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34255 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34256
34257 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34258 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34259 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34260 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34261 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34262 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34263 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34264
34265 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34266 following ways:
34267
34268 .ilist
34269 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34270 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34271 .next
34272 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34273 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34274 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34275 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34276 successful, a zero return code is given.
34277 .next
34278 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34279 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34280 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34281 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34282 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34283 are.
34284 .next
34285 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34286 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34287 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34288 .next
34289 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34290 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34291 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34292 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34293 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34294 .next
34295 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34296 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34297 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34298 .next
34299 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34300 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34301 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34302 are ever generated.
34303 .next
34304 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34305 .next
34306 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34307 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34308 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34309 .endlist
34310
34311 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34312 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34313 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34314 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34315 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34316 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34317
34318
34319
34320
34321 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34322 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34323
34324 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34325 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34326 .cindex "log" "types of"
34327 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34328 and the panic log:
34329
34330 .ilist
34331 .cindex "main log"
34332 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34333 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34334 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34335 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34336 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34337 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34338 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34339 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34340 .next
34341 .cindex "reject log"
34342 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34343 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34344 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34345 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34346 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34347 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34348 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34349 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34350 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34351 false.
34352 .next
34353 .cindex "panic log"
34354 .cindex "system log"
34355 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34356 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34357 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34358 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34359 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34360 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34361 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34362 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34363 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34364 .endlist
34365
34366 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34367 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34368 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34369 .code
34370 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34371 by QUIT
34372 .endd
34373 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34374 ways of changing this:
34375
34376 .ilist
34377 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34378 you set
34379 .code
34380 timezone = UTC
34381 .endd
34382 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34383 .next
34384 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34385 example:
34386 .code
34387 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34388 .endd
34389 .endlist
34390
34391 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34392 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34393 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34394 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34395 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34396 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34397
34398
34399
34400
34401 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34402 .cindex "log" "destination"
34403 .cindex "log" "to file"
34404 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34405 .cindex "syslog"
34406 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34407 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34408 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34409 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34410 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34411 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34412 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34413
34414 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34415 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34416 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34417 references to the host name:
34418 .code
34419 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34420 .endd
34421 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34422 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34423 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34424 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34425 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34426 log at all.
34427
34428 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34429 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34430 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34431 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34432 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34433 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34434 implying the use of a default path.
34435
34436 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34437 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34438 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34439 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34440 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34441 equivalent to the setting:
34442 .code
34443 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34444 .endd
34445 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
34446 logs are written.
34447
34448 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34449 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34450
34451 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34452 .display
34453 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34454 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34455 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34456 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34457 .endd
34458 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34459 error is logged.
34460
34461
34462
34463 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34464 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34465 .cindex "cycling logs"
34466 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34467 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34468 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34469 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34470 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34471 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34472 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34473
34474 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34475 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34476 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34477 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34478 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34479 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34480 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34481 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34482 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34483 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34484 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34485 renamed.
34486
34487
34488
34489 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34490 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34491 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34492 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34493 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34494 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34495 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34496 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34497 .code
34498 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34499 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34500 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34501 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34502 .endd
34503 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34504 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34505 .code
34506 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34507 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34508 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34509 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34510 .endd
34511 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34512 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34513 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34514 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34515
34516 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34517 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34518 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34519 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34520 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34521 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34522 log names:
34523 .code
34524 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34525 /var/log/exim-panic.log
34526 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34527 /var/log/exim/panic
34528 .endd
34529
34530
34531 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34532 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34533 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34534 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34535 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34536 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34537 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34538 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34539 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34540 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34541 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34542 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34543 the time and host name to each line.
34544 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34545
34546 .ilist
34547 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34548 .next
34549 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34550 .next
34551 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
34552 .endlist
34553
34554 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
34555 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
34556 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
34557 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
34558
34559 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
34560 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
34561 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
34562 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
34563 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
34564 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
34565 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
34566 RFC 3164, you should set
34567 .code
34568 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
34569 .endd
34570 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
34571 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
34572
34573 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
34574 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
34575 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
34576 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
34577 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
34578 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
34579 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
34580 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
34581 name, and pid as added by syslog:
34582 .code
34583 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
34584 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
34585 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
34586 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
34587 [5/5] mple>)
34588 .endd
34589 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
34590 (LOG_NOTICE):
34591 .code
34592 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
34593 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
34594 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
34595 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
34596 [5\18] .example>)
34597 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
34598 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
34599 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
34600 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
34601 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
34602 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
34603 [12\18] F From: <>
34604 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
34605 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
34606 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
34607 [16\18] le>
34608 [17\18] B Bcc:
34609 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
34610 .endd
34611 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
34612 without modification.
34613
34614 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
34615 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
34616 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
34617 where it is.
34618
34619
34620
34621 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
34622 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
34623 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
34624 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
34625 timestamp. The flags are:
34626 .display
34627 &`<=`& message arrival
34628 &`=>`& normal message delivery
34629 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
34630 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
34631 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
34632 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
34633 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
34634 .endd
34635
34636
34637 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
34638 .cindex "log" "reception line"
34639 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34640 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
34641 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
34642 .code
34643 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
34644 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
34645 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
34646 .endd
34647 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
34648 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
34649 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
34650 .code
34651 R=<message id>
34652 .endd
34653 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
34654
34655 .cindex "HELO"
34656 .cindex "EHLO"
34657 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
34658 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
34659 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
34660 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
34661 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
34662 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
34663 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
34664 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
34665 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
34666 name in parentheses.
34667
34668 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
34669 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
34670 the log containing text like these examples:
34671 .code
34672 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
34673 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
34674 .endd
34675 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
34676 on.
34677
34678 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
34679 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
34680 of Exim.
34681
34682 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
34683 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
34684 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
34685 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
34686 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
34687 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
34688 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
34689 suite that was used.
34690
34691 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
34692 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
34693 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
34694 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
34695 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
34696 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
34697 authenticator name.
34698
34699 .cindex "size" "of message"
34700 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
34701 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
34702 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
34703 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
34704 other).
34705
34706 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34707 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34708
34709
34710
34711 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
34712 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
34713 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34714 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
34715 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
34716 to fit it on the page:
34717 .code
34718 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
34719 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
34720 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
34721 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
34722 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
34723 .endd
34724 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
34725 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
34726 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
34727 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
34728 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
34729
34730 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
34731 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
34732 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
34733 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
34734
34735 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
34736 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
34737 .display
34738 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
34739 .endd
34740 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
34741 parentheses afterwards.
34742
34743 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34744 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
34745 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
34746 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
34747 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
34748 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
34749
34750 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
34751 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
34752 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
34753 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
34754 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
34755
34756 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
34757 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
34758
34759 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34760 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34761
34762
34763 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
34764 .cindex "discarded messages"
34765 .cindex "message" "discarded"
34766 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
34767 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
34768 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
34769 .code
34770 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
34771 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
34772 .endd
34773 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
34774 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
34775 .code
34776 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
34777 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
34778 .endd
34779
34780
34781 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
34782 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
34783 .code
34784 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
34785 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
34786 .endd
34787 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
34788 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
34789 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
34790 .code
34791 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
34792 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
34793 .endd
34794 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
34795 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
34796 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
34797
34798
34799
34800 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
34801 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
34802 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
34803 following form is logged:
34804 .code
34805 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
34806 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
34807 .endd
34808 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
34809 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
34810 .code
34811 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
34812 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
34813 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
34814 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
34815 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
34816 .endd
34817 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
34818 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
34819 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
34820 flagged with &`**`&.
34821
34822
34823
34824 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
34825 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
34826 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
34827 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
34828 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
34829
34830
34831
34832 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
34833 A line of the form
34834 .code
34835 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
34836 .endd
34837 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
34838 at the end of its processing.
34839
34840
34841
34842
34843 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
34844 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
34845 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
34846 the following table:
34847 .display
34848 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
34849 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
34850 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34851 &`CV `& certificate verification status
34852 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34853 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
34854 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
34855 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
34856 &`H `& host name and IP address
34857 &`I `& local interface used
34858 &`id `& message id for incoming message
34859 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
34860 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
34861 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
34862 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
34863 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
34864 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
34865 &`S `& size of message
34866 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
34867 &`ST `& shadow transport name
34868 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
34869 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
34870 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
34871 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
34872 .endd
34873
34874
34875 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
34876 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
34877 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
34878
34879 .ilist
34880 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
34881 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
34882 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
34883 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
34884 during the first delivery attempt.
34885 .next
34886 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
34887 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
34888 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34889 .next
34890 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34891 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34892 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34893 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34894 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34895 doing.
34896 .next
34897 .cindex "error" "ignored"
34898 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34899 message:
34900 .olist
34901 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34902 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34903 .next
34904 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34905 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34906 .next
34907 A delivery set up by a router configured with
34908 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34909 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34910 .code
34911 errors_to = <>
34912 .endd
34913 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34914 .endlist olist
34915 .endlist ilist
34916
34917
34918
34919
34920
34921 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34922 .cindex "log" "selectors"
34923 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34924 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34925 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34926 example:
34927 .code
34928 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34929 .endd
34930 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34931 selection marked by asterisks:
34932 .display
34933 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34934 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34935 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34936 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34937 &` arguments `& command line arguments
34938 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34939 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34940 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34941 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34942 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34943 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34944 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34945 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34946 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
34947 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
34948 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34949 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34950 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34951 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34952 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34953 &` pid `& Exim process id
34954 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34955 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34956 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34957 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34958 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34959 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34960 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34961 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34962 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34963 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34964 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34965 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34966 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34967 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34968 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34969 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34970 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34971 .new
34972 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34973 .wen
34974 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34975 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34976 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34977 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34978
34979 &` all `& all of the above
34980 .endd
34981 More details on each of these items follows:
34982
34983 .ilist
34984 .cindex "8BITMIME"
34985 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34986 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34987 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34988 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34989 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34990 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34991 .next
34992 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34993 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34994 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34995 this log selector is set.
34996 .next
34997 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
34998 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34999 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35000 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35001 such users cannot access the log).
35002 .next
35003 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35004 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35005 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35006 parentheses between them.
35007 .next
35008 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35009 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35010 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35011 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35012 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35013 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35014 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35015 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35016 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35017 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35018 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35019 between the caller and Exim.
35020 .next
35021 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35022 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35023 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35024 .next
35025 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35026 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35027 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35028 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35029 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35030 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35031 .next
35032 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35033 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35034 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35035 .next
35036 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35037 .cindex "size" "of message"
35038 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35039 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35040 .next
35041 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35042 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35043 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35044 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35045 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35046 .next
35047 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35048 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35049 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35050 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35051 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35052 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35053 .next
35054 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35055 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35056 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35057 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35058 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35059 .next
35060 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35061 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35062 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35063 client's ident port times out.
35064 .next
35065 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35066 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35067 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35068 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35069 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35070 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35071 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35072 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35073 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"& and to
35074 rejection lines
35075 and (despite the name) the local interface is added to &"=>"& lines..
35076 .next
35077 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35078 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35079 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35080 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35081 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35082 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35083 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35084 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35085 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35086 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35087 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35088 .next
35089 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35090 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35091 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35092 .next
35093 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35094 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35095 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35096 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35097 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
35098 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
35099 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
35100 .next
35101 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35102 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35103 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35104 immediately after the time and date.
35105 .next
35106 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35107 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35108 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35109 .next
35110 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35111 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35112 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35113 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35114 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35115 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35116 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35117 message has been successfully received.
35118 .next
35119 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35120 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35121 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35122 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35123 .next
35124 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35125 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35126 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35127 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35128 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35129 has taken place.
35130 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35131 in the list.
35132 .next
35133 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35134 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35135 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35136 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35137 .next
35138 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35139 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35140 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35141 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35142 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35143 .next
35144 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35145 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35146 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35147 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35148 attempt.
35149 .next
35150 .cindex "log" "return path"
35151 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35152 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35153 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35154 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35155 .next
35156 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35157 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35158 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35159 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35160 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35161 .next
35162 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35163 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35164 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35165 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35166 detail is lost.
35167 .next
35168 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35169 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35170 it is too big.
35171 .next
35172 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35173 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35174 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35175 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35176 it.
35177 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35178 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35179 .next
35180 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35181 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35182 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35183 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35184 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35185 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35186 response.
35187 .next
35188 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35189 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35190 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
35191 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35192 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35193 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35194 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35195 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35196 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35197 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35198
35199 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35200 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35201 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35202 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35203 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35204 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35205 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35206 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35207 .next
35208 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35209 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35210 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35211 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35212 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35213 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35214 .next
35215 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35216 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35217 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35218 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35219 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35220 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35221 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35222 already have their own log lines.
35223
35224 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35225 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35226 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35227 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35228 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35229 the same logging options.
35230
35231 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35232 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35233 .code
35234 C=EHLO,QUIT
35235 .endd
35236 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35237 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35238 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35239 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35240 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35241 .next
35242 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35243 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35244 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35245 was accepted or used.
35246 .next
35247 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35248 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35249 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35250 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35251 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35252 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35253 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35254 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35255 .next
35256 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35257 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35258 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35259 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35260 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35261 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35262 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35263 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35264 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35265 .next
35266 .cindex "log" "subject"
35267 .cindex "subject, logging"
35268 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35269 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35270 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35271 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35272 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35273 .next
35274 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35275 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35276 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35277 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35278 .next
35279 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35280 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35281 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35282 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35283 .next
35284 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35285 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35286 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35287 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35288 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35289 .next
35290 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35291 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35292 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35293 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35294 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35295 .next
35296 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35297 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35298 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35299 .endlist
35300
35301
35302 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35303 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35304 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35305 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35306 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35307 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35308 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35309 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35310 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35311 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35312 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35313 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35314 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35315
35316 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35317 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35318 &%message_logs%& option false.
35319 .ecindex IIDloggen
35320
35321
35322
35323
35324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35326
35327 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35328 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35329 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35330 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35331 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35332
35333 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35334 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35335 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35336 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35337 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35338 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35339 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35340 various criteria"
35341 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35342 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35343 "extract statistics from the log"
35344 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35345 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35346 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35347 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35348 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35349 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35350 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35351 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35352 .endtable
35353
35354 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35355 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35356 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35357
35358
35359
35360
35361 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35362 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35363 .cindex "process, querying"
35364 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35365 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35366 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35367 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35368 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35369 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35370 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35371 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35372 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35373
35374 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35375 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35376 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35377
35378
35379 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35380 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35381 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35382 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35383 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35384 options:
35385 .display
35386 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35387 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35388 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35389 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35390 .endd
35391 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35392 .code
35393 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35394 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35395 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35396 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35397 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35398 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35399 .endd
35400 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35401 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35402
35403
35404
35405 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35406 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35407 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35408 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35409 .code
35410 exim -bpu
35411 .endd
35412 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35413 .code
35414 exim -bp
35415 .endd
35416 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35417 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35418
35419 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35420 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35421
35422 .vlist
35423 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35424 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35425 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35426 .code
35427 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35428 .endd
35429 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35430 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35431 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35432
35433 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35434 Match against the size field.
35435
35436 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35437 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35438
35439 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35440 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35441
35442 .vitem &*-z*&
35443 Match only frozen messages.
35444
35445 .vitem &*-x*&
35446 Match only non-frozen messages.
35447 .endlist
35448
35449 The following options control the format of the output:
35450
35451 .vlist
35452 .vitem &*-c*&
35453 Display only the count of matching messages.
35454
35455 .vitem &*-l*&
35456 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35457 the default.
35458
35459 .vitem &*-i*&
35460 Display message ids only.
35461
35462 .vitem &*-b*&
35463 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35464
35465 .vitem &*-R*&
35466 Display messages in reverse order.
35467
35468 .vitem &*-a*&
35469 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35470 .endlist
35471
35472 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35473
35474
35475
35476 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35477 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35478 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35479 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35480 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35481 running a command such as
35482 .code
35483 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35484 .endd
35485 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35486 it, as in the following example:
35487 .code
35488 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35489 .endd
35490 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35491 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35492 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35493 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35494
35495 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35496 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35497 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35498 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35499 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35500 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35501 sender.
35502
35503 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35504 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35505 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35506 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35507 level"& addresses).
35508
35509
35510
35511
35512 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35513 "SECTextspeinf"
35514 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35515 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35516 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35517 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35518 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35519 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35520 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35521 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35522 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35523 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35524 .display
35525 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35526 .endd
35527 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
35528
35529 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
35530 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
35531 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
35532
35533 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
35534 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
35535 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
35536 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
35537 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
35538
35539 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
35540 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
35541 regular expression.
35542
35543 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
35544 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
35545
35546 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
35547 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
35548 normally.
35549
35550 Example of &%-M%&:
35551 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
35552 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
35553 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
35554 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
35555 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
35556 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
35557 search term.
35558
35559 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
35560 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
35561 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
35562
35563
35564 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
35565 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
35566 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
35567 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
35568 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
35569 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
35570 the &%--help%& option.
35571
35572
35573 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
35574 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35575 .cindex "cycling logs"
35576 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35577 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
35578 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
35579 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
35580 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
35581 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
35582 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
35583 .ilist
35584 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
35585 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
35586 .next
35587 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
35588 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
35589 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
35590 configuration.
35591 .endlist
35592
35593 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
35594 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
35595 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
35596 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
35597 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
35598 logs are handled similarly.
35599
35600 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
35601 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
35602 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
35603 any existing log files.
35604
35605 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
35606 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
35607 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
35608 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
35609 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
35610 .code
35611 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
35612 .endd
35613 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
35614 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
35615
35616
35617
35618 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
35619 .cindex "statistics"
35620 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
35621 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
35622 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
35623 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
35624 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
35625
35626 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
35627 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
35628 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
35629 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
35630 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
35631 .code
35632 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
35633 .endd
35634 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
35635 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
35636 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
35637 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
35638 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
35639 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
35640 also produced per user.
35641
35642 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
35643 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
35644 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
35645 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
35646 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
35647
35648 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
35649 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
35650 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
35651 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
35652 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
35653 an entirely separate message.
35654
35655 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
35656 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
35657 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
35658 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
35659 least one address that failed.
35660
35661 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
35662 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
35663 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
35664 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
35665 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
35666 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
35667 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
35668
35669 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
35670 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
35671 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
35672
35673 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
35674 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
35675 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
35676 .code
35677 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
35678 .endd
35679
35680 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
35681 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
35682 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
35683 .cindex "checking access"
35684 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
35685 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
35686 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
35687 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
35688 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
35689 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
35690
35691 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
35692 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
35693 .code
35694 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
35695 .endd
35696 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
35697 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
35698 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
35699 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
35700 .code
35701 Rejected:
35702 550 Relay not permitted
35703 .endd
35704 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
35705 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
35706 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
35707 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
35708 you can use:
35709 .code
35710 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
35711 -f himself@there.example
35712 .endd
35713 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
35714 mandatory arguments.
35715
35716 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
35717 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
35718 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
35719
35720
35721
35722 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
35723 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
35724 .cindex "building DBM files"
35725 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
35726 .cindex "lower casing"
35727 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
35728 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
35729 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
35730 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
35731 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
35732 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
35733
35734 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
35735 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
35736 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
35737 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
35738 files.
35739
35740 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
35741 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
35742 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
35743 well.
35744
35745 .cindex "USE_DB"
35746 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
35747 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
35748 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
35749 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
35750 .code
35751 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
35752 .endd
35753 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
35754 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
35755
35756 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
35757 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
35758 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
35759 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
35760 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
35761 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
35762
35763 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
35764 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
35765 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
35766 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
35767 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
35768 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
35769 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
35770 return code is 2.
35771
35772
35773
35774
35775 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
35776 .cindex "retry" "times"
35777 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
35778 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
35779 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
35780 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
35781 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
35782 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
35783 output. For example:
35784 .code
35785 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
35786 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
35787 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35788 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35789 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
35790 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
35791 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
35792 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
35793 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
35794 past final cutoff time
35795 .endd
35796 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
35797 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
35798 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
35799 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
35800 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
35801 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
35802 run very often.
35803
35804 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
35805 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
35806 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
35807 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
35808 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
35809 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
35810
35811
35812
35813 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
35814 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
35815 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
35816 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
35817 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
35818 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
35819 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
35820
35821 .ilist
35822 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
35823 .next
35824 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
35825 for remote hosts
35826 .next
35827 &'callout'&: the callout cache
35828 .next
35829 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
35830 .next
35831 &'misc'&: other hints data
35832 .endlist
35833
35834 The &'misc'& database is used for
35835
35836 .ilist
35837 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
35838 .next
35839 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
35840 &(smtp)& transport)
35841 .endlist
35842
35843
35844
35845 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
35846 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
35847 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
35848 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
35849 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
35850 .code
35851 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
35852 .endd
35853 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
35854 .code
35855 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
35856 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
35857 .endd
35858 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
35859 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
35860 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
35861 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
35862 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
35863 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
35864 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
35865 and a textual description of the error.
35866
35867 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
35868 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
35869 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
35870 exceeded.
35871
35872 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
35873 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
35874 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
35875 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
35876 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
35877 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
35878 cross-references.
35879
35880
35881
35882 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
35883 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
35884 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
35885 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
35886 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
35887 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
35888 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
35889 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
35890 updated sufficiently often.
35891
35892 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
35893 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
35894 the retry database:
35895 .code
35896 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
35897 .endd
35898 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
35899 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
35900 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
35901 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
35902 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
35903 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
35904 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
35905 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
35906 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
35907 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
35908 whenever it removes information from the database.
35909
35910 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
35911 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
35912 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
35913 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
35914 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
35915
35916 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
35917 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35918 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35919 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35920 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35921 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35922 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35923 tidied.
35924
35925 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35926 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35927
35928
35929
35930
35931 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35932 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35933 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35934 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35935 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35936 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35937 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35938 displayed.
35939
35940 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35941 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35942 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35943 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35944 by new data, for example:
35945 .code
35946 > 4 951102:1000
35947 .endd
35948 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35949 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35950 used as optional separators.
35951
35952
35953
35954
35955 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35956 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35957 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35958 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
35959 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35960 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35961 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35962 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35963 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35964 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35965 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35966 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35967 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35968
35969 .vlist
35970 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
35971 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35972
35973 .vitem &%-flock%&
35974 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35975 supports it.
35976
35977 .vitem &%-interval%&
35978 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35979 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35980
35981 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
35982 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35983
35984 .vitem &%-mbx%&
35985 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35986
35987 .vitem &%-q%&
35988 Suppress verification output.
35989
35990 .vitem &%-retries%&
35991 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35992 the lock (default 10).
35993
35994 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
35995 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35996 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35997 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35998 subsequently sees.
35999
36000 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36001 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36002 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36003 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36004
36005 .vitem &%-v%&
36006 Generate verbose output.
36007 .endlist
36008
36009 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36010 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36011 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36012 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36013 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36014 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36015 more than 30 minutes old.
36016
36017 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36018 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36019 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36020 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36021 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36022 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36023
36024 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36025 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36026 suppresses all output except error messages.
36027
36028 A command such as
36029 .code
36030 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36031 .endd
36032 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36033 .display
36034 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36035 <&'some commands'&>
36036 &`End`&
36037 .endd
36038 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36039 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36040 such as
36041 .code
36042 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36043 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36044 .endd
36045 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36046 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36047 .ecindex IIDutils
36048
36049
36050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36052
36053 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36054 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36055 .cindex "X-windows"
36056 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36057 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36058 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36059 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36060 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36061 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36062 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36063 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36064
36065
36066
36067 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36068 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36069 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36070 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36071 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36072 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36073 parameters are for.
36074
36075 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36076 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36077 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36078 .code
36079 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36080 .endd
36081 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36082 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36083 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36084 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36085 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36086
36087 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36088 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36089 .code
36090 Eximon*background: gray94
36091 .endd
36092 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36093 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36094 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36095 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36096 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36097 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36098 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36099 .code
36100 xrdb -merge <<End
36101 Eximon*highlight: gray
36102 End
36103 .endd
36104 .cindex "admin user"
36105 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36106 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36107
36108 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36109 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36110 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36111 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36112 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36113
36114 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36115 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36116 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36117 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36118 different parts of the display.
36119
36120
36121
36122
36123 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36124 .cindex "stripchart"
36125 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36126 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36127 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36128 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36129 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36130 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36131 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36132 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36133 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36134
36135 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36136 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36137 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36138 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36139
36140 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36141 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36142 to a single partition.
36143
36144 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36145 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36146 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36147 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36148 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36149 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36150 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36151
36152
36153
36154
36155 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36156 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36157 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36158 .cindex "window size"
36159 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36160 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36161 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36162 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36163 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36164 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36165
36166 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36167 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36168 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36169 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36170
36171 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36172 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36173 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36174 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36175 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36176 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36177
36178 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36179 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36180 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36181
36182
36183
36184 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36185 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36186 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36187 the main log is maintained.
36188 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36189 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36190 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36191 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36192 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36193
36194 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36195 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36196 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36197 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36198 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36199 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36200 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36201 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36202 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36203 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36204 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36205
36206 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36207 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36208 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36209 It cannot go further back up the log.
36210
36211 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36212 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36213 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36214 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36215 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36216 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36217
36218 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36219 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36220 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36221 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36222 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36223 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36224
36225 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36226 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36227 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36228 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36229 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36230 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36231 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36232 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36233 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36234 window.
36235
36236
36237
36238 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36239 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36240 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36241 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36242 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36243 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36244 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36245 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36246 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36247 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36248
36249 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36250 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36251 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36252 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36253 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36254 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36255 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36256
36257 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36258 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36259 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36260 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36261 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36262 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36263 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36264
36265 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36266 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36267 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36268 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36269
36270 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36271 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36272 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36273 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36274 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36275 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36276 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36277 not shown.
36278
36279 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36280 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36281
36282 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36283 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36284 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36285 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36286 display is updated.
36287
36288
36289
36290 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36291 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36292 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36293 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36294 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36295 any selected text.
36296
36297 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36298 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36299 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36300 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36301 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36302 .code
36303 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36304 .endd
36305 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36306 follows:
36307
36308 .ilist
36309 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36310 in a new text window.
36311 .next
36312 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36313 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36314 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36315 .next
36316 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36317 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36318 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36319 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36320 .next
36321 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36322 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36323 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36324 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36325 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36326 .next
36327 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36328 that the message be frozen.
36329 .next
36330 .cindex "thawing messages"
36331 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36332 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36333 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36334 that the message be thawed.
36335 .next
36336 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36337 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36338 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36339 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36340 .next
36341 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36342 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36343 message.
36344 .next
36345 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36346 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36347 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36348 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36349 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36350 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36351 which case no action is taken.
36352 .next
36353 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36354 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36355 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36356 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36357 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36358 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36359 case no action is taken.
36360 .next
36361 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36362 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36363 .next
36364 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36365 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36366 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36367 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36368 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36369 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36370 the address is qualified with that domain.
36371 .endlist
36372
36373 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36374 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36375 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36376 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36377 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36378 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36379 if no output is generated.
36380
36381 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36382 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36383 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36384 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36385
36386 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36387 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36388 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36389 .ecindex IIDeximon
36390
36391
36392
36393
36394
36395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36397
36398 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36399 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36400 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36401 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36402
36403 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36404 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36405 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36406 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36407 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36408 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36409
36410 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36411 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36412 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36413 as soon as possible.
36414
36415
36416 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36417 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36418 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36419 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36420 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36421 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36422
36423 .ilist
36424 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36425 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36426 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36427 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36428 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36429 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36430
36431 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36432 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36433 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36434 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36435 .next
36436
36437 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36438 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36439 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36440 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36441 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36442 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36443 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36444 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36445 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36446 separate commands.
36447
36448 .next
36449 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36450 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36451 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36452 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36453 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36454 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36455 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36456 .next
36457 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36458 is disabled.
36459 .next
36460 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36461 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36462 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36463 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36464 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36465 .endlist
36466
36467
36468
36469 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36470 .cindex "setuid"
36471 .cindex "root privilege"
36472 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36473 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36474 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36475 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36476 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36477 is required for two things:
36478
36479 .ilist
36480 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36481 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36482 not required.
36483 .next
36484 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36485 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36486 configuration.
36487 .endlist
36488
36489 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36490 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36491 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36492 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36493 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36494 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36495 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36496 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36497
36498 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36499 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36500 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36501
36502 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36503 uid and gid in the following cases:
36504
36505 .ilist
36506 .oindex "&%-C%&"
36507 .oindex "&%-D%&"
36508 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36509 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36510 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36511 the calling process.
36512 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36513 option may not be used at all.
36514 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36515 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36516 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36517 .next
36518 .oindex "&%-be%&"
36519 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
36520 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
36521 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36522 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
36523 calling process.
36524 .next
36525 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
36526 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
36527 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
36528 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
36529 testing address verification
36530 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
36531 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
36532 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
36533 option).
36534 .next
36535 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
36536 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
36537 .endlist
36538
36539 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
36540
36541 .ilist
36542 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
36543 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
36544 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
36545 will be used during message reception.
36546 .next
36547 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
36548 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
36549 .next
36550 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
36551 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
36552 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
36553 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
36554 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
36555 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
36556 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
36557 generating bounce and warning messages.
36558
36559 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
36560 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
36561 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
36562 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
36563 .next
36564 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
36565 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
36566 .endlist
36567
36568
36569
36570
36571 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
36572 .cindex "privilege, running without"
36573 .cindex "unprivileged running"
36574 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
36575 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
36576 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
36577 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
36578 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
36579 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
36580 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
36581 to any other uid.
36582
36583 .cindex SIGHUP
36584 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
36585 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
36586 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
36587 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
36588
36589 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
36590 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
36591 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
36592 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
36593 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
36594
36595 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
36596 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
36597 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
36598 effect.
36599
36600 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
36601 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
36602 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
36603
36604 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
36605 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
36606 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
36607 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
36608 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
36609 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
36610 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
36611 address this problem at this time.
36612
36613 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
36614 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
36615 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
36616 be used in the most straightforward way.
36617
36618 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
36619 number of restrictions on what you can do:
36620
36621 .ilist
36622 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
36623 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
36624 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
36625 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
36626 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
36627 .next
36628 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
36629 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
36630 .next
36631 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
36632 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
36633 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
36634 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
36635 .next
36636 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
36637 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
36638
36639 .olist
36640 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
36641 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
36642 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
36643 .next
36644 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
36645 owned by the Exim user.
36646 .next
36647 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
36648 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
36649 mailboxes need to be created manually.
36650 .endlist olist
36651 .endlist ilist
36652
36653
36654 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
36655 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
36656 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
36657 gives more security at essentially no cost.
36658
36659 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
36660 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
36661
36662
36663
36664
36665 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
36666 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
36667 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
36668
36669
36670
36671 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
36672 .cindex "security" "local commands"
36673 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
36674 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
36675 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
36676 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
36677 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
36678
36679 .ilist
36680 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
36681 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
36682 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
36683 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
36684 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
36685 .next
36686 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
36687 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
36688 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
36689 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
36690 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
36691 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
36692 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
36693 .next
36694 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
36695 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
36696 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
36697 .next
36698 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
36699 taint checking might apply to their usage.
36700 .next
36701 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
36702 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
36703 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
36704 .next
36705 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
36706 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
36707 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
36708 of opaque strings.
36709 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
36710 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
36711 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
36712 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
36713 .endlist
36714
36715
36716
36717
36718 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
36719 .cindex "security" "data sources"
36720 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
36721 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
36722 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
36723 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
36724 are some issues to be aware of:
36725
36726 .ilist
36727 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
36728 .next
36729 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
36730 .next
36731 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
36732 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
36733 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
36734 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
36735 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
36736 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
36737 data.
36738 .next
36739 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
36740 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
36741 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
36742 .next
36743 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
36744 expected to yield one result.
36745 .endlist
36746
36747
36748
36749
36750 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
36751 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
36752 .cindex "IP source routing"
36753 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
36754 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
36755 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
36756 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
36757
36758
36759
36760 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
36761 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
36762 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
36763
36764
36765
36766
36767 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
36768 .cindex "trusted users"
36769 .cindex "admin user"
36770 .cindex "privileged user"
36771 .cindex "user" "trusted"
36772 .cindex "user" "admin"
36773 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
36774 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
36775 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
36776 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
36777 permit a remote host to be specified.
36778
36779 .oindex "&%-f%&"
36780 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
36781 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
36782 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
36783 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
36784 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
36785 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
36786
36787 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
36788 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
36789 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
36790 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
36791 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
36792
36793 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
36794 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
36795 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
36796 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
36797 includes the contents of files on the spool.
36798
36799 .oindex "&%-M%&"
36800 .oindex "&%-q%&"
36801 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
36802 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
36803 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
36804 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
36805 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
36806 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
36807
36808 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
36809 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
36810 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
36811 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
36812 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
36813 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
36814 files.
36815
36816
36817
36818 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
36819 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
36820 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
36821 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
36822 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
36823 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
36824
36825
36826
36827 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
36828 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
36829 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
36830 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
36831 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
36832 this.
36833
36834
36835
36836 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
36837 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
36838 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
36839 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
36840 converted output.
36841
36842
36843
36844 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
36845 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
36846 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
36847 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
36848 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
36849
36850
36851
36852 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
36853 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
36854 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
36855 loading it.
36856
36857
36858 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
36859 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
36860 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
36861 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
36862 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
36863 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
36864 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
36865
36866 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
36867 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
36868 string.
36869
36870
36871
36872 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
36873 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
36874 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
36875 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
36876
36877
36878
36879 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
36880 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
36881 enough to hold the result.
36882 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
36883
36884
36885
36886
36887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36889
36890 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
36891 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
36892 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
36893 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
36894 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
36895 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
36896 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
36897 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
36898 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
36899 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
36900 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
36901 themselves are recoverable.
36902
36903 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
36904 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
36905 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
36906
36907 .ilist
36908 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
36909 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
36910 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
36911 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
36912 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
36913 .next
36914 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
36915 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
36916 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
36917 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
36918 will always be the case.
36919 .next
36920 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
36921 .next
36922 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
36923 signature.
36924 .endlist
36925 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
36926
36927 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
36928 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
36929 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
36930 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
36931 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
36932 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
36933 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36934 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36935 attempt.
36936
36937 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36938 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36939 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36940 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36941 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36942 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36943 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36944 normally the Exim user.
36945
36946 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36947 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36948 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36949 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36950 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36951 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36952 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36953 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36954
36955 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36956 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36957 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36958 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36959
36960 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36961 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36962
36963 .vlist
36964 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36965 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36966 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36967 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36968 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36969 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36970 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36971 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36972 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36973 newlines.
36974
36975 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36976 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36977 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36978 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36979 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36980 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36981
36982 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36983 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36984 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36985 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36986 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36987 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36988
36989 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36990 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36991 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36992
36993 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36994 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36995 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36996 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36997 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36998
36999 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37000 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37001 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37002 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37003 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37004
37005 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37006 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37007 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37008
37009 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37010 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37011 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37012
37013 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37014 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37015 present.
37016
37017 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37018 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37019 present if the number is greater than zero.
37020
37021 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37022 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37023 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37024
37025 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37026 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37027 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37028
37029 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37030 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37031 command.
37032
37033 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37034 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37035 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37036 messages.
37037
37038 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37039 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37040 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37041 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37042
37043 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37044 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37045 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37046
37047 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37048 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37049 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37050 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37051 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37052 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37053
37054 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37055 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37056 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37057 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37058 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37059
37060 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37061 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37062 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37063 generated messages.
37064
37065 .vitem &%-local%&
37066 The message is from a local sender.
37067
37068 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37069 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37070
37071 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37072 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37073 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37074 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37075
37076 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37077 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37078 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37079
37080 .vitem &%-N%&
37081 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37082 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37083 &%-N%& is assumed.
37084
37085 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37086 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37087 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37088
37089 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37090 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37091 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37092
37093 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37094 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37095 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37096
37097 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37098 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37099 certificate was verified by the server.
37100
37101 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37102 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37103 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37104
37105 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37106 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37107 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37108 certificate.
37109 .endlist
37110
37111 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37112 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37113 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37114 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37115 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37116 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37117 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37118 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37119 addresses are complete.
37120
37121 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37122 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37123 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37124 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37125 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37126 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37127 .code
37128 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37129 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37130 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37131 .endd
37132 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37133 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37134 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37135 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37136 example:
37137 .code
37138 4
37139 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37140 darcy@austen.fict.example
37141 rdo@foundation
37142 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37143 .endd
37144 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37145 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37146 line is of the following form:
37147 .display
37148 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37149 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37150 .endd
37151 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37152 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37153 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37154 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37155 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37156 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37157 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37158 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37159
37160
37161 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37162 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37163 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37164 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37165 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37166 following:
37167
37168 .table2 50pt
37169 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37170 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37171 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37172 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37173 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37174 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37175 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37176 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37177 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37178 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37179 .endtable
37180
37181 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37182 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37183 typical set of headers:
37184 .code
37185 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37186 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37187 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37188 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37189 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37190 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37191 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37192 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37193 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37194 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37195 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37196 .endd
37197 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37198 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37199 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37200 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37201 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37202 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37203
37204 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37206
37207 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37208 "DKIM Support"
37209 .cindex "DKIM"
37210
37211 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37212 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37213 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37214 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37215
37216 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37217 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37218
37219 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37220 .olist
37221 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37222 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37223 (including transport filters)
37224 except cutthrough delivery.
37225 .next
37226 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37227 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37228 different signature contexts.
37229 .endlist
37230
37231 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37232 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37233 Exim's standard controls.
37234
37235 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37236 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37237 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37238 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37239 .code
37240 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37241 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37242 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37243 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37244 .endd
37245 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37246 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37247 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37248 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37249 senders).
37250
37251
37252 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37253 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37254
37255 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37256 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37257
37258 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37259 MANDATORY:
37260 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37261 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37262
37263 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37264 MANDATORY:
37265 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37266 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37267 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37268 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37269
37270 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37271 MANDATORY:
37272 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37273 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37274 The result can either
37275 .ilist
37276 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37277 .next
37278 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37279 the private key.
37280 .next
37281 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37282 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37283 is set.
37284 .endlist
37285
37286 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37287 OPTIONAL:
37288 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37289 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37290 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37291 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37292
37293 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37294 OPTIONAL:
37295 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37296 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37297 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37298 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37299 variables here.
37300
37301 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37302 OPTIONAL:
37303 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37304 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37305 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37306 used.
37307
37308
37309 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37310 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37311
37312 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37313 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37314 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37315 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37316 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
37317 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37318 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37319
37320 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37321 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37322 runtime of the ACL.
37323
37324 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37325 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37326 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37327 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37328
37329 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37330 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37331 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37332 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37333 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37334 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37335 it defaults as:
37336 .code
37337 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37338 .endd
37339 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37340 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37341 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37342 .code
37343 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37344 .endd
37345 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37346 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37347 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37348 .code
37349 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37350 .endd
37351
37352 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37353 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37354
37355
37356 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37357 available (from most to least important):
37358
37359
37360 .vlist
37361 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37362 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37363 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37364 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37365 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37366 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37367 .ilist
37368 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37369 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37370 .next
37371 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37372 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37373 .next
37374 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37375 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37376 .next
37377 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37378 .endlist
37379 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37380 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37381 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37382 .ilist
37383 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37384 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37385 .next
37386 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37387 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37388 .next
37389 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37390 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37391 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37392 .next
37393 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37394 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37395 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37396 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37397 .endlist
37398 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37399 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37400 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37401 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37402 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37403 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37404 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37405 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37406 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37407 The key record selector string.
37408 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37409 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37410 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37411 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37412 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37413 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37414 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37415 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37416 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37417 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37418 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37419 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37420 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37421 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37422 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37423 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37424 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37425 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37426 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37427 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37428 integer size comparisons against this value.
37429 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37430 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37431 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37432 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37433 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37434 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37435 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37436 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37437 in the key record.
37438 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37439 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37440 in the key record.
37441 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37442 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37443 .endlist
37444
37445 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37446
37447 .vlist
37448 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37449 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37450 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37451 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37452 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37453
37454 .code
37455 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37456 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37457 sender_domains = gmail.com
37458 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37459 dkim_status = none
37460 .endd
37461
37462 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37463 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37464 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37465 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37466
37467 .code
37468 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37469 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37470 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37471 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37472 .endd
37473
37474 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37475 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37476 for more information of what they mean.
37477 .endlist
37478
37479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37481
37482 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37483 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37484 .cindex "adding drivers"
37485 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37486 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37487 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37488 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37489
37490 .olist
37491 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37492 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37493 .next
37494 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37495 .display
37496 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37497 .endd
37498 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37499 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37500 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37501 .next
37502 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37503 .code
37504 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37505 .endd
37506 .next
37507 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37508 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37509 .next
37510 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37511 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37512 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37513 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37514 simple form that most lookups have.
37515 .next
37516 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37517 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37518 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37519 .next
37520 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37521 &_src_&.
37522 .next
37523 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
37524 as for other drivers and lookups.
37525 .endlist
37526
37527 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
37528 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
37529 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
37530 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
37531 searched using a binary chop procedure.
37532
37533 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
37534 the interface that is expected.
37535
37536
37537
37538
37539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37541
37542 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37543 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
37544 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
37545 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
37546 . processors.
37547 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37548
37549 .literal xml
37550 <?sdop
37551 format="newpage"
37552 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
37553 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
37554 ?>
37555 .literal off
37556
37557 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
37558 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
37559 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
37560
37561
37562 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37563 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////